Quarterlytics / Real Estate / Real Estate - Development / Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

lre · LSE Real Estate
Claim this profile
Ticker lre
Exchange LSE
Sector Real Estate
Industry Real Estate - Development
Employees 201-500
← All annual reports
FY2015 Annual Report · Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Annual Report & Accounts 2015 

Stickingto our

game plan

L

a

n

c

a

s

h

i

r

e

H

o

l

d

i

n

g

s

L

i

m

i

t

e

d

A

n

n

u

a

l

R

e

p

o

r

t

&

A

c

c

o

u

n

t

s

2

0

1

5

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
In this report

Highlights

STRATEGIC REPORT
OVERVIEW
8 Lancashire Group at a glance
10 Chairman’s statement
14 Our business model

STRATEGY
16 Chief Executive’s review
19 Strategy

PERFORMANCE
24 Financial review
26 Key performance indicators
28 Underwriting review
30 Business review
37 Cathedral
38 Kinesis and third-party capital
39 Enterprise risk management
42 Principal risks
44 Corporate responsibility

GOVERNANCE
52 Chairman’s introduction
54 Board of Directors
59 Corporate governance report
62 Committee reports
71 Directors’ remuneration report
89 Directors’ report
93 Statement of Directors’ responsibilities

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
96 Independent auditors’ report
102 Consolidated primary statements
106 Accounting policies
112 Risk disclosures
139 Notes to the accounts

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
171 Shareholder information
172 Glossary
176 Contact information

RETURN ON EQUITY*

10.9%

(2014: 13.9%)

COMBINED RATIO

72.1%

(2014: 68.7%)

PROFIT AFTER TAX

$181.1m

(2014: $229.3m)

DIVIDEND YIELD

17.3%

(2014: 17.8%)

TOTAL INVESTMENT RETURN

0.7%

(2014: 1.0%)

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN

25.9%

(2014: -24.2%)

KPI

KPI

KPI

KPI

Visit our corporate website for more information: 
http://www.lancashiregroup.com

* RoE excluding the impact of warrants in 2015 was 13.5% (2014: 14.7%)

Success is about reading the field 
of play and knowing when to 
attack or play for position.
Our three consistent strategic 
priorities guide and govern  
our game... 

Underwriting comes first
Effectively balance risk and return
Operate nimbly through the cycle

Underwriting comes first

Creativity

In rugby, getting the balance right between the discipline  
of the forwards and the creativity of the backs is key. For 
us, maintaining underwriting discipline in challenging 
markets means we continue to produce a leading combined 
ratio. We remain creative in being able to provide tailored 
insurance and reinsurance products to our clients across 
the three platforms of our business.

COMBINED RATIO
The Group's combined ratio 
has always been below 100%, 
despite the softening market 
rates of recent years, and 
Lancashire has consistently 
achieved combined ratios  
which have led the market.

72.1%

2
.
0
7

7
.
8
6

1
.
2
7

5 year average

67.7%

7
.
3
6

9
.
3
6

11

12

13

14

15

2 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Discipline

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W

www.lancashiregroup.com 

3

 
Effectively balance risk and return

Sticking to our game plan means not seeking top line 
growth for the sake of it in markets where we do not 
believe the right opportunities exist. We work hard  
to maintain the profitability on our core book of 
business. Effective capital management also allows 
us to deliver meaningful returns to our shareholders.

PROFIT AFTER TAX 
We aim to be profitable four 
years out of five, but in fact we 
have made a profit in each of 
the ten years of our existence. 

$181.1m

DIVIDEND YIELD
We pay annual ordinary 
dividends, and when we cannot 
utilise our profits by retaining 
them as additional capital we 
return them to shareholders  
by way of special dividends.

17.3%

Dividend
yield

2
.
2
1
2

9
.
4
3
2

5
.
2
2
2

3
.
9
2
2

Profit after tax  
5 year average

1
.
1
8
1

$216m

%
8
.
7
1

%
3
.
7
1

%
3
.
2
1

%
4
.
8

%
3
.
8

11

12

13

14

15

k
s
i
R

4 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Profit after tax  

5 year average

$216m

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W

R
e
w
a
r
d

www.lancashiregroup.com 

5

 
Operate nimbly through the cycle

Strength

Our outwards reinsurance programme provides a breadth 
and depth of cover which has helped us to strengthen our 
position and manage volatility. This helps us to continue  
to underwrite our core portfolio through the challenges  
posed by the cycle.

6 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

PROBABLE MAXIMUM LOSS
PMLs are a reasonable proxy for  
the relative amounts of risk we are 
retaining across the cycle. In the  
current environment we have  
continued to bring risk levels down, 
largely through the use of additional 
reinsurance. The table shows our  
1 in 100 year Gulf of Mexico expected 
net loss at 1 January in each year.

$198.7m

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W

.

7
8
2
3

.

3
7
8
2

.

6
9
4
2

.

2
5
3
2

.

7
8
9
1

12

13

14

15

16
as at 1 January

Agility

www.lancashiregroup.com 

7

 
LANCASHIRE GROUP AT A GLANCE

OUR STRONG AND CLEAR 
INVESTMENT PROPOSITION

Even in difficult markets, the Lancashire Group continues to deliver strong 
and consistent returns. Our goal remains to provide a relatively attractive, 
risk-adjusted return to shareholders over the long term. We achieve this by 
focusing on underwriting risk selection, maintaining our underwriting 
discipline and managing our capital to suit market opportunities.

Through all the significant market events since its establishment ten years ago, the Lancashire 
Group remains a top-performing specialty, short-tail insurer and reinsurer delivering leading 
combined ratios and returns on equity. Our message of “underwriting comes first” remains as 
relevant today as it did when we began; and our continued discipline and commitment to 
focus on drivers of profitability allow us to remain as a strong and relevant counterparty for 
our clients and brokers and to continue to deliver strong returns for our shareholders.

Performance incentives for management and staff are aligned to shareholders’ interests so 
our focus remains on maintaining profitability and returning capital to shareholders in the 
right market conditions. We seek to optimise capital and are well positioned to take advantage 
of the market in a post loss scenario. 

OPERATING HIGHLIGHTS
•  Maintained our core portfolio despite difficult  
market conditions and trading environment.

•  Able to buy broader and deeper reinsurance protection 

FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
•  Combined ratio of 72.1 per cent, yet again one of the 
leading combined ratios in our peer group, reflecting 
solid underwriting and expense control.

across the Group to protect our core book.

•  Loss ratio for 2015 of 27.5 per cent, another strong 

performance in a year with a number of medium-sized  
risk and catastrophe losses.

•  Favourable loss reserve development on prior year  

losses totalled $107.7 million for the year. 

•  Gross premiums written of $641.1 million with  
a contribution of $247.7 million from Cathedral.

•  Kinesis deployment of $299.5 million of limits  

with capital raised on two occasions during the year.

•  Investment return of 0.7 per cent reflecting emphasis  

on limiting risk in volatile markets.

•  Our investment portfolio has produced a positive return 

and has remained resilient in the face of turbulent 
financial markets during the course of 2015.

•  As we continue with work on the development and 
integration of our three business platforms we have 
benefitted from a greater financial contribution from 
Cathedral during the year. There were no acquisition  
costs to amortise in 2015, with both syndicates performing 
well and having large prior year reserve releases.

•  Kinesis has continued to expand its “investor club”  
and has completed further capital raises during  
the course of the year.

•  The Group was fully prepared for the introduction  

of the Solvency II regime in 2016 and Group Supervision  
from the PRA.

8 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

LANCASHIRE IS A BESPOKE SPECIALTY 
INSURER/REINSURER OPERATING ACROSS 
THREE PLATFORMS

OUR THREE PLATFORMS

LANCASHIRE
Two operating companies covering  
the London and Bermuda markets with 
strong core business portfolios, recognised 
leadership capability and the ability to 
deploy capacity nimbly in a changing 
market across four classes.

CATHEDRAL
Two syndicates in Lloyd’s with mature 
portfolios of short-tail business in the  
same classes as Lancashire, but separate 
niches, allowing further diversification  
of the business and client base. Access  
to Lloyd’s unique capital structure  
and world-wide licences.

KINESIS
A third-party capital and underwriting 
manager in Bermuda, leveraging the 
Group's expertise, infrastructure and  
track record to offer unique multi-class 
products to clients and investors, with  
scope to develop more products as the 
market evolves.

D

F

E

$393.4m

Gross premiums written

D

A

C

$247.7m

$299.5m

Gross premiums written

Limits deployed

A

C

B

B

Portfolio breakdown

Portfolio breakdown

A: Property: 50.1%
B: Energy: 28.5%

C: Marine: 12.1%
D: Aviation: 9.3%

D: Marine: 11.9%
A: Property Re: 37.5%
B: Property Direct: 26.7% E:  Aviation: 11.5%
C: Energy: 8.1%

F:  Other: 4.3%

Page 30
Read about the Lancashire companies

Page 37
Read about Cathedral

Page 38 
Read about Kinesis

www.lancashiregroup.com 

9

OVERVIEW 
CHAIRMAN’S STATEMENT

INTERVIEW WITH
MARTIN THOMAS

Lancashire has faced yet another year of challenging 
underwriting conditions. Against this background  
our strategic priorities have been essentially defensive 
in nature, and consistent with what we have done in 
the past – to maintain a core book of business and to 
focus on the fundamentals of good underwriting.

25.9%

Total shareholder return

17.3%

Dividend yield

10 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Q What have been the strategic  
challenges for 2015?

Achieving the right balance of risk and return  
is important when taking any strategic decision. 

Lancashire has faced yet another year of 
challenging underwriting conditions. Against 
this background our strategic priorities have 
been essentially defensive in nature, and 
consistent with what we have done in the past 
– i.e. to maintain a core book of business and to 

Lancashire believes that  
its relevance to its clients 
and brokers is not due  
to the complexity of its 
administration and structure 
or the size of its capital base, 
but rather its expertise and 
commitment to excellence 
in underwriting.

focus on the 
fundamentals of good 
underwriting. The 
Board has not 
required management 
to seek out top-line 
growth through 
speculative new 
products or structures, 
as some businesses 
have done in this 
market. As is 
described elsewhere 

in this report, our priorities have been to 
provide excellent underwriting products and 
services to our core insurance and reinsurance 
clients, and their brokers, and to support the 
relationships that we have built up over many 
years. In this environment, where insurance and 
reinsurance pricing has been falling, as a Board 
we have been comfortable witnessing Alex and 
the management team de-risking the business, 
in particular through the purchase of additional 
and better priced outwards reinsurance 
coverage. In doing this we have had one eye  
on the cyclical nature of the insurance and 
reinsurance markets. The Group operates a 
lean business, with a global headcount of less 
than 200 employees, and we have the ability to 
shrink and grow our capital base in line with 
market opportunities. The Board has been 
happy to adopt this more defensive strategy 
during 2015, secure in the knowledge that  
when opportunities do arise we will have the 
expertise, relationships and the resources  
at hand to capitalise on them.

The Group operates a lean  
business, with a global 
headcount of less than 200 
employees, and we have the 
ability to shrink and grow 
our capital base in line  
with market opportunities.

Q Have the 2015 financial results been in 

line with expectations?

Given the difficult trading environment, I am pleased with 
our RoE of 10.9 per cent, warrant adjusted 13.5 per cent, for 
2015. Net earned premium for the Group was $567.1 million 
for 2015, which compares with $715.6 million for 2014. This 
decrease is principally a reflection of reduced pricing and 
lower renewals in a number of our core classes of business, 
in particular the energy lines, as we focus on underwriting 
profitable business rather than top line growth. Despite  
the volatile financial markets of 2015, the Group's total 
investment return for the year was $14.4 million. Although 
down from $22.0 million in 2014, this reflects our 
conservative investment positioning across asset classes, 
which has paid off in difficult markets. The combined ratio 
of 72.1 per cent is an excellent result. I am also pleased with 
the performance of Cathedral, which contributed 3.5 per cent 
to RoE during 2015 and has demonstrated an impressive 
resilience in tough markets. 

Kinesis has recently underwritten its third January cycle  
of multi-class reinsurance products and has now established 
a high calibre portfolio of cedants and investors. Kinesis 
remains well-placed to capitalise on any changes in the 
reinsurance markets at such time as the opportunity  
may arise.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

11

OVERVIEW 
CHAIRMAN’S STATEMENT CONTINUED

It remains a core part of the Board's 
strategy to flex the Group's capital 
base in such a way that capital 
which we cannot deploy profitably  
is returned to shareholders.

Q What is the Board’s approach to dividend payments 

and capital management?

The Board is pleased to have declared ordinary and  
special dividends in respect of 2015 amounting in total to 
$1.10 per common share. It has for some years now been  
our mantra that Lancashire tailors its capital requirements  
to the underwriting and business opportunities available to 
it. This year we have returned a total of $316.0 million to 
shareholders, which significantly exceeds the Group’s profit 
after tax for the year of $181.1 million. It remains a core part 
of the Board’s strategy to flex the Group’s capital base in 
such a way that capital which we cannot deploy profitably  
is returned to shareholders. An important element to this 
active capital management strategy employed by the Board  
is the flexibility afforded to us by shareholders to issue up  
to 15 per cent of Lancashire’s shares on a non pre-emptive 
basis. The best opportunities in the insurance and 
reinsurance sectors arise following major loss events,  
and the flexibility afforded to the Board, which would  
allow it to issue shares quickly to raise capital so as to 
maximise such opportunities for the business, is a central 
pillar of our business strategy. Once again the Company  
is seeking shareholder support for a resolution at the 2016 
AGM allowing this capital management flexibility, and  
I would encourage all shareholders to vote in favour.

12 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Q What differentiates Lancashire  

from its peers?

During the last year we witnessed a wave of  
mergers and acquisitions within the insurance  
and reinsurance sector. The rationale for many  
of these appears to have been to create cost and 
capital efficiencies for businesses, most of which 
have had complex international networks and 
operations and, in the current market, have found 
themselves struggling to make meaningful returns. 
Lancashire believes that its relevance to its clients 
and brokers is not due to the complexity of its 
administration and structure or the size of its 
capital base, but rather its expertise and 
commitment to excellence in underwriting.  
Within the classes of business in which we  
operate, Lancashire provides leadership and 
technical underwriting skills which ensure its 
relevance to clients and brokers alike. We remain 
committed to this business model, and for this 
reason we believe that Lancashire need not 
participate in the mergers and acquisitions 
roundabout, since it does not suffer from the 
structural problems which have driven the latest 
round of consolidation within our sector.

Within the classes of 
business in which we 
operate, Lancashire 
provides leadership and 
technical underwriting 
skills which ensure its 
relevance to clients  
and brokers alike.

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W

Q What plans does the business have for 
Board planning and succession?

In last year’s Annual Report and Accounts I was 
able to report the appointment of two new 
Directors to the Board, namely Peter Clarke and 
Tom Milligan. Consequently, 2015 was a year for 
consolidation on the Board, and I have been 
pleased with the mix of skills and perspectives 
which we now have in the Boardroom. Of all our 
Board members, I am now the longest serving, 
having been first appointed to the Board in 2006, 
becoming Chairman in 2007. Having served the 
Board and the business since the early days 
following its foundation in 2005, I have decided 
that the time is now right for me to step down from 
my role as Chairman and Director. The Board as  
a whole has considered the matter of succession  
to the Chairmanship, and I am delighted to report 
that Peter Clarke, with the full support of the 
Board, has agreed to become Chairman following 
the 2016 AGM, at which point I will retire from the 
Board. The business will be in excellent hands with 
Peter as Chairman of the Board and Alex as CEO 
and I wish them well. I would also like to thank all 
those people within the Group with whom I have 
worked over many years. The exceptional success 
of Lancashire as a business is principally due to  
the expertise and dedication of its people, and  
it has been a privilege and a pleasure for me to 
share in that common enterprise.

Q What challenges and opportunities do you see for the 

year ahead?

On a personal level I am delighted to be able to take over  
the leadership of the Board of a business which has achieved 
sector beating results over the last decade. The Group is well 
positioned to weather the challenges of a difficult underwriting 
and macroeconomic environment. Against this backdrop the 
principal challenge for the Board and the business is to ensure 
that we maintain a dynamic culture capable of maximising  
the right opportunities in the market at such time as they  
may arise. This will require patience and a tight focus on our 
strategic priorities of a balanced approach to risk and return,  
a commitment to excellence in underwriting and the flexibility 
and nimbleness to address the changing challenges of the 
underwriting cycle. I look forward to working with the  
Board, the management team and everyone working  
in the business over the years ahead.

Martin Thomas
Non-Executive Chairman

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chairman designate

www.lancashiregroup.com 

13

 
OUR BUSINESS MODEL

THREE PLATFORMS, ONE COMMON GOAL

We leverage our deep underwriting expertise with efficient management 
of capital and resources across our three platforms to provide our  
clients and brokers with excellent solutions for their insurance and 
reinsurance needs. We always focus on the risk-adjusted return.

LANCASHIRE
Pages 30 to 36
To find out more information

UNDERWRITING
AND CAPITAL
MANAGEMENT

CATHEDRAL
Page 37
To find out more information

KINESIS
Page 38
To find out more information

Clients and ma r k e t s

OUR RESPONSIBILITY
We recognise that our responsibility as a company and as individuals reaches wider than  
our shareholders and our clients. We strive to be a good employer, a good corporate citizen 
and a responsible preserver of resources. Through the Lancashire Foundation, we make 
substantial financial contributions and provide human support to a number of good causes 
in the places we operate and around the world (for further details see pages 44 to 49).

14 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

RESPONSIBILITYRETURNRISKLANCASHIRE

Key Strengths

CATHEDRAL

KINESIS

•  Strong brand with clients and brokers

•  Strong brand with core clients and brokers

•  Recognised for significant capacity and  
strong leadership ability in well-defined 
business sectors

•  Proven track record of supplying capacity 

across the cycle with sector-leading  
profitable results

•  A lean business operation allows us to remain 

nimble and make decisions efficiently

•  Recognised for long-term consistency  

of relationships

•  Efficient Lloyd’s capital model allowing 

greater premium leverage than for rated 
companies

•  Worldwide licensing maintained by Lloyd’s 

allows Cathedral to write business worldwide 
with limited regulatory overheads

•  Ability to leverage Group data, relationships 
and reputation with investors and clients

•  Experienced, fully dedicated management 
with strong relationships amongst clients, 
brokers and investors

•  Highly specialised multi-class product  
with strong barriers to entry in terms  
of data and modeling expertise

•  Ability to raise and deploy capital very quickly

•  A profitable core book of business and 

•  Use of world’s oldest insurance third-party 

disciplined underwriting allows us to produce 
an excellent combined ratio

capital – the Names – who pay underwriting 
fees, costs and profit commission

•  Expanding investor base following a strong 
underwriting performance since the first 
capital raise for 2014 risks

•  Strong record of capital management actions 
to optimise and adjust capital and navigate 
market cycles

•  Experienced management team with  

proven ability

Goals

•  Operates two active syndicates, following  

•  Proven track record with Kinesis  

the build out of Syndicate 3010

now in its third year

•  Maintain key client, broker and reinsurer 

•  Maintain core portfolios in the syndicates  

in a climate of increased competition

•  Continue to look for new opportunities for 
bolt on business lines in both syndicates

•  Leverage the Group’s balance sheet and  

cross sell where opportunities arise

relationships to ensure the continued flow  
of business and maintenance of capabilities

•  Continue to improve use of reinsurance and 
retrocession to uphold risk-adjusted balance 
in softening markets

•  Retain “underwriting comes first” culture  
and discipline without being tempted into 
innovation or diversification for its own sake

Risk

•  Ensure product is correctly calibrated to meet 
clients' needs in terms of responding to events  
and capital relief

•  Deliver returns in line with expectations  
for modeled ranges given market losses  
and pricing

•  Continue to increase investor club members 

•  Source reinsurance opportunities and provide 

bespoke and flexible products to match 
investor appetite

•  Continued influx of new capacity, some from 
naïve or inexperienced capital, and further 
development of broker facilities with less 
robust underwriting controls

•  Pressure on signings and participation  

•  Increased competition from traditional  

given relatively small line sizes 
although counterbalanced by strength  
of broker and client relationships

and collateralised markets being displaced 
from property retrocession, with attempts  
to replicate the Kinesis product

•  Expanded burden of regulatory oversight  
or overlapping regulation from Lloyd’s,  
the PRA and the FCA

•  Waning of investor interest in insurance 

allocations if interest rates begin to increase  
and yields return to capital markets

•  Client resistance to complex products, given 
cheap availability of traditional products

•  Continuing rate pressures in  

softening markets

•  Widening terms and conditions being  

accepted by the insurance market without 
adequate pricing or exclusions

Return

71.3%

Lancashire Companies' combined ratio

Cathedral's combined ratio

73.6%

$299.5m

Kinesis limits deployed

www.lancashiregroup.com 

15

OVERVIEW 
CHIEF EXECUTIVE’S REVIEW

72.1%

Combined ratio

27.5%

Loss ratio

10.9%

Return on equity*

*  RoE excluding the impact of 
warrants in 2015 was 13.5%

INTERVIEW WITH
ALEX MALONEY

Good underwriting remains 
paramount, as does our  
ability to act quickly and  
nimbly to changing conditions 
and our preparedness to closely 
match our capital to the 
opportunities available.

16 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Q What have the challenges been in 2015?

Having worked in the insurance business for the last  
25 years it is my view that 2015 has been the most 
challenging calendar year for the whole insurance industry 
that we have seen for at least a decade. The insurance 
industry as a whole has seen a further accumulation of 
capital; this stems from yet another benign year for 
catastrophe losses, resulting in pressure on premium pricing 
and the terms and conditions of coverage. Several insurers 
have been involved in merger and acquisition activity, which 
is in part a response to falling margins and the perceived 
need amongst some of our competitors to rationalise their 
larger and more complex operations and infrastructures. 
The broking community has not been immune to these 
pressures and has continued both to consolidate its 
operations and to innovate with new products and methods 
of distribution, which might be regarded as having been 
designed to generate new income streams for the brokers 
themselves, rather than serving the insurance needs of  
the market. Into this mix must be added the continuing 
commercial pressure on our clients, particularly in the oil 
and gas industries, where the dramatic fall in the oil price 
has resulted in less exploration and development activity,  
as well as economic pressure on our clients’ existing 
operations and asset prices and a corresponding drop-off  
in the demand for insurance coverage. Whilst our return  
on equity is 10.9 per cent, the warrant adjusted return on 
equity of 13.5 per cent is a better reflection of our 
underwriting results. This, together with our combined  
ratio of 72.1 per cent for the year, demonstrates our ability  
as a business to pick our team and adapt our game plan  
to these harsh playing conditions. Against this backdrop  
I am delighted with our financial performance.

Q How has the business responded to the  

difficult market?

Our strategic priorities are engrained within our own 
business and people and are also now well understood  
by our investors and stakeholders. Good underwriting  
(our basic skill set) remains paramount, as does our ability  
to act quickly and nimbly to changing conditions and  
our preparedness to closely match our capital to the 
opportunities available. Our global headcount remains less 
than 200, which means that as a business we remain able to 
avoid the cost and complexity of our larger competitors and 
to adapt our risk profile to market conditions. In a market 
where the price for assuming risk has been falling, we have 
reduced our risk levels. This takes discipline. We have had  
to take hard decisions to turn down badly-priced business 
and we have reduced our inwards exposures where required. 
On the bright side, the reduction in the pricing of risk has 

created excellent opportunities on the reinsurance 
purchasing side. This combination of inwards underwriting 
discipline and better priced and broader outwards 
reinsurance coverage has enabled us to de-risk our overall 
portfolio. Our Cathedral business, which we acquired during 
2013, has helped give strength and breadth to the core 
business of the Group. Its contribution to Group profits of 
$46.0 million and its impressive combined ratio of 73.6 per 
cent for the year illustrate the quality and discipline which 
have always been characteristic of our Group. The year on 
year decline in our net premium income is not an exciting 
story to tell, but it is the mark of a business which adapts  
its strategy so as to flex its capital and risk profile to deliver  
a solid risk adjusted return to its shareholders. A more 
detailed analysis of market conditions can be found in  
the Underwriting Review on pages 28 to 29. 

Q Does Lancashire have the size to remain relevant  

to clients and brokers?

There has been a tendency amongst commentators and 
analysts to equate the “relevance” of an insurance company 
to the size of its capital base. That is a superficially attractive 
argument, but it is flawed. Whilst the balance sheet size of an 
insurer is important, it is not the only factor in the decision 
of brokers and clients when placing insurance risks. Our 
brokers come to us, whether that be through our London  
or Bermuda Lancashire platforms, through Cathedral at 
Lloyd’s, or through Kinesis, because we employ leading 
specialty underwriters in the fields in which we underwrite. 
Our underwriters understand the needs of the brokers and 
our clients and have the standing and ability to act as leaders 
in the negotiation of pricing and coverage terms and to 
service with excellence the ongoing needs of our clients.  
We may not always be the cheapest, or have the biggest 
balance sheet, but you get what you pay for and we do pride 
ourselves on being the leaders in those classes within which 
we operate. As a Group we do not wish to create a worldwide 
network. We have a strong presence in the London and 
Bermuda markets and we are supportive of those markets 
and the related broker distribution networks, which we 
consider to be world-leading in their capabilities and 
expertise. Our priority is to maintain a tightly focused  
and relatively small business without the distractions  
and overheads of multiple foreign offices and operations. 
Lancashire is a business which prides itself on its 
underwriting expertise, its excellence of service and its 
ability to adapt its capital base to the opportunities in any 
given market. I have recently met with all of our largest 
shareholders and I am confident that they understand the 
challenges of the current market and our strategic response, 
which ensures our continuing relevance to our clients, our 
brokers and all our stakeholders.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

17

STRATEGY 
CHIEF EXECUTIVE’S REVIEW CONTINUED

Q You have chosen a rugby theme for this Annual 

Report – why is that?

Q Where do you see the business in the longer term?

Rugby has been a lifelong love for me. I have enjoyed the 
game both as a player and as a supporter. It is the ultimate 
team sport and a game in which success, whilst drawing on 
individual talent, is ultimately built on teamwork. That is 
how I see our Group. As a team we value the contribution  
of all the members, and I hope that we encourage a culture 
where we are not reliant on one or two star signings, but on 
a bench strength of home grown talent. We also place value 
on clear and rapid communication, a prime example of that 
being Lancashire’s daily underwriting call where all our 
Lancashire underwriters, however experienced, have the 
opportunity to consider all the risks being evaluated by our 
business – whether in London or Bermuda. Any team has to 
adapt rapidly, to play the pitch, weather conditions and the 
particular strengths and weaknesses of any opponent as they 
are found. The challenges of the current insurance market 
dictate to us as a business that we modify our game plan to 
the conditions of play. As with any good team, we assess the 
relative risks and rewards and we consider when to adopt a 
defensive strategy and when to attack. From time to time we 
may suffer setbacks, but our objective is to create a business 
capable of succeeding year upon year, whatever challenges 
we may face.

Q How do you think the market will change  

during 2016?

The fundamentals of our business don’t change. The market 
is driven by the forces of supply and demand and, absent  
a major market moving catastrophe loss event, I anticipate 
that there will continue to be an oversupply of underwriting 
capacity across the industry in 2016. Generating returns  
will remain difficult in this soft part of the cycle. As a Group 
we will continue to adapt to these market conditions, but  
I am suspicious of some of the recent innovations in the 
market, including broker facilities, the rapid growth in  
cyber coverage pursued by some of our competitors and  
the use of disruptive technologies to create new platforms 
for distribution. All of these have their associated risks and 
my gut instinct is to proceed with extreme caution and to 
focus on our traditional skills. So for 2016 we will work to 
provide an acceptable return on our investors’ capital, 
driven by our view of risk and capital requirements in 
response to market conditions.

Our Group has the structure and expertise to implement 
our current nimble strategy as a bespoke provider of 
specialty insurance and reinsurance. We have carefully  
and consistently developed this strategy since Lancashire’s 
inception in 2005. My vision is to continue to build the  
best bespoke specialty (re)insurance company in the world 
by retaining and recruiting best in breed underwriters across 
a number of specialty insurance and reinsurance classes. 
Over the next few years we will look to consolidate our 
existing core book of business and to grow organically  
other specialty lines, but only where the right opportunities 
present themselves. We will continue to optimise the use of 
our different underwriting 
platforms at Lloyd’s, in London 
and Bermuda and through Kinesis, 
our third-party capital facility. We 
plan to keep the headcount small, 
maintaining a tight control over 
business costs. Perhaps most 
importantly, I want to build and 
consolidate a group of talented 
people with individual expertise 
and a strong sense of their place  
in the overall Lancashire team and 
a shared understanding of our 
strategic goals. 

Our underwriters 
understand the needs  
of the brokers and our 
clients and have the 
standing and ability  
to act as leaders in the 
negotiation of pricing 
and coverage terms and 
to service with excellence 
the ongoing needs of  
our clients.

In closing, I must mention Martin 
Thomas, our Chairman, who is 
stepping down at this year's AGM having served the Group 
for over nine years. I have enjoyed working with Martin  
and I have valued his support and insight – as well as  
his constructive challenge. Martin has been an excellent 
Chairman and member of the LHL Board and has helped 
guide our Board and business through both challenging  
and exciting times to establish Lancashire as one of the most 
successful and respected specialty insurance and reinsurance 
groups listed on the LSE. We will continue to work together 
until the 2016 AGM, when I will look forward to working 
with Peter Clarke, an existing member of our Board and 
the designated new Chairman. But I would like to take this 
opportunity to thank Martin for his exceptional contribution 
to the success of Lancashire. 

Alex Maloney
Group Chief Executive Officer

18 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

STRATEGY

INTRODUCTION TO STRATEGY

Over our ten year history our strategic objectives have remained unchanged. How we implement that strategy 
adapts as the market forces to which we find ourselves subject on the field of play ebb and flow. By adopting this 
active fluidity of approach we demonstrate the importance of one of the three cornerstones of our strategy: to 
operate nimbly through the cycle.

The market we find ourselves in today is a very different one from 
when we started ten years ago. In all of our lines of business, rates 
have declined and margins are under more pressure than at any 
time in our history. In order to effectively balance risk and return 
our approach is different over time. In very simple terms we get 
paid less now than in prior years for assuming the same risk –  
so we therefore adjust our risk levels down accordingly. We have 
consolidated our core portfolio of business and defended this  
book whilst at the same time protecting the balance sheet with 
broader and deeper reinsurance coverage. This year we have 
continued to manage down the volatility within the Group’s 
underwriting portfolio as margins reduce. We still accept risk,  
as this is what we do. But we carefully manage the risk levels  
we accept, to reflect the market we see.

In soft markets premiums inevitably come under pressure. Even 
maintaining constant risk levels will deliver lower premium 
volumes as rates soften. In these markets there is a natural 
tendency to lose sight of basic underwriting principles and focus 
on premium income rather than underwriting profitability.  
To maintain underwriting discipline you need to accept that 
premiums will shrink. We believe that, ultimately, underwriting 
profitability should remain the focus. Why write more risk when 
the return for that risk is less? This can seem counterintuitive given 
the obvious but superficial attraction of maintaining premium 
levels. Our team of underwriters shares this view of the importance 
of careful risk selection rather than top-line growth and our 

LANCASHIRE FIRST LOSS XL LIMIT ILLUSTRATION
2012 VS 2015

principal focus is on generating underwriting profit. This  
sharp strategic focus is demonstrated by a combined ratio  
of 72.1 per cent. At Lancashire, underwriting always comes first.

Another temptation when premiums are reducing is to enter 
markets or underwrite products that are new and fashionable. 
Again, we tend not to be swayed by fashion. If we can understand 
the risk, or bring in best in breed underwriting teams that 
understand the risk, then we will expand the business. What  
we will not do is enter new classes purely to replace lost revenue  
across other areas of the portfolio.

It is fair to describe our underwriting strategy in this market as 
defensive. We feel that a defensive strategy is the correct one, and 
we are fortunate to have a portfolio of business with long-term blue 
chip clients that allows us to take this stance. We are very grateful 
for the support that both our clients and brokers have shown to 
the Group over the past year and throughout our ten year history, 
and we look forward to working with them for another ten  
years and beyond.

We wait patiently for the time when the market is in a more 
favourable position than it is today. In the meantime we will do 
everything we can to capitalise on the expertise and relationships 
we as a business have nurtured and to make sure the Group is best 
positioned for when these better times return. 

Outwards Reinsurance 
1st loss limit 2015

Outwards Reinsurance 
1st loss limit 2012

Energy 
ex GOM

Energy 
ex GOM

Energy 
GOM

Energy 
GOM

Marine 
Hull

Marine 
Hull

Marine 
IGPIA

Marine 
IGPIA

Terror 
Metro

Terror 
Metro

2012

2015

2012

2015

2012

2015

2012

2015

2012

2015

Terror 
Non
 metro
2012

Terror 
Non 
metro
2015

US ANP 
ILWs

2012

Peak 
Property 
Cat
2015

Japan 
ILWs

2012

Non-US 
Property 
Cat
2015

Political 
Risk

Political 
Risk

2012

2015

www.lancashiregroup.com 

19

STRATEGY 
STRATEGY CONTINUED

CONSISTENCY IN STRATEGIC 
DIRECTION OVER TIME

Our strategy

We have three strategic aims that enable us to meet our goal of providing an attractive 
risk-adjusted return to our shareholders. We put underwriting at the forefront of all that we 
do, we focus on getting the right balance between risk and return and we ensure that we can 
react nimbly to an ever-changing market. This enables us to serve our clients and brokers with 
significant capacity across the cycle, not just in the core business we aim to renew every year,  
but also in times or in areas where capacity is scarce: the opportunistic part of our portfolio.  
We keep our structure lean and overheads under strict control so that we can refocus our 
resources quickly. And we test our assumptions and performance constantly through our 
structure using daily underwriting calls or exception reporting to management, a fortnightly 
Risk and Return Committee meeting with all disciplines within the Group represented,  
and a series of supporting underwriting, operational, compliance, investment and finance 
committees. Around this our risk function and internal audit supply challenge and assurance  
to management and the Board through a simple and continuous reporting process.

SHAREHOLDER 
RETURN

Cross-cycle return of risk-free plus 13%
Profitable 4 years out of 5
Peak-zone PML limits  of 25% of capital

Effectively balance 
risk and return

Operate nimbly through 
the cycle

Underwriting always 
comes first

OUR CULTURE –  
THE BEDROCK OF OUR STRATEGY

Lancashire encourages a culture of co-operation and respect based on open challenge.  
This can be seen clearly in the LICL and LUK daily underwriting call where senior and junior 
underwriters debate the risks they want to write and their fit to the portfolio and market.  
It also characterises the Group-wide Risk and Return Committee which brings together 
underwriting, actuarial, finance and treasury and risk to challenge the assumptions used  
in all areas of our planning and measuring the business.

20 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Description

UNDERWRITING ALWAYS 
COMES FIRST
We employ 34 underwriters 
across the Group, many of them 
with decades of experience,  
and supply them with analytical 
tools to assess which business 
best fits our portfolios. We look 
for profitable new opportunities 
helping us to remain relevant to 
our brokers and clients.

EFFECTIVELY BALANCE 
RISK AND RETURN
By bringing together all our 
disciplines – underwriting, 
actuarial, modeling, finance, 
treasury, risk and operations 
– at our fortnightly RRC 
meetings, we are able  
to look at how different parts  
of our operations are working 
together. We stress test our 
business plans and gauge  
where we can be most effective 
without undue volatility.

OPERATE NIMBLY THROUGH 
THE CYCLE 
As capital continues 
to accumulate in the  
(re)insurance market, 
the need to be nimble is 
more important than ever. 
This means being ready to 
deploy capital quickly when 
it is needed, and having the 
discipline to return it when 
it is not.

Achievements in 2015

Performance

We have reduced our written 
premium and PMLs by turning 
down under-priced business, 
whilst retaining our core book. 
We have grown the number  
of Kinesis investors to ten and 
the number of cedants to ten, 
whilst deploying $299.5 million 
of limits.

Combined Ratio

72.1%

KPI

Gross premiums written

$641.1m

Still a leading combined  
ratio, even in difficult markets, 
evidencing the continued  
focus on underwriting, 
portfolio construction  
and superior risk selection.

We saw a significant 
contribution from Cathedral  
in 2015 as we focused on 
protecting our core portfolios, 
but maintained the discipline  
to decline or re-structure our 
participation on under-priced 
or poorly performing business.

Associated strategic risks

The key risk in the current 
market phase is the loss of 
relevance to brokers and 
clients; with so much surplus 
capacity, insurers need to  
have a unique selling point.  
For Lancashire that is found  
in its mixture of capacity, 
leadership capability,  
significant reinsurance 
expenditure and multiple 
balance sheet options. 

We have had to reduce  
income in some areas of  
our business in response  
to market weakening. But  
we have been able to find 
substantial outwards 
reinsurance opportunities  
that allow us to mitigate 
some of the effects of price 
reductions, and reduce  
our net exposures until  
the time is right for us  
to retain more risk.

Lancashire renewed its  
15 per cent disapplication of 
pre-emption rights to smooth 
potential future capital raises.

KPI

Return on Equity*

10.9%

A good result despite  
a challenging market  
and the incidence of risk  
losses, helped by our  
improved outwards  
reinsurance programme.

Probable Maximum Loss

$198.7m*

We continued to reduce our 
exposure to key catastrophe 
perils as the market has  
become more competitive, 
demonstrating our discipline 
and nimbleness.

The key issue for Lancashire is 
to continue to serve our clients 
and brokers with significant 
capacity, whilst ensuring  
that the portfolio is not 
unbalanced. This means 
constantly re-assessing our 
business mix, and testing  
key risk assumptions. 

*  RoE excluding the impact of warrants  

in 2015 was 13.5%.

*  1 in 100 year Gulf of Mexico Hurricane 
expected net loss at 1 January 2016.

Dividend Yield

17.3%

Whilst buying back shares  
can be a part of right-sizing 
capital, special dividends  
allow Lancashire to make 
substantial capital returns 
quickly when justified.

Percentage of 
comprehensive income 
returned to shareholders

KPI

187.0%

Lancashire continues to 
exercise the discipline of  
giving back capital it cannot 
profitably deploy, but remains 
open to new opportunities  
such as those developed in 
Syndicate 3010.

Page 26
KPIs

Lancashire has developed  
an expectation among its 
stakeholders that it will produce 
a consistent return and pay 
ordinary dividends and special 
dividends when it makes sense 
to do so. Lancashire has to 
ensure that all stakeholders 
understand that in hard 
markets Lancashire will want  
to retain and even raise capital 
to take full advantage of 
underwriting opportunities.

Page 39
Enterprise Risk Management

www.lancashiregroup.com 

21

STRATEGY 
PERFORMANCE

Disciplined

to achieve success

Being a disciplined and focused team, 
with clear strategic goals, means we 
deliver solid performance in all types  
of conditions.

22 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

P
E
R
F
O
R
M
A
N
C
E

PERFORMANCE

24 Financial review
26 Key performance indicators 
28 Underwriting review
30 Business review
37 Cathedral
38 Kinesis and third-party capital
39 Enterprise risk management
42 Principal risks
44 Corporate responsibility

www.lancashiregroup.com 

23

 
FINANCIAL REVIEW

Elaine Whelan
Group Chief Financial Officer

MAINTAINING STRONG 
FINANCIALS

Q How would you sum up the 2015 Group financial performance?

While market conditions continued to deteriorate, we maintained our 
disciplined approach to underwriting. A combination of our risk selection 
and managing our exposure in a softening market meant we were still able 
to produce a good result across all platforms. Our RoE for the year was  
13.5 per cent, after adjusting for the impact of warrants, and our combined 
ratio was 72.1 per cent. Lancashire contributed 9.3 per cent of that RoE, 
with Cathedral and Kinesis contributing 3.4 per cent and 0.8 per cent 
respectively. We produced a profit after tax of $181.1 million and 
comprehensive income of $169.8 million. Our warrant adjusted  
compound annual return since inception is now 18.8 per cent.

24 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Q Why have your premiums reduced by such a 

significant amount?

Early on in 2014 we expected the market to 
continue to soften. We therefore wrote some 
multi-year deals as a hedge against that. Those 
deals were predominantly in the property 
catastrophe excess of loss, worldwide offshore 
energy and Gulf of Mexico offshore energy lines  
of business. The total multi-year premium in those 
segments in 2014 was $175.3 million. Adjusting for 
that, the reduction in premium was $91.2 million, 
or 12.5 per cent, which is more indicative of the 
pricing trend.

Q How else has the softening market impacted 

performance?

Although pricing has reduced on the inwards 
book, the same is true on the outwards book.  
We have been able to increase our reinsurance 
cover in 2015 without increasing the cost. That  
has allowed us to protect our core book while 
managing our exposures down, which we  
believe is the right thing to do in this market.

As ever in a softening market, we see more losses 
coming through. Thankfully, given our business 
model, we have avoided most of these. There were 
no major catastrophe losses this year, but we did 
have a slightly higher level of mid-sized claims, 
particularly in the energy and satellite lines of 
business. However, reserve releases on prior years, 
particularly for 2014, were substantial as there was 
a general lack of reported claims coming through. 
Our accident year loss ratio was 46.0 per cent and 
our loss ratio was 27.5 per cent.

Q How did the investment market volatility 

affect Lancashire?

There certainly was a lot of volatility throughout 
most of the year. Speculation about the timing  
of the Federal Reserve raising interest rates  
and concerns around China and global growth 
pervaded. But we have been hedging our portfolio 
against rate hikes for some time now and also have 
a small allocation to risk assets which helps to 
hedge the portfolio. Our investment return of  
0.7 per cent for the year reflects that, and is a  
very respectable return in relative terms.

2015 FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

Gross premiums written
Net premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net insurance losses
Net underwriting income
Net investment income
Net realised gains (losses) and impairments
Net operating profit
Profit after tax 
Net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments
Comprehensive income 
Dividends1

Diluted earnings per share
Diluted operating earnings per share
Fully converted book value per share
Return on equity
Return on equity excluding warrant adjustments
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio
Accident year loss ratio 
Net total return on investments2

(1)  Dividends are included in the financial statement year in which they were recorded. 

(2) Net return on investments includes internal foreign exchange hedges. 

2011
$m

2012 
$m

2013 
$m

2014 
$m

2015 
$m

632.3
565.1
574.5
182.3
208.8
43.2
8.6
219.0
212.2
(10.6)
201.6
180.4

$1.20
$1.23
$7.62
13.4%
13.4% 
31.7%
19.6%
12.4%
63.7%
59.3%
1.8%

724.3
576.1
582.6
174.1
289.1
32.5
11.8
220.3
234.9
17.8
252.7
201.4

$1.29
$1.21
$7.83
16.7%
17.1% 
29.9%
20.5%
13.5%
63.9%
34.6%
3.1%

679.7
557.6
568.1
188.1
254.2
25.4
12.6
184.2
222.5
(32.5)
190.0
325.6

$1.17
$0.97
$7.50
18.9%
18.9% 
33.1%
22.1%
15.0%
70.2%
36.1%
0.3%

907.6
742.8
715.6
226.5
335.7
28.6
(5.9)
231.9
229.3
(2.1)
227.2
321.0

$1.16
$1.17
$6.96
13.9%
14.7% 
31.7%
21.4%
15.6%
68.7%
35.9%
1.0%

641.1
481.7
567.1
155.7
265.2
29.8
(2.8)
173.4
181.1
(11.3)
169.8
317.5

$0.91
$0.87
$6.07
10.9%
13.5% 
27.5%
25.8%
18.8%
72.1%
46.0%
0.7%

Q What is the impact on RoE of warrants  

exercised in 2015?

Q How has capital been  
managed in 2015?

We had 18.7 million warrants outstanding at the beginning 
of the year, all expiring on 16 December 2015. As expected, 
these were all exercised during 2015, mostly on a cashless 
basis. The impact of the cashless elections reduced our 
headline RoE by 2.6 per cent. Going forward, our only 
dilutive instruments will be our RSS awards and the impact 
of exercises will be insignificant.

Much the same way as it always has been – we work out what 
business we want to write, then we work out the capital we 
need to support that. We add a buffer and any excess beyond 
that buffer is returned to shareholders. We constantly 
monitor our capital and exposures and adjust our position  
as necessary. We still currently favour special dividends as a 
means of return given our multiple. We returned a total of 
$317.5 million this year, or 187.0 per cent of comprehensive 
income. That's a dividend yield of 17.3 per cent. Including 
dividends declared on 17 February 2016, our capital return 
since inception stands at $2.5 billion. 

Elaine Whelan
Group Chief Financial Officer

www.lancashiregroup.com 

25

PERFORMANCE 
KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATORS

RETURN ON EQUITY*

COMBINED RATIO

TOTAL INVESTMENT RETURN

10.9%

72.1%

DR

5 Year Average

.

4
3
1

.

9
8
1

.

7
6
1

.

9
3
1

.

9
0
1

.

7
3
6

.

9
3
6

.

2
0
7

.

7
8
6

.

1
2
7

0.7%

1
3

.

8
1

.

11

12

13

14

15

11

12

13

14

15

11

12

0
1

.

7
0

.

14

15

3
0

.

13

Aim

The Group’s aim is to provide 
shareholders with a risk-adjusted return 
on equity of 13 per cent in excess of a 
risk-free rate over the insurance cycle.

The Group aims to price its business  
to ensure that the combined ratio  
in any year is less than 100 per cent.

The Group’s primary investment 
objectives are to preserve capital and 
provide adequate liquidity to support  
the Group’s payment of claims and  
other obligations. Within this framework 
we aim for a degree of investment 
portfolio growth.

Measurement

The return on equity is measured by 
management as the internal rate of return 
of the increase in fully converted book 
value per share in the period, adjusted  
for dividends.

The combined ratio is the ratio of costs  
to net earned premium and is a measure 
of an insurance company’s operating 
performance. It is calculated as the sum 
of the loss ratio, the acquisition cost ratio 
and the expense ratio.

Total investment return measures 
investment income and net realised  
and unrealised gains and losses  
produced by the Group’s managed 
investment portfolio.

2015 Performance

Risk Management

Our market in 2015 was almost universally 
in a soft phase. We recognise that whilst 
we have attained very high RoE in the 
recent past, at this stage of the cycle we 
cannot expect to earn such high returns. 
But we continue to focus on getting the 
best risk-adjusted return for our 
shareholders. In 2015 this led us to  
buy more reinsurance and retrocession 
protection to reduce our exposures. 
Warrant exercises reduced our RoE by  
2.6 per cent during 2015.

The stated aim is a long-term goal, 
acknowledging that management expects 
both higher and lower results in the 
shorter term. The cyclicality and volatility 
of the insurance market is expected to be 
the largest driver of this pattern. We seek 
to align our variable remuneration to 
shareholders' interests by having an  
RoE component in this.

*  RoE excluding the impact of warrants in 2015  

was 13.5% (2014: 14.7%)

26 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Whilst the combined ratio in 2015 was 
above the five-year average, it was still  
an excellent result. In the context of a 
softening market and corresponding 
downward pressure on premiums, we 
would expect the loss ratio to increase 
and have increased our attritional  
loss ratio to take account of both  
this and Cathedral’s more  
frequency-oriented portfolio.

In 2015 Lancashire continued to monitor 
risk-on/risk-off volatility and increased 
the allocation to risk assets in the surplus 
portfolio as a hedge against the interest 
rate risk inherent in the significant 
fixed-income portfolio. However, given 
the liquidity and duration needs of the 
business, the composition of the core 
portfolio is unchanged.

The Group’s underwriters assess likely 
losses, using tools such as BLAST and 
BAM, and catastrophe models, and their 
experience and knowledge of past loss 
experience, industry trends and current 
circumstances. This allows them to 
estimate the premiums sufficient to meet 
likely losses and expenses. Peer reviews  
of risks are conducted through the daily 
underwriting call or peer review, 
depending on risk impact, enabling the 
Group to ensure careful risk selection, 
limits on concentration and appropriate 
portfolio diversification. The RRC then 
monitors performance at a portfolio level. 

The investment strategy places an 
emphasis on the preservation of invested 
assets and provision of sufficient liquidity 
for the prompt payment of claims, in 
conjunction with providing a reasonably 
stable income stream. These objectives 
are reflected in the Group’s investment 
guidelines and its conservative asset 
allocation. Management reviews the 
composition, duration and asset 
allocation of the investment portfolio  
on a regular basis in order to respond  
to changes in interest rates and other 
market conditions. 

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN

25.9%

.

6
1
4

DR

.

9
5
2

.

6
1
2

.

3
1
2

PERCENTAGE OF COMPREHENSIVE 
INCOME RETURNED TO 
SHAREHOLDERS

DONATIONS MADE TO THE  
LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION

187.0%

$3.2m

.

0
7
8
1

.

4
1
7
1

.

3
2
5
1

2
3

.

0
3

.

5
2

.

5 Year Average

0
2

.

9
1

.

.

2
4
2

-

.

5
9
8

.

7
9
7

DR

KPI linked to Executive 
Directors’ remuneration. 
For more information 
see pages 71 to 88.

11

12

13

14

15

11

12

13

14

15

11

12

13

14

15

The Group’s aim is to provide an 
attractive risk-adjusted return to 
shareholders over the insurance cycle. 
This is a long-term goal, recognising  
that the cyclicality and volatility of  
both the insurance market and the 
financial markets in general will impact 
management’s ability to maximise the 
share multiple in the immediate term. 

Total shareholder return is measured in 
terms of the internal rate of return of the 
increase/decrease in share price in the 
period, measured in U.S. dollars and 
adjusted for dividends.

The Group aims to carry the right  
level of capital to match attractive 
underwriting opportunities, utilising  
an optimal mix of capital tools. Over  
time, through pro-active and flexible 
capital management across the cycle,  
we aim to generate optimum returns  
for shareholders.

The percentage of comprehensive 
income returned to shareholders equals 
the total capital returned to shareholders 
through dividends and share repurchases 
paid in a given year, divided by the 
Group’s comprehensive income.

Despite the challenging market in  
2015 our share price performed 
extremely well.

In view of the current market outlook 
Lancashire took the decision to return 
surplus capital to shareholders due to  
the lack of opportunities meeting internal 
hurdles. With significant and long-term 
market capital to support our reinsurance 
needs, we were able to improve the 
Group's capital efficiency through  
better pricing and terms on our  
outwards reinsurance purchases.

The Lancashire Foundation was 
established in 2007 with the aim  
of creating a charitable trust for  
the benefit of charitable causes in 
Bermuda, the UK and worldwide.

Money is donated by the Group to  
the Lancashire Foundation ordinarily 
through an annual cash donation and  
by dividends on Lancashire warrants that 
were donated to the Foundation on its 
inception. During 2015 a third-party 
donation of $2.5 million was also facilitated 
(see page 91 for further details).

Charities supported in 2015 included 
charities proposed by staff and by clients 
and brokers. Over 40 charities in total 
were supported financially in Bermuda, 
the UK and around the world. All staff 
had the opportunity to take part in 
volunteering days.

The Lancashire remuneration structure 
and share scheme ensure that staff are 
highly motivated and closely aligned  
to the Group’s goals, and therefore with 
shareholders. Permanent staff are eligible 
to receive RSS awards for which TSR is  
an element of the vesting criteria. The 
participation of employees in the RSS 
ensures that there is a strong focus on 
sustainable long-term shareholder value.

Risk tolerances are set at a level that  
aims to prevent the Group incurring  
losses that would impair its ability to 
operate. The Group’s key capital measure 
is its A.M. Best rating, and a minimum 
rating of A- is considered necessary to 
attract business. In 2015, Lancashire 
maintained its A rating.

The Lancashire Foundation is a  
charity registered in England and  
Wales (registration number 1149184). 
The charity’s trustees are Group 
employees and non-executive Board 
members. The day-to-day operations are 
administered by a Foundation Donations 
Committee, made up of employees from 
across the Group, which operates within 
the specific criteria set for the 
Foundation’s charitable giving.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

27

PERFORMANCE 
UNDERWRITING REVIEW

Paul Gregory
Group Chief Underwriting Officer

KNOWING OUR 
MARKETS, DELIVERING 
CONSISTENT RESULTS

2015 witnessed volatility across the globe with plunging  
oil prices, uncertainty around China and further political 
instability following a rise in war and terrorism related events. 
(Re)insurance is a global industry and these shifts in economic 
and political factors have ramifications in the classes of 
business the Group underwrites, with some classes more  
directly affected than others. This, combined with the 
challenging and softening market conditions, creates  
a landscape that requires careful navigation. The  
Lancashire Group has the underwriting teams, with the 
appropriate client and broker relationships, to do just this.

28 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

PROPERTY REINSURANCE
Mother Nature was kind to the reinsurance industry 
during 2015. There were a number of natural catastrophe 
events including large earthquakes in Nepal, Pakistan, 
India and Afghanistan, plus the most intense storm ever 
recorded in the Western hemisphere, Hurricane Patricia, 
in Mexico. Whilst all of these events sadly led to loss of 
life, the economic impact to the industry was minimal. 
Following this low level of natural catastrophe losses to 
the industry the softening rating trend continued 
through 2015. Loss levels were at historic lows, so the 
rates in all global territories were under pressure, albeit 
the pace of reductions slowed, most noticeably for US 
catastrophe perils. The dynamic between traditional 
markets and alternative ILS capacity providers remained, 
but traditional paper still remains favoured by the 
majority of clients with whom the Group enjoys 
relationships. Across the Group we have strong client  
and broker relationships that have been built up over 
time, and with the benefit of both Lloyd’s and Bermudian 
platforms we are able to offer different products to  
satisfy the varying needs of both clients and brokers.  
It is this that has allowed us to maintain our profitable 
core portfolio. 

PROPERTY DIRECT & FACULTATIVE
The property portfolio is less directly impacted by global 
events than other classes, albeit economic factors 
naturally have some impact on demand. It is the demand 
and supply dynamics of the insurance industry that have  
a more acute effect on this sector, although our portfolio 
is structured in such a way as to help protect us. Our 
portfolio of business underwritten in Syndicate 2010  
is made up of two parts: binding authorities and open 
market risks. Each part has experienced contrasting 
fortunes. In a market where most lines of business are 
under pressure, the binding authority portfolio has held 
up extremely well. Loss activity has been low and rates 
were relatively flat through the first half of the year with 
small reductions during the latter half. The open market 
risks have been under more pressure as a number of 
aggressive competitors competed for market share and 
premium income. In line with the Group’s underwriting 
philosophy, risk selection is paramount and underwriting 
with profitability in mind has been the focus in order to 
navigate this competitive market landscape. An 
abundance of facultative and treaty reinsurance capacity 
allows the underwriting team to trade through this softer 
part of the cycle and protect underwriting margins.

ENERGY 
Without doubt 2015 was ‘the perfect storm’ for the upstream 
energy market. The steep decline in the price of oil directly 
impacted demand for insurance coverage at a time when 
energy market insurance capacity had never been higher.  
It was this supply-demand imbalance that drove a fiercely 
competitive market, with market premiums reducing 
significantly given lower rates and lower client demand. 
Overlying these market conditions were a run of attritional 
losses, which in quantum ultimately outstripped premium  
in the market. Despite this, the Group portfolio held up well. 
Premium income was undoubtedly impacted, but most 
importantly we maintained our positions on our core 
portfolio and the book remained profitable. Having  
the discipline not to chase premium to protect top line 
income was ultimately why our portfolio outperformed  
the market. Under the circumstances this was a considerable 
achievement and, whilst the challenges will continue  
into 2016, the portfolio remains well placed to  
outperform the market. 

MARINE
The volatile commodity market, driven by uncertainty 
around China, has had a direct impact on the marine cargo 
portfolio underwritten in Syndicate 3010 as commodity 
prices have a knock on effect on demand. Despite this, the 
core portfolio has performed well, with the book performing 
in line with expectations, albeit with premiums down given  
it is a commodity based business. Much like the energy  
book, the focus has been on underwriting for profit, not top 
line premium growth, with underwriting discipline being 
maintained. Outside of the cargo market, the other marine 
classes we underwrite have been relatively stable throughout 
2015. The hull, builders' risk and war accounts at Lancashire 
have been remarkably stable from both a pricing and 
demand point of view, with an absence of any significant 
market losses. The Group’s marine portfolio is mature  
and well established and will most likely remain that way  
for the foreseeable future.

AVIATION
Following a turbulent 2014 loss year, the claims in the 
aviation market continued in 2015. Political instability 
continued to bring claims with the tragic loss of the Russian 
Metrojet plane over Egypt, as well as the Germanwings crash 
as a result of pilot suicide. The Group straddles many parts 
of the aviation market with aviation reinsurance written in 
Syndicate 2010, war and general aviation within Syndicate 
3010 and the AV52 and satellite products within Lancashire 
London. In the aviation reinsurance market the larger losses 

in 2014 seem to be long forgotten and those in 2015 have 
had little impact on the market as a whole. Market 
conditions weakened as abundant capacity remained in  
the sector, fuelling competition. In these environments  
risk selection remains key and we have carefully navigated 
the market with our core clients. We continue to build out 
the war and general aviation offering from Syndicate 3010 
carefully and selectively in a challenging marketplace.  
The support from brokers and clients in the first full year  
of underwriting has been appreciated as we build the 
foundations of the portfolio for future years. The AV52 
portfolio remains stable and once again performed 
profitably, despite pressure on rating, given the extremely 
low claims frequency for this class. The satellite market has 
continued to experience a number of losses throughout the 
year, however there has been limited reaction in risk rating. 
As a result, we have shrunk our position in this sub-class as 
the risk reward metrics no longer make larger positions on 
satellite business viable. We remain willing and able to 
increase risk levels in the future, should the risk reward 
dynamic change.

TERRORISM, POLITICAL VIOLENCE AND POLITICAL RISKS
There has been a high frequency of political violence and 
terrorism events throughout the course of 2015 across all 
parts of the globe, from terrorist attacks in Nigeria, Tunisia, 
Turkey and France to airstrikes in Libya, Syria and Yemen. 
Despite the volatile world in which we live, and the 
prevalence of tragic war and terrorism events, there remains 
pricing pressure in all of these classes as, despite the terrible 
loss of life these events bring, the financial cost borne by  
insurers is thus far small. The escalation of incidents does 
however raise awareness of the product, which stimulates 
new demand, and given the pricing levels today the product 
is more affordable and attractive to purchase. The Group 
has been successful in building a core book of business and 
defending that book during 2015 as well as slowly building 
out the portfolio within Syndicate 3010 and at the same time 
avoiding losses and maintaining profitability. The increase  
in broker facilities has been a feature of 2015 which puts 
further pressure on an already competitive market. To date 
we have not entered any facility where we are not in control 
of our underwriting, as we believe we must have complete 
control of our risk selection and exposure management 
which, in an ever more unstable world, is more important 
than ever. Fortunately, given our history, line size, service 
levels and leadership capabilities, we have been  
able to maintain our market position despite the  
increased competition.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

29

PERFORMANCE 
STRONG 
PERFORMANCE

BUSINESS ENVIRONMENT AND OUTLOOK
2015 has been a difficult year for underwriting as we are now firmly  
in the soft phase of the underwriting cycle. But managing the cycle is  
one of the key skills of the Lancashire Group. As a long-standing leader  
in specialty insurance and reinsurance lines, the silver lining of the  
highly competitive market is the ability of the Group to maintain its  
core inwards portfolio while managing net exposures through  
greatly improved pricing, and terms and conditions on the  
outward reinsurance placements.

The market is not without challenges, but the Lancashire business model 
was designed with the knowledge that we have to cater for all phases of 
the cycle. A solid return on equity and an excellent combined ratio have 
been achieved in difficult trading conditions and allowed us to maintain 
our excellent dividend record, based on our continued commitment to 
focusing first on our underwriting and our capital management. With 
market-leading underwriters across all three of our business platforms we 
have defended our core portfolio, reduced exposures where competition 
made returns unacceptable, and maintained our relevance to brokers and 
clients. The work we have done over the last couple of years in adding to 
our underwriting resources reinforces our ability to trade successfully 
through all conditions. 

RENEWAL PRICE INDEX (RPI)
Lancashire’s RPI is an internal methodology that management uses  
to track trends in premium rates on a portfolio of insurance and 
reinsurance contracts. The RPI is calculated on a per contract basis  
and reflects Lancashire’s assessment of relative changes in price, terms, 
conditions and limits on like-for-like renewals only, and is weighted  
by premium volume. The RPI does not include new business and only 
covers business written by LICL and LUK, to offer a consistent basis  
for analysis. The calculation involves a degree of judgement in relation  
to the comparability of contracts and the assessment noted above.  
To enhance the RPI tool, the management of Lancashire may revise  
the methodology and assumptions underlying the RPI, so the trends  
in premium rates reflected in the RPI may not be comparable over time. 
Consideration is only given to renewals of a comparable nature so the  
RPI does not reflect every contract in Lancashire’s portfolio. The future 
profitability of the portfolio of contracts within the RPI is dependent 
upon many factors besides the trends in premium rates.

BUSINESS REVIEW

Hayley Johnston
Chief Underwriting Officer, LUK

Sylvain Perrier
Chief Underwriting Officer, LICL

In a difficult year for 
underwriting, Lancashire  
still achieved a combined 
ratio of 72.1 per cent.

30 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

The following table summarises the RPI figures for the main business classes, excluding the Lloyd’s segment, using 2006 as the base year: 

RPI

Class

Aviation (AV52)
Gulf of Mexico offshore energy
Worldwide offshore energy
Marine
Property retrocession and reinsurance
Terrorism
Combined

UNDERWRITING RESULTS

2006

100
100
100
100
100
100
100

2007

2008

80
80
80
88
97
86
86

69
64
68
80
86
71
76

2009

68
137
84
82
127
66
83

2010

62
139
88
80
121
60
81

2011

59
140
97
79
131
57
83

2012

55
140
100
86
157
55
84

2013

49
136
97
89
152
52
81

2014

44
125
91
91
132
48
76

2015

41
118
81
82
117
43
68

Property 
$m

Energy 
$m

Marine 
$m

Aviation 
$m

Lloyd’s 
$m

Total 
$m

Property 
$m

Energy 
$m

Marine 
$m

Aviation 
$m

Lloyd’s 
$m

Total 
$m

2014

2015

Gross premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio

67.7
57.7

53.2
52.6

239.4
169.7

641.1
263.0
567.1
221.5
9.8% 24.7% 47.8% 62.5% 47.9% 31.7% 10.6% 37.0% 13.8% 57.8% 33.4% 27.5%
11.8% 30.9% 30.7% 18.3% 22.2% 21.4% 18.4% 37.4% 34.2% 26.3% 23.0% 25.8%
18.8%
21.6% 55.6% 78.5% 80.8% 70.1% 68.7% 29.0% 74.4% 48.0% 84.1% 56.4% 72.1%

197.2
171.3

112.0
126.5

247.7
198.2

907.6
715.6

284.3
214.1

36.6
33.4

47.6
37.7

15.6%

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

PREMIUMS
Gross premiums written decreased by 29.4 per cent in 2015 
compared to 2014. The decrease came primarily from the  
property and energy segments where a number of multi-year  
deals written in 2014 are not yet due to renew. Of the total 
reduction of $266.5 million in gross premiums written for 2015, 
non-annual deals in those segments accounted for $175.3 million. 
Excluding the impact of these deals, the reduction for 2015 in 
gross premiums written was $91.2 million or 12.5 per cent. Gross 
premiums earned for the year decreased by 17.2 per cent. The 
Group’s five principal segments, and the key market factors 
impacting them, are discussed below.

PROPERTY
Property gross premiums written decreased by 25.0 per cent for  
the year ended 31 December 2015 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2014. The property retrocession and catastrophe 
excess of loss, terrorism and political books, all saw reductions  
due to the timing of multi-year contract renewals.

ENERGY
Energy gross premiums written decreased by 53.2 per cent for  
the year ended 31 December 2015 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2014. Multi-year contracts in the Gulf of Mexico  
and worldwide offshore books drove the majority of the year  

on year reduction with $65.0 million and $18.6 million  
respectively of multi-year deals written in 2014 not yet due for 
renewal. The remaining reduction was primarily due to pricing 
pressure and exposure reductions given the drop in oil prices.  
The reduction in gross premiums earned in 2015 in the energy 
book of 26.0 per cent is significantly lower than the reduction  
in gross premiums written, reflecting the impact of continued 
earnings on the prior year multi-year deals. While 2015  
gross premiums written have decreased by 53.2 per cent,  
37.2 per cent is due to the impact of multi-year deals.

MARINE
Marine gross premiums written decreased by 29.7 per cent for  
the year ended 31 December 2015 compared to the year ended  
31 December 2014. The decrease is primarily driven by non-annual 
contracts written in 2014 in the marine hull book which are not 
due to renew until 2016. Overcapacity in the market continued  
to put downward pressure on pricing, especially the hull book.

AVIATION
Aviation gross premiums written decreased by 31.2 per cent  
for the year ended 31 December 2015 compared to the year  
ended 31 December 2014 due to the timing of satellite launches  
on contracts written in previous years.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

31

PERFORMANCE 
BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

LLOYD’S
In the Lloyd’s segment gross premiums written decreased  
by 12.9 per cent for the year ended 31 December 2015 
compared to the year ended 31 December 2014. The 
decrease for the year was mainly due to pricing pressure 
across all historic lines of business, slightly offset by growth 
in the terrorism and aviation classes that Cathedral began 
writing in 2014.

CEDED
Ceded premiums decreased by $5.4 million, or 3.3 per cent, 
for the year ended 31 December 2015 compared to the year 
ended 31 December 2014. The overall decrease for the year 
is predominantly due to the restructuring of the Lancashire 
marine, energy and terrorism programmes during the first 
quarter of 2015 at a reduced cost. The saving from the 
restructuring was offset by new cover purchased on the 
political risk book in the second quarter of 2015. Lancashire 
and Cathedral both took advantage of favourable conditions 
in the reinsurance market to buy more limit at a lower 
attachment point for around the same outlay, with the 
overall net decrease in outwards reinsurance spend in the 
year being due to a multi-year programme placed in 2014 
but not yet due for renewal.

EARNED
Net premiums earned as a proportion of net premiums  
written were 117.7 per cent for the year ended  
31 December 2015, compared to 96.3 per cent for the  
year ended 31 December 2014. The increased percentage  
in premiums earned for the year ended 31 December 2015 
compared to the same period in 2014 was due to the impact 
of multi-year deals written in 2014 where we saw the benefit 
of earnings coming through on those deals in 2015.

LOSS DEVELOPMENT BY CLASS

Property
Energy
Marine
Aviation
Lloyd’s
Total

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

ACCIDENT YEAR LOSS RATIOS 

Accident year loss ratio 
Initial accident year loss ratio
Change in loss ratio post-accident year

Note: Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2015.

32 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

LOSSES
The Group’s net loss ratio was 27.5 per cent for the year 
ended 31 December 2015 compared to 31.7 per cent  
for the year ended 31 December 2014. The 2015 accident 
year loss ratio, including the impact of foreign exchange 
revaluations, was 46.0 per cent compared to 35.9 per cent  
for the year ended 31 December 2014. For the year ended  
31 December 2015, there were no significant losses, however, 
we experienced a few mid-sized claims across a number  
of our segments. Attritional losses have otherwise been 
relatively low. In 2014 there were relatively low reported 
losses across all lines, although there was some negative 
development on prior accident year mid-sized marine  
and energy claims.

Prior year favourable development was $107.7 million  
for the year ended 31 December 2015, which was primarily 
driven by general IBNR releases across most lines of business 
plus additional recoveries on our 2011 Thai flood losses. 
This compared to favourable development of $34.4 million 
for the year ended 31 December 2014 where favourable 
development from IBNR releases was offset somewhat by 
adverse development on prior year accident mid-sized 
marine and energy claims. 

The table below provides further detail of the prior years’ 
loss development by class, excluding the impact of foreign 
exchange revaluations:

2011 
$m

63.5
57.3
28.6
5.9
n/a
155.3

2011 
%

56.7
59.3
2.6

2012 
$m

(36.0)
37.4
25.9
0.1
n/a
27.4

2012 
%

30.0
34.6
4.6

2013 
$m

13.2
18.4
(23.4)
(1.4)
9.1
15.9

2013 
%

27.5
36.1
8.6

2014 
$m

19.8
5.4
(9.7)
0.9
18.0
34.4

2014 
%

29.7
35.9
6.2

2015 
$m

26.4
35.2
13.8
2.9
29.4
107.7

2015 
%

46.0
n/a
n/a

Excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, 
previous accident years’ ultimate losses developed as follows 
during 2015 and 2014:

ULTIMATE LOSS DEVELOPMENT BY ACCIDENT YEAR

2006 and prior accident years
2007 accident year
2008 accident year
2009 accident year
2010 accident year
2011 accident year
2012 accident year
2013 accident year
2014 accident year
Total

2014 
$m

1.8
(0.3)
3.6
4.3
5.7
(6.1)
11.1
14.3
n/a
34.4

2015 
$m

1.6
1.1
(2.1)
4.1
(3.5)
17.1
10.8
35.4
43.2
107.7

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

The ratio of IBNR to total net loss reserves was 35.2 per cent 
as at 31 December 2015 compared to 31.6 per cent as at  
31 December 2014.

ACQUISITION COSTS
The acquisition cost ratio was 25.8 per cent for the year 
ended 31 December 2015 compared to 21.4 per cent for 
the year ended 31 December 2014. The increase was largely 
due to profit commission received in relation to Accordion 
that lowered the ratio in 2014, combined with lower earned 
premiums in 2015 and additional reinsurance cover 
purchased during 2015 compared to 2014.

MANAGED INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO ALLOCATIONS

INVESTMENTS, LIQUIDITY AND CASH FLOW
Since inception, the primary objectives for our investment 
portfolio have been capital preservation and liquidity.  
Those objectives remain unchanged, and are more 
important than ever in today’s volatile and reactive markets. 
As market volatility continues, we position our portfolio  
to limit downside risk in the event of market shocks. In 2015, 
our focus has been on managing our interest rate risk, the 
largest risk to our predominantly fixed income portfolio.  
We continue to maintain a short duration fixed income 
portfolio and have been using our risk budget to add 
products to our portfolio to help mitigate a rise in rates.  
We produced a total investment return of 0.7 per cent  
(2014 – 1.0 per cent) for the year. Our average annual total 
investment return since inception is 3.0 per cent, and we 
have made a positive investment return in every year since 
inception, including 2008. Our portfolio mix illustrates our 
conservative philosophy, as shown in the table on page 124. 
With the composition regulated by the Group’s investment 
guidelines, we have three investment portfolio categories: 
‘core’, ‘core plus’ and ‘surplus’. The core portfolio contains 
at least enough funds required to meet near-term obligations 
and cash flow needs following an extreme event. Assets in 
excess of those required to be held in the core portfolio  
may be held in any of the three portfolio categories, which 
are discussed further on page 123. As at 31 December 2015 
and 2014 the managed portfolio was as follows:

Fixed income securities
Cash and cash equivalents
Hedge funds
Equity securities
Total

2014 
%

81.9
10.6
6.8
0.7
100.0

2015 
%

81.6
9.6
8.0
0.8
100.0

Cash
Short-term investments
Fixed income funds
Government debt
Agency debt
Agency MBS, CMBS
Non-agency RMBS, ABS, CMBS
FDIC corporate bonds
Corporate bonds
Bank loans
Fixed income – at FVTPL
Equity securities
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Other investments
Total

2011  
%

2012  
%

2013  
%

 2014  
%

2015  
%

13.2
4.0
–
27.2
4.2
13.2
5.8
2.5
29.9
–
–
–
–
–
100.0

11.1
5.4
–
18.8
6.2
19.2
5.3
–
32.2
1.8
–
–
–
–
100.0

14.7
9.8
1.1
14.6
4.1
10.9
8.4
–
29.7
4.5
1.3
0.7
–
0.2
100.0

10.6
1.4
0.7
21.4
0.8
7.7
11.0
–
31.7
5.8
1.4
0.7
6.8
–
100.0

9.6
1.1
0.6
23.6
0.2
7.3
8.4
–
33.2
5.9
1.3
0.8
8.0
–
100.0

www.lancashiregroup.com 

33

PERFORMANCE 
BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

The composition, duration and asset allocation of the 
investment portfolio are reviewed on a regular basis in order 
to respond to changes in interest rates and other market 
conditions. If certain asset classes are anticipated to produce 
a higher return within management’s risk tolerance an 
adjustment in asset allocation may be made. Conversely,  
if the risk profile is expected to move outside of tolerance 
levels, adjustments may be made to reduce the risk in the 
portfolio. We try to be nimble in our investment strategy 
while putting our objective of capital preservation first and 
foremost. We believe in the application of common sense, 
and do not place much reliance on ‘black box’ approaches 
to investment selection. 

Investments are, however, inherently unpredictable and 
there are risks associated with any investment strategy 
decisions. Recent market history has been tumultuous  
and we remain ever watchful. We will continue to monitor 
the economic environment closely.

INVESTMENT PERFORMANCE 
Net investment income excluding realised and unrealised 
gains and losses, was $29.8 million for the year ended  
31 December 2015, an increase of 4.2 per cent compared  
to 2014. Total investment return, including net investment 
income, net realised gains and losses, impairments and  
net change in unrealised gains and losses, was $14.4 million  
for the year ended 31 December 2015 compared to  
$22.0 million for 2014. The investment portfolio returned  
0.7 per cent in 2015, a good result given the increase in 
treasury yields and the widening of credit spreads during  
the year. For the year ended 31 December 2014, returns were 
generated primarily by a reduction in treasury yields, which 
offset the slight widening of investment grade credit spreads.

LIQUIDITY 
The Group is a short-tail insurance and reinsurance group. 
As such, the investment portfolio must be liquid, short 
duration, and highly credit-worthy. As noted earlier, the 
Group’s investment strategy places an emphasis on the 
preservation of invested assets and provision of sufficient 
liquidity for the prompt payment of claims in conjunction 
with providing a reasonably stable income stream.

Liquid securities will be maintained at an adequate level  
to more than meet expenses, including unanticipated claims 
payments. Only once safety, liquidity, and investment income 
requirements are satisfied, may additional growth in the 
investment portfolio be pursued. Given the current global 
outlook and incessant volatility in the markets, this is 
unlikely to occur in the near future.

CASH FLOW
The Group’s cash inflows are primarily derived from net 
premiums received, from losses recovered from reinsurers, 
from net investment income, including dividends and other 
returns from associates, and any capital raising activities 
performed in a given year including the issuance of debt. 
Excess funds are invested in the investment portfolio, which 
primarily consists of high-quality, highly liquid fixed income 
securities of short duration. Other cash inflows result from 
the sale and redemption of investments. 

The principal outflows for the Group are the settlement  
of claims, the payment of premiums for reinsurance cover, 
payment of general and administrative expenses, the 
servicing of debt, the purchase of investment products, the 
distribution of dividends and the repurchasing of shares. 

In 2015, whilst lower than the prior year, our operating  
cash flow remained strong, driven by the Group’s robust 
underwriting performance. A net positive cash inflow  
arose from operations during the year of $98.1 million  
(2014 – $212.5 million). We have generated positive operating 
cash flows in each year of operation since inception. 

KEY INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO STATISTICS

Duration
Credit quality
Market yield
Book yield

2011

2012

2013

2014

2015

1.8 years
AA–
1.5%
1.9%

1.8 years
AA–
1.1%
1.8%

1.0 year
AA–
1.2%
1.4%

1.5 years
AA–
1.5%
1.5%

1.5 years
AA–
1.9%
1.6%

34 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

ASSOCIATES
The $4.1 million share of profit of associate for the year 
ended 31 December 2015, reflects Lancashire’s 10 per cent 
interest in KHL. The share of profit of associates was  
$5.9 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 and 
related to the Kinesis vehicle and the remaining interest  
in the Accordion and Saltire vehicles. Third-party capital  
is discussed on page 38.

OTHER OPERATING EXPENSES

Employee salaries and benefits
Employment taxes 
on equity compensation
Other operating expenses
Amortisation of intangible assets
Total

2014 
$m

55.3

(1.2)
48.8
8.4
111.3

2015 
$m

61.6

2.7
42.3
–
106.6

Employee remuneration costs for the year ended  
31 December 2015 were $6.3 million higher than the same 
period in 2014. With the recent announcement of the 
incumbent CEO and CFO of Cathedral leaving the Group, 
an additional compensation expense has been recorded.  
A slight increase in headcount and an increase in year end 
bonus and profit related pay provisions, due to underlying 
performance, also led to increased salaries and benefits  
for the year. The year ended 31 December 2014 included  
a reversal of national insurance accruals in relation to  
equity compensation exercises driven by both the timing  
of exercises and fluctuations in the share price.

Other operating expenses were lower for the year ended  
31 December 2015 compared to the same period in 2014 
primarily due to reduced donations by the Group to the 
Lancashire Foundation, as the Foundation had sufficient 
funds to meet its goals in the current year. In addition, some 
legal and consulting costs were incurred in 2014 in relation 
to the retirement of the previous CEO. The amortisation of 
intangible assets arising on the acquisition of Cathedral was 
completed in the third quarter of 2014 and there was no 
further amortisation in 2015.

Equity based compensation expenses were $15.8 million  
for the year ended 31 December 2015 and $23.3 million  
for the year ended 31 December 2014. The equity  
based compensation charge is driven by the anticipated 
vesting level of the active awards based on current 
performance expectations.

CAPITAL MANAGEMENT
Lancashire has built a reputation for being one of the best 
known and most active proponents of capital management 
in the industry. Capital management is our most important 
area of focus after underwriting and it is our firm belief that 
pro-active and flexible capital management is crucial in 
helping to generate a superior risk-adjusted return over 
time. With our focus on maximising shareholder return  
we will return capital where this offers the best returns  
for our shareholders. We have returned 103.6 per cent  
of comprehensive income generated via dividends or  
share repurchases since inception.

The Group actively reviews the level and composition of 
capital on an ongoing basis. Internal methods have been 
developed to review the profitability of classes of business 
and their estimated capital requirements plus the capital 
requirements of the combination of a wide range of other 
risk categories. The key aim of the capital management 
process is to maintain a strong balance sheet, whilst:

•  maintaining sufficient capital for underwriting 

opportunities and to meet obligations to policyholders;

•  maximising the risk-adjusted return to shareholders  

within predetermined risk tolerances; 

•  maintaining adequate financial strength ratings; and 

•  meeting internal, regulatory and rating agency 

requirements.

The subsidiary operating entities also conduct capital 
requirement assessments under internal measures and in 
compliance with local regulatory and Lloyd's requirements. 

Capital raising can include debt or equity, and returns of 
capital may be made through dividends, share repurchases,  
a redemption of debt or any combination thereof. All capital 
actions require approval by the Board of Directors. The 
retention of earnings generated also leads to an increase  
in capital.

The composition of capital is driven by management’s 
appetite for leverage, amongst other factors, including  
the cost and availability of different types of capital. 

Maintaining a strong balance sheet will be the overriding 
factor in all capital management decisions. Solvency II,  
a new regulatory regime for (re)insurance in the European 
Economic Area, introduced a new basis for assessing capital 
which was effective from 1 January 2016. The Group  
is confident that it is more than adequately capitalised  
for supervisory and regulatory purposes under the  
Solvency II regime.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

35

PERFORMANCE 
WARRANTS
All outstanding warrants to purchase the Company’s 
common shares which were issued at inception were 
exercised prior to their expiry on 16 December 2015. 
Warrants exercised during the year are shown below.

LETTERS OF CREDIT
Lancashire has a standard syndicated LOC facility which  
in total amounts to $350.0 million, with a $75.0 million loan 
sub-limit available for general corporate purposes. Syndicate 
2010 and Syndicate 3010 each have a catastrophe facility  
in place to assist in paying claims and gross funding  
of catastrophes. These facilities amount to a combined 
$100.0 million with a total of $50.0 million available  
by way of LOCs and $50.0 million by way of RCFs.

There was no outstanding debt under the above facilities  
at any reporting date. There are no off-balance sheet forms 
of capital.

BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

CAPITAL
As at 31 December 2015, total capital available to the  
Group was $1.542 billion, comprising shareholders’  
equity of $1.220 billion and $322.3 million of long-term 
debt. Tangible capital was $1.388 billion. Leverage was  
20.9 per cent on total capital and 23.2 per cent on total  
tangible capital. Total capital and total tangible capital  
as at 31 December 2014 were $1.683 billion and  
$1.530 billion respectively.

DIVIDENDS
During 2015, the Lancashire Board declared a final dividend 
of $0.10 and a special dividend of $0.50 per common share 
in respect of the 2014 financial year and an interim dividend 
of $0.05 and special dividend of $0.95 per common share in 
respect of 2015. With the final dividend in respect of 2015  
of $0.10 per common share, total capital returns since 
inception amount to $2.5 billion, or 210.9 per cent of initial 
capital raised. The final dividend of $0.10 per common share 
has been declared and will be paid on 23 March 2016 to  
the shareholders of record on 26 February 2016.

NON PRE-EMPTIVE ISSUE OF SHARES
As part of the Group’s flexible approach to capital 
management the Board has in recent years requested  
and received from shareholders authority to issue up to  
15 per cent of its shares on a non pre-emptive basis. 
Lancashire believes that this ability to raise capital quickly  
is important in securing first mover advantage in the 
catastrophe insurance and reinsurance business which it 
underwrites. The Board proposes to put a similar request for 
authority to shareholders in a resolution at the 2016 AGM to 
be held on 4 May 2016.

WARRANTS

Outstanding and exercisable  
as at 31 December 2014
Exercised during the year
Outstanding and exercisable  
as at 31 December 2015

Number of 
Management Team 
Performance 
warrants

Number of 
Management Team 
Ordinary warrants 

Number of  
Founder warrants

Number of 
Lancashire 
Foundation 
warrants

Number of 
Ordinary warrants

Total Number of  
warrants

117,480
(117,480)

559,182
(559,182)

15,032,679
(15,032,679)

648,143
(648,143)

2,350,000
(2,350,000)

18,707,484
(18,707,484)

–

–

–

–

–

–

36 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Lawrence Holder
Managing Director, CUL

Key financial information for Cathedral for  
the year ended 31 December is as follows:

Gross premiums written
Net premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net insurance losses
Net underwriting income
Other income
Profit after tax
Comprehensive income

Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio1
Combined ratio1

2014
$m

284.3
219.4
214.1
102.5
64.1
10.1
25.7
25.4

47.9%
22.2%
15.0%
85.1%

2015
$m

247.7
196.4
198.2
66.2
86.4
7.0
46.0
45.6

33.4%
23.0%
17.2%
73.6%

(1)  The expense ratio in Cathedral’s financial statements is presented net  
of fees, commissions and other non-investment income. On this basis  
the combined ratio for 2015 is 71.0 per cent compared to 81.5 per cent  
for 2014.

CATHEDRAL

2015 has seen a continuation of the deteriorating trading environment set against 
a benign claims experience that has prevailed since the start of 2013. The main 
distinction between this year and last has been a change in focal point in the 
market, where both trading pressure and losses have fallen. Competitive emphasis 
has moved from property reinsurance to the direct lines of business, as companies 
look to supplement income lost across their reinsurance portfolios. Despite the 
challenging market, during 2015 Cathedral has contributed to the Group's top and 
bottom line, with strong premium retention and excellent underwriting profits.  
We have been working hard to maintain our accounts in a shape where we believe 
we have a reasonable chance of a profitable outcome, assuming that we return  
to a more frequent and severe claims environment than we have had of late. 

Syndicate 2010 has suffered a small loss of top line income but our net position 
has been mitigated by our ability to purchase cost effective reinsurance that  
has lowered our retentions while our overall exposures have remained stable.

The position of each of our underwriting teams within their markets has  
enabled them to deliver a good quality book of business in a challenging year.  
We continue to get presented with good business opportunities at the behest  
of clients and brokers, but naturally we trade within oversubscribed market  
places and have been forced to decline business, some of it very long standing 
where we believe market pricing no longer holds out sufficient prospect of a 
profit. Such disciplined underwriting involves hard choices, but is essential in  
the current market.

Although 2014 was all about competition in the property reinsurance account,  
in 2015 the biggest pressures have been in the open market direct insurance 
book and the aviation reinsurance book. Both have seen additional players 
shoehorning themselves into already oversubscribed markets, offering capacity  
at prices our underwriters do not feel offers much prospect of profit, much of  
the time within new rationalised coverage structures, where brokers and clients  
are looking to maximise the value they can get.

Syndicate 3010’s core cargo account ebbs and flows with world trade and 
commodity pricing but, outside that, the rest of our accounts are all operating  
in very tough conditions. Both the direct aviation and aviation war markets are 
heavily oversubscribed and blighted by the presence of broker lineslips corralling 
significantly more capacity than is required. We have preferred to plough our 
own furrow, offering open market leading expertise with the support of some 
notable players in the Lloyd’s market on whose behalf we underwrite. We now 
have an established presence and a good quality trading portfolio from which  
to build in the future.

Our terror and energy accounts have also had to contend with challenging 
market conditions created by over-capacity in general, and more specifically 
broker facilities in the terrorism market and for energy a reduction in demand 
from the industry on the back of falling oil prices. Despite these challenging 
conditions, the foundations set when we established the accounts in 2014,  
and the leverage the Group’s position in these markets provides, has allowed 
these portfolios to develop in a measured way.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

37

PERFORMANCE 
BUSINESS REVIEW CONTINUED

Darren Redhead
Chief Executive Officer, Kinesis

The Kinesis  
multi-class  
approach continues  
to find attractive 
opportunities and 
offers investors 
superior returns.

38 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 KINESIS AND 
THIRD-PARTY CAPITAL

Kinesis was launched in 2013 and is the vehicle for the development of 
Lancashire’s strategy to build partnerships with capital market participants. 
It gives the Group the opportunity to leverage its underwriting expertise, 
whilst affording flexibility in the management and deployment of its own 
capital. During 2015, Kinesis deployed $299.5 million of limits of fully 
collateralised reinsurance protection through its unique, multi-class  
product offering for $62.9 million of net premiums written. Since  
inception to the end of 2015 Kinesis has deployed combined aggregate  
limits of $639.5 million for $140.7 million of net premiums written and 
offers investors both superior returns and a high level of diversification.

Lancashire’s subsidiary KCML receives underwriting fees on all net 
premiums written by Kinesis Re, generating a stable stream of fee  
income, in addition to potential profit commissions. LHL also holds a  
10.0 per cent stake in KHL, which is treated as an associate for accounting 
purposes. Lancashire’s share of KHL’s results is reflected as an equity  
pick up in the consolidated financial statements.

Financial information for the year ended 31 December is as follows:

Kinesis

Saltire

Accordion

Total

2015 
$m

2014 
$m

2015 
$m

2014 
$m

2015 
$m

2014 
$m

2015 
$m

2014 
$m

Profit commission
Underwriting fees
Equity pick up

7.3
5.6
4.1

–
6.2
4.7

–
–
–

3.0
–
0.1

–
–
–

6.7
–
1.1

7.3
5.6
4.1

9.7
6.2
5.9

Note: LHL owned 92.68 per cent of KCML at 31 December 2015.

ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT

Louise Wells
Chief Risk Officer

ENTERPRISE RISK 
MANAGEMENT

The fundamental principle of the  
Group’s approach to ERM is that risk 
management should be embedded in the 
processes and procedures that we use to 
run our business every day. This has not 
changed. However in 2015, we have had 
a busy, yet successful year embedding  
the Solvency II related processes and 
procedures developed in 2014 into  
our business as usual processes. We are 
confident that we continue to have a clear 
view of our risks, and their management, 
right across the Group.

ERM DEVELOPMENTS
With the introduction of Solvency II on 1 January 2016 we worked  
closely with the BMA (our former Group supervisor) to effect an orderly 
transition to the PRA, who became our Group supervisor on that date. 
During 2015, we successfully submitted our first supervisory reporting  
to the PRA under the Solvency II preparatory phase guidelines.

At the Group level, the ORSA Working Group, created in 2014, has been 
replaced by the RROC with the remit to “support the Board in reviewing 
Solvency II and other regulatory and public reporting outputs on the 
Board's behalf and, to the extent permitted by in force regulatory 
requirements, approving these for release”. The RROC consists of at  
least two Non-Executive Directors from the LHL Board who will rotate 
every two years, the Group CEO, Group CFO and CRO. An equivalent 
committee also operates at the LUK level as LUK is also PRA regulated. 

The RROC allows the Non-Executive Directors to carry out a more 
detailed review of the ORSA process and procedures and to contribute 
directly to the point-in-time report given to our regulators outside of  
the constraints of the Board’s calendar.  

In 2015, the Group:

•  Completed its scheduled RRC reviews of the underlying  

ORSA framework elements and an internal audit of the capital  
modeling process.

•  Further developed the documentation and formalisation of policies  
and procedures underpinning the broader system of governance in 
accordance with the relevant Solvency II preparatory phase guidance.

•  Provided further training and development to both relevant boards  

and senior management in order to validate understanding and embed 
engagement in the ORSA process.

•  Further developed the stress, scenario and reverse stress testing processes 

to include input from the Non-Executive Directors at the scenario 
selection stage. The process also now includes stress testing the SCR. 

•  Commenced the implementation of a new governance and risk portal  

to enhance the ERM process. 

•  Fully embedded our suite of capital and solvency measures, including 
Solvency II metrics, into business as usual monitoring through RRC 
review and quarterly CRO reporting.

•  Submitted a Group ORSA point-in-time report to the PRA including  
an assessment of the appropriateness of the standard formula for 
Lancashire’s risk profile and a comparison to BLAST.

•  Ensured Cathedral maintained its ‘Green’ rating by Lloyd’s in relation  

to the Lloyd’s Solvency II regime. This has included submissions  
and procedural and process documentation for the internal model, 
submission of an ORSA and overall compliance with the Lloyd’s  
risk framework.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

39

PERFORMANCE 
ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT CONTINUED

ERM & ORSA 

KEY ACTIVITIES

•  Review of business strategy with challenge from Board

•  Production of ORSA report

•  CRO report to Board and 
Executive Management 
Committee

•  Capital and liquidity 

management frameworks

•  Review of BLAST policies, 

capital and solvency appetites

•  Full/proxy capital assessments 

•  Rating agency capital 

assessments

•  Stress and scenario testing

STRATEGY REVIEW  
& CHALLENGE

•  Risk ID and assessment

•  Quarterly risk and control 

affirmations

RISK SOLVENCY &  
ASSESSMENT

C U LTURE &

RISK ID &  
ASSESSMENT

RRCRRC
RRC
OVERN A N C E

G

CAPITAL 
MANAGEMENT

RISK & BUSINESS  
MANAGEMENT

BUSINESS  
PLANNING

RISK APPETITE &  
TOLERANCES

•  Review of risk strategy  
and ‘attitude to risk’

•  Review of risk appetite and limits

•  Review of Group risk tolerances

•  Review of risk management 

•  Review and approval  

policies

of business plan

•  Assessment of risk management  

•  Stress and scenario testing 

framework maturity

(business plan)

•  Integrated assurance assessment

•  Assessment of management 

•  Emerging risk assessment

actions

Key Elements of ORSA

Board sign-off and embedding

Business Strategy

Risks

Capital and Solvency

Stress and Scenario Testing

RRC
The RRC, under the Chairmanship of the Group CEO,  
is the key management tool for monitoring and challenging 
the assessment of risk on a continual basis. The RRC  
agenda is reviewed each year to ensure its activities  
remain appropriate and aligned with the business cycle. 

BLAST
We continue to challenge the assumptions used  
in BLAST and make changes where appropriate. 

EMERGING RISK
As ever in 2015, the Group strove to foresee potential areas 
of new risk, or developments in existing risks that could 
threaten the Group. We continue to monitor cyber risk 
carefully, both in our operating exposure, where through 
our lack of retail clients and limited holding of our own 
employees' personal data we present a low risk profile, and 
through our inwards insurance risk. Terrorism is an area of 
core business focus for Lancashire, and is well understood, 
but the continued increase in diversity of targets and modes 
of attack from terrorist groups means we maintain a watch 
on developing trends.

40 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
RISK UNIVERSE
We continue to classify risks in three broad classes:

•  Intrinsic Risk: ‘Risk that stems from the inherent 

randomness and uncertainty that exists in the universe  
in which we operate and that is therefore fundamental  
to how we manage our business’. This is the risk we accept 
as inherent in the core functions of our business; so we 
recognise that by insuring fortuitous events we can suffer 
losses, and by investing premiums and other assets we can 
see the value of those investments fall. We cannot avoid 
these risks so we focus on the correlated operational risks 
and seek to mitigate them. So, for example, we know that by 
insuring the risk of earthquake we are exposed to the risk 
that losses exceed our plan. We model our portfolio using 
stochastic modeling to review actual and planned exposures 
to ensure they remain within tolerances. The correlated 
risks are that we might fail to design or maintain effective 
tolerances and limits, and fail to maintain exposures within 
such limits; or that we fail to keep accurate and timely 
records of our exposures. We then devise systems and 
processes to mitigate these risks, such as PML 
reconciliations, and RDS sign-offs.

•  Operational Risk: ‘The potential for specific losses arising  

as a result of inadequate or failed internal processes, 
personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events’. 
Risks that are operational in causation can be split into  
two sub-categories in terms of how they crystallise:

 – Independent: risks that have the potential to crystallise 
independently from intrinsic risk. For example, losses 
arising through the imposition of fines as a result of a 
regulatory breach, so unrelated to our core functions.

 – Correlated: risks that relate to the failure to effectively 

operate the processes designed to manage intrinsic risk, 
and therefore have the potential to amplify its impact 
beyond that modeled. For example, increased reinsurer 
default losses arising through the use of non-approved 
counterparties. 

•  Other Risk: This is the more nebulous category of risks such 
as reputational risk or communication risk which cannot 
necessarily be mitigated by holding capital since they  
may not have direct balance sheet implications. These  
are included within the risk register and are assessed  
and mitigated through scenario and stress testing.

RISK UNIVERSE

Type

Category

Description

e
r
o
C

c
i
s
n
i
r
t
n
I

l
a
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
O

r
e
h
t
O

Underwriting 
Investment

Reserving  
(Re)Insurance 
counterparty 
Liquidity

Operational

Intrinsic risks representing the potential to generate a return as well as a loss.

In these areas, the Group promotes informed risk taking that considers the risk and 
return equation in all major decisions, with the intention of maximising risk-adjusted 
return on equity.

Intrinsic risks to which we are inevitably exposed as a result of conducting  
our day-to-day business operations yet offer no direct potential for return.

They are quantified insofar as practicable for the purposes of capital and risk 
management and avoided or minimised insofar as is economically justifiable.

These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal processes,  
personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events. 

They have the potential to either magnify the adverse impacts of intrinsic risks  
or crystallise separately in their own right.

Strategic Group  
Emerging

These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but for which a structured 
approach is still required to ensure that their potential impact is considered and 
mitigated insofar as is practicable.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

41

PERFORMANCE 
PRINCIPAL RISKS

PRINCIPAL RISKS

As described under our review of the Risk Universe, our 
classification of risks as Intrinsic Core and Intrinsic Non-
Core, Operational and Other, helps us to focus on our 
management and mitigation of those risks. Within BLAST 
insurance risk accounts for over 80 per cent of the allocated 
risk capital, so this is clearly the principal area where we 
stringently apply controls and reviews. For example, we place 
a large number of controls around monitoring risk levels 

across the business. However, we understand that even risks 
that do not generate a capital charge under an economic 
capital model can pose serious threats to the execution of 
the business plan and strategy, and therefore need to be 
monitored and tested. For example, we spend a lot of time 
looking at the implications of emerging capital and the 
evolution of the market cycle.

INTRINSIC RISK: CORE

TYPE
Underwriting: Losses in our classes are hard to predict as to the 
specifics of timing and quantum of occurrence. Additionally, we 
write lines of business that are subject to accumulations, including 
accumulations of individual risks in a single event such as several 
property catastrophe excess of loss programmes being affected by  
a windstorm or earthquake, and accumulations between business 
lines such as a 9/11 type event impacting both the terrorism and 
AV52 portfolios. Losses can also exceed expectations in terms of 
both frequency and severity. So, although we model losses, for 
example using the RMS and AIR stochastic models, we know  
that these projections can and will be wrong in many instances.

Investment: We need to hold sufficient assets in readiness to pay 
claims, but the markets and products in which we invest can suffer 
volatility and losses. As a short-tail insurer, we are able to hold the 
majority of assets in low duration securities such as fixed income 
bonds. However, this creates an additional source of risk in the 
current environment, where there is a considerable risk from 
changes to interest rates as quantitative easing programmes may 
begin to taper or be increased. We model our investment portfolios 
and use various stress scenarios to see what kinds of losses we could 
expect under a range of outcomes.

INTRINSIC RISK: NON-CORE

TYPE
Reserving: Because we do not know the amount of losses we  
are going to incur at the outset of a contract, we have to make 
estimates of the reserves we need to hold to pay claims. If these 
reserves are inadequate and claims exceed them, this may have an 
impact on earnings, or indeed capital. We use regular independent 
external reviews of our reserves which look at the overall levels of 
expected losses, as well as individual large events, including 
benchmarking analyses.

MITIGATION
Modeling: We apply loads to, and stress test, stochastic models and 
develop alternative views of losses using exposure damage ratios.

RRC: The RRC considers accumulations, clashes and 
parameterisation of losses and models.

Capital: We set our internal capital requirements at a level  
that allows for buffers above accumulations of extreme events.

Investment strategy: Our strategy is that investment income is not 
expected to be a significant driver of our returns. Our primary 
focus remains on underwriting as the engine of profits.

IRRC: The IRRC forms an integral part of our risk management 
framework, meeting at least quarterly and reporting to the  
RRC quarterly.

External advisers: Lancashire’s Board and management recognise 
that the Group’s principal expertise lies in underwriting so we use 
the services of internationally recognised investment managers  
who are experts in their fields.

MITIGATION
Short-tail business: Lancashire’s focus is on short-tail lines of 
business where losses are usually known within, or shortly after,  
the policy period with a reasonable degree of certainty. 

Experience data: We have access to a lot of data, both our own and 
from the industry as a whole, about losses and loss trends. Actuarial 
and statistical data is used to set estimates of future losses, and 
these are reviewed by underwriters, claims staff and actuaries  
to ensure that they reflect the actual experience of the business. 

External review: Insurers typically facilitate an independent, 
external review of their loss reserves. Lancashire retains the 
services of one of the leading industry experts, and our appetite  
is defined so as to set reserves within a range of reasonable 
estimates based on both internal and external review. 

42 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

INTRINSIC RISK: NON-CORE CONTINUED

TYPE
Reinsurance and intermediary counterparty: Almost all our risks 
are brought to us by brokers, who act as an intermediary between 
us and the client and handle the transaction of payments of claims 
and premiums on our behalf. This exposes us to the risk of 
mishandling by, or failure of, the broker concerned. In order  
to make our portfolio as efficient as possible, we buy reinsurance  
to protect against severity, frequency and accumulation of losses. 
Again, this exposes us to the risk that our counterparties may  
have the inability or unwillingness to pay us in the event of a loss. 

MITIGATION
Counterparty credit limits: We use counterparty limits, seek  
to deal with reputable reinsurers and use collateral agreements 
where appropriate. The operating entities of the Group that 
contract for reinsurance separately, maintain and report their  
own counterparty credit limits at the entity level. The RSC is 
responsible for approving counterparties and monitoring 
aggregate limits. We have terms of business agreements with  
all our counterparties that seek to limit our exposure. All 
reinsurers must conform to minimum rating standards or  
collateral arrangements where appropriate.

Liquidity: In order to satisfy claims payments we need to ensure 
that sufficient assets are held in a readily realisable form. This 
includes holding cash accounts for the expected level of attritional 
losses, as well as ensuring we can meet claims payment 
requirements in extreme events.

Portfolio management: The Group maintains liquidity significantly 
in excess of the Board agreed tolerances. This is achieved through 
the maintenance of a highly liquid portfolio of short duration  
and high creditworthiness. We monitor this through the use  
of stress tests and mitigate risks through the quality of the 
investments themselves.

OPERATIONAL

TYPE
These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal 
processes, personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events. 
They have the potential either to magnify the adverse impacts of 
intrinsic risks or crystallise separately in their own right. This can 
encompass IT availability, where the failure of an IT system, such  
as our underwriting system, could impact our ability to maintain 
accurate and up-to-date records of our exposure. If correlated  
with an insurance loss this could cause us to breach insurance  
risk tolerances. It could also encompass IT integrity, where  
an unauthorised intruder could alter data in our systems,  
or introduce a bug that would corrupt the system.

OTHER

TYPE
These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but  
for which a structured approach is still required to ensure that 
their potential impact is considered and mitigated insofar  
as practicable. They include categories such as Strategic,  
Group and Emerging Risks. 

MITIGATION
Capacity: We mitigate IT availability risk by adding redundancy to 
the capacity we need and using backups of data including off-site 
storage that we test regularly.

Testing and access: We mitigate the integrity risk by using 
independent external penetration tests, and by restricting access  
to key systems to only those people who are qualified and need  
to use them.

Personnel: We mitigate the risks associated with staff retention  
and key-man risk through a combination of resource planning 
processes and controls. Examples include targeted retention 
packages, documented position descriptions and employment 
contracts, resource monitoring and the provision of appropriate 
compensation and training schemes.

MITIGATION
Qualitative approach: These risks require a qualitative approach, 
engaging staff in appropriate discussions about sources of risk, and 
then thinking about possible outcomes. The Group Executive 
Committee and the RRC consider these issues, and the reports 
made by the CRO to the Board include standing items on 
Emerging Risk.

Revision of Attritional Loss Ratio: Lancashire has responded to the 
downturn in the market cycle by revising the expected attritional 
loss ratios to account for the changes to pricing and coverage.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

43

PERFORMANCE 
CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY

SUPPORTING COMMUNITIES – 
OUR RESPONSIBILITY TO OTHERS

WHY CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY IS IMPORTANT TO LANCASHIRE
Lancashire strives to be a responsible employer and a good corporate citizen supportive of the 
communities in which we operate. We recognise the need to balance the responsibilities we owe  
to our stakeholders such as shareholders, regulators, staff and clients with our responsibilities  
to society as a whole. The insurance business by its nature seeks to provide support to those  
afflicted by the unexpected, but we recognise that many communities and businesses around  
the world cannot afford, or do not have access to, the right kind of insurance. So we use our  
talents and resources, our people, time and money to support those who are in distress or at  
a disadvantage. We do this principally through our Foundation, which supports a number  
of excellent charities, both through grant making and encouraging volunteering by our staff,  
to whom we provide up to a week of annual charity leave after an initial period of employment. 

OUR APPROACH
Corporate responsibility is an integral part of Lancashire’s 
approach to its business. We limit the negative impact of our 
carbon footprint through mitigation strategies and offsets, 
and we try to improve the world around us in positive ways 
such as the donations by the Foundation and the allocation  
of staff charity days to work on local improvement projects.  
As well as the direct benefits, we believe that Lancashire 
reaps indirect benefits in terms of its attraction as an ethical 
and compassionate employer, and the positive team-building 
benefits of the activities undertaken. In terms of governance, 
the LHL Board sets the policy for corporate donations to  
the Foundation and reviews reports on its activities (and  
is represented directly by a Non-Executive Director as one  
of the Foundation’s Trustees). The LHL Board also sets  
the policy for the execution of the HR function, and  
the environmental impact of the business. The day-to-day 
activities of the Foundation are delegated to a Donations 
Committee comprised entirely of staff members from across 
our operating platforms, which monitors and reports on the 
activities of the charities to which donations are made.

During 2015, the UK government introduced legislation 
requiring qualifying companies to publish details of how 
they respond to the problem of modern slavery. Lancashire 
has a relatively low headcount (less than 200 employees 
globally), all of whom are remunerated on a basis which 
comfortably exceeds UK minimum wage requirements.  
In the ancillary services and limited supply chains used by 
the Group, Lancashire seeks to receive assurance that its 
service providers pay a living wage. Concerns over human 
rights issues with insureds and potential clients are addressed 
as part of the underwriting process. The Board has also 
recently approved a statement addressing modern slavery 
and human trafficking concerns, which can be found on  
the Lancashire website.

We focus on the following four areas:

•  Community (see page 45)

•  Environment (see page 47)

•  Marketplace (see page 48)

•  Workplace (see page 48)

44 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

COMMUNITY
We remain strongly committed to engaging with our local 
communities in Bermuda and London and continue to 
support local initiatives and activities across the network, 
through partnerships with schools, local government and 
local businesses. 

OUR APPROACH
We support our communities through the Foundation by 
making donations to locally based charities and through our 
staff charity day release programmes and charity leave. In 
2015, we donated funds to a number of charities providing 
activities and care to disadvantaged children in London 
during the summer holidays. In Bermuda we continue to 
sponsor a morning fresh fruit programme for primary school 
children, and have from time to time held staff raffles, bake 
sales and other fundraising efforts.

OUR FOCUS AREAS 
We focus on victims of disasters and those who are 
disadvantaged and excluded whether through lack of 
opportunity, lack of resources or just in need of a helping  

$15.5m

donated by the Lancashire 
Foundation since inception.

hand. As our business is in part based on 
insuring against natural disasters we know 
very well how disruptive they can be, so the 
largest Foundation donation is to Médecins 
Sans Frontières (MSF), who provide 
immediate aid in crisis situations (both 
natural and man-made) right across the 
globe. The Foundation has made significant 
financial commitments to charities that 
support families in crisis (Family Centre) and children  
with autism (Tomorrow’s Voices) in Bermuda, and charities 
supporting ex-offenders throughout the UK (St Giles Trust), 
and a poverty relief programme in the Philippines (ICM). 
But we also support them in other ways, for instance 
renovating premises for Tomorrow’s Voices, mentoring  
staff members for St Giles Trust and sending volunteers  
on week-long service missions to ICM. 

We also make donations to charities suggested by staff and 
indeed by clients and brokers. In 2015, we supported RP 
Fighting Blindness, Pancreatic Cancer UK, Back Up Trust, 
Batten Disease Family Association, War Child, School of 
Hard Knocks and The Brain Tumour Charity, all at the 
suggestion of our business partners, helping to build the 
sense of an insurance community in Bermuda and London.

EMPLOYEE ENGAGEMENT
We recognise that the energy and talents of the people  
of Lancashire can make a difference in a number of ways, 
and that our charitable partnerships offer a valuable way  
to channel these generous instincts. We provide day release 
programmes for staff to give back to the communities in 
which they live and around the world. In addition, staff  

are entitled to up to a week’s annual charity leave on 
completion of three years' permanent employment with  
the Group, which they can spend with a charity of their 
choice or with an existing Foundation-supported entity.  
The Lancashire Foundation also operates a charity  
matching scheme to support individual staff members' 
charitable initiatives. During 2015 such matched funds  
from the Foundation amounted to $25,033 and supported 
12 charities.

CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY IN ACTION

The Family Centre

“Having just completed our 25th anniversary year, we look 
back over the years and are overwhelmed with gratitude for all 
of the supporters who have contributed to our many milestones. 
The funding from Lancashire has been instrumental in 
assisting us to provide consistent counselling support to the 
highest risk families in Bermuda. This incredible, reliable 
support led us to choose Lancashire as our Donor of the Year  
for 2014. In 2015, in addition to their incredibly generous 
donation, they also purchased a new van for our organisation!

Family Centre’s core mission and services are aimed at helping 
families to get back on track to ensure a brighter future for their 
children. We do this through our intensive counselling services, 
training and community programmes.There is a powerful quote 
that has always resonated with me: 'One hundred years from 
now, it will not matter what kind of car I drove, what kind of 
house I lived in, how much was in my bank account, nor what 
my clothes looked like. But the world may be a little better because 
I was important in the life of a child.' With Lancashire’s help,  
I believe we are achieving this.

Thank you for your incredible commitment and meaningful 
investment which is helping us to make a difference in the lives 
of vulnerable children and their families all across Bermuda.”

Martha Dismont, 
Executive Director, The Family Centre

From left to right: Elaine Whelan, Martha Dismont and Jennifer Wilson with the van 
donated by the Lancashire Foundation in 2015.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

45

PERFORMANCE 
CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY CONTINUED

CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY IN ACTION

Project Transform

Every year, since 2010, six to eight employees from across  
the Group volunteer to travel to the Philippines and work 
alongside ICM for a week providing aid and support to  
those living in ultra-poverty. The 2015 Project Transform 
volunteers have reflected on their experience and 
summarised their thoughts below: 

“The general feeling amongst the team before we set off was that the 
trip would provide a morale building and motivational opportunity 
that would enrich and challenge our day-to-day lives. However, the 
experiences that we had were much more profound; witnessing the 
work of ICM in the communities that we encountered and who 
briefly, and so kindly, let us into their lives, took us well outside  
of our individual and collective comfort zones. 

We worked with communities for whom the opportunities that we 
take for granted – of education, shelter and aspirations – are not 
readily available, but their dignity and determination to change  
their lives for the better was truly humbling. 

Overall, the experience of working together in both a physically  
and emotionally tough environment is something that will always 
bond us as a team. The ultimate reward, however, is the feeling of 
accomplishment and utmost respect for the work ICM undertake  
in those communities on a daily basis. 

It was a privilege to demonstrate to those we met that we care  
and that they are not forgotten.”

40 

members of staff have volunteered to participate in  
ICM’s Project Transform in the Philippines since 2010.

The 2015 Project Transform team pictured from left to right – Neeta Shah, Michael Bambury, Elaine Whelan, Aftab Akram, Rhys Dominique, Hayley Johnston, Michael Bush and  
Kimberley Thompson.

46 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

ENVIRONMENT
With operations in London and Bermuda, and with clients 
and brokers around the globe, the Lancashire Group 
generates the bulk of its carbon footprint as a result of 
airline travel, which we offset through an organised 
programme. In 2014, the Lancashire Group consolidated  
its UK operations into 20 Fenchurch Street, which complies 
with all the latest standards for energy use and recycling.  
As a result, total emissions from electricity have decreased  
by 21 per cent compared with 2014.

Types of Emissions

Activity

Direct (Scope 1) Gas (kWh)

Refrigerant

2015
tCO2e

60.4

0.0

2014
tCO2e

40.3

13.0

Indirect (Scope 2) Electricity (kWh)

590.2

751.6

Indirect (Scope 3) Business Travel (km) 1,754.4

1,270.9

346.6
63.7
2,815.3

334.3
67.4
2,477.5

14.7

12.9

Additional Upstream 
Activities 
Other

Total
Intensity metric:  
Staff number – 192 FTE
Total Emissions (tCO2e)  
Intensity ratio per FTE

100%

of our 2015 CO2 emissions offset. 

OUR APPROACH
The figures in this report are calculated over a 12 month 
period from 1 January 2015 to 31 December 2015. 
Lancashire has elected to use the number of full-time 
employees (FTE) as its intensity metric. Emissions per FTE 
rose from 12.9 tCO2e per FTE in 2014 to 14.7 tCO2e per FTE 
in 2015, an increase of 14.0 per cent, driven by the increase 
in air travel. Where data was not available for 2015, values 
were estimated using the corresponding months from the 
previous year or by using industry benchmarks.

OUR FOCUS AREAS
Using an operational control approach, Lancashire assessed 
its boundaries to identify all of the activities and facilities  
for which it is responsible and reported on all of the material 
greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions including Scope 1, 2 and 
3. Calculations performed follow the ISO-14064-1:2006 
standard and give absolute and intensity factors for the 
Group’s emissions. 

Results show that GHG emissions in the year were 2,815.3 
tonnes of CO2e, comprised of direct emissions (Scope 1) 
amounting to 60.4 tonnes of CO2e, and indirect emissions 
(Scope 2) amounting to 590.2 tonnes of CO2e. The source of 
other indirect emissions (Scope 3) comprised 2,164.7 tonnes 
of CO2e. Emissions from business travel have increased by 
38.0 per cent compared to 2014, due to a 22.0 per cent 
increase in total km travelled by air. Total emissions for  
2015 increased by 13.6 per cent compared with 2014. In the 
current challenging underwriting environment this increase 
in travel emissions has been driven principally by an increase 
in international client visits, particularly on long-haul flights 
to Japan and the Far East.

Lancashire has purchased carbon credits to reduce its gross 
GHG emissions by 2,815.3 tonnes, offsetting its total carbon 
emissions and remaining carbon neutral.

The Group has chosen to offset its carbon emissions  
with Carbon Clear by buying credits from the Mokla wind 
power project in India. These offsetting proposals were 
discussed and agreed with the Group’s CEO.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

47

PERFORMANCE 
CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY CONTINUED

MARKETPLACE
We continue to help the development of our marketplace  
by making employees available to sit on market committees, 
boards and working groups. In 2015, our employees have 
given talks at industry conferences, investor days and 
symposia, and as part of market education programmes.  
As noted on page 45, we also donate to many of the causes 
supported by our industry partners through the Foundation.

OUR APPROACH
We believe the most important thing we can do is to make 
the talents of our people available, and we do this happily. 
We also engage actively with our regulators in Bermuda  
and London, and the Cathedral team are active within  
the Lloyd’s market. With our clients and their brokers we  
are happy to welcome them to our offices, but we also travel 
to see them and their businesses right around the world.

OUR FOCUS AREAS
•  Regulators: we recognise the need to engage closely with 
our regulators at the BMA, PRA, FCA and at Lloyd’s and 
seek to be transparent in all our dealings with them.

•  Clients: we strive to offer clear, fairly-priced and useful 
products that meet our clients’ needs across our three 
capital bases.

•  Brokers: we are fully committed to supporting a ‘broker 
market’ and prize our broker relationships very highly  
right across the Group. 

•  Investors: we continue to work hard at investor relations 
and have an active programme of engagement with 
investors around the globe. 

100%

of our employees are eligible for RSS awards.

WORKPLACE 
We strive to attract and retain excellent employees who drive 
our appetite to outperform. Every company says it, but we 
truly believe that the talents of our people and our unique 
culture set us apart from our competitors. 

Recruiting the right people for the Group will always be a 
high priority for the business. It is critical that the aspirations 
and values of new recruits are a good match to both the role 
and the values of Lancashire.

The Group promotes an inclusive environment that 
recognises and values diversity as key to enhancing 
individual development and maximising business 
effectiveness. One way in which we seek to increase diversity, 
and the values of the Group, is through our ‘Respect in the 
Workplace’ training sessions which are given to all new 
employees during their induction. The training sessions  
aim to highlight their responsibilities in preventing 
discrimination in the workplace.

Among the full-time staff, the turnover for the Group for 
2015 was 8.9 per cent (down from 11.3 per cent in 2014), 
and as at 31 December 2015, 3.5 per cent of the workforce 
was composed of third party contractors, down from  
6.6 per cent in 2014.

Lancashire complies with all relevant local UK and 
Bermudian legal requirements, in particular with respect  
to rights of freedom of association, collective bargaining  
and working time regulations.

INTERNSHIP PROGRAMME
Since 2014, both the Group and the Foundation have jointly 
sponsored two internship positions for Bermuda resident 
college graduates. These graduates have been afforded the 
opportunity to spend two years working and learning about 
insurance in the Group’s London office and are due to 
complete their placements during 2016. The two-year term  
is a major commitment which demonstrates the Group’s 
determination to give back to Bermuda and, given the 
success of our first two interns, the Group is now in the 
process of re-advertising the programme, with the hope  
of welcoming two new graduates to the London office in 
the summer of 2016.

48 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

OUR FOCUS AREAS
Our focus in 2015 has been to maintain the success of  
our employees through ongoing training and coaching 
– provided both internally and externally. During 2015 
almost 30 per cent of our employees undertook formal 
training supported by the Group. We continue to measure 
our employees’ success through attainment of personal 
performance metrics as well as performance within the 
Group’s values framework. We are delighted that during 
2015 approximately 5 per cent of our employees were 
promoted within the Group supported by the training  
and development opportunities provided.

EMBRACING DIVERSITY
We are committed to being an equal opportunities employer. 
The Lancashire Group is currently represented by employees 
from 13 different nations. The gender split of males  
to females (see page 68) within the Group is 62/38  
per cent respectively. 

We continue to promote the value of having a diverse 
workforce by supporting the ‘Ban the Box’ campaign,  
an initiative from Business in the Community to give 
ex-offenders better employment opportunities by calling  
for the removal of tick boxes from employment application 
forms that ask about criminal convictions. Recruiting the 
right people for the Group is a high priority for the business 
and we promote the value of having a diverse workforce.  
We base all recruitment decisions on the ability of our 
prospective employees to do the job, without consideration 
to race, age, gender, sexual orientation, disability, beliefs,  
or background. Ban the Box aligns with our commitment  
to being an equal opportunities employer. The campaign 
further aligns with our corporate social responsibility efforts, 
in particular our partnership with St Giles Trust, a charity 
which supports ex-offenders and prepares them for training 
and employment opportunities.

CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY IN ACTION

St Giles Trust (SGT)

“Some of our most important services have been able to flourish despite a 
challenging funding landscape thanks to the wonderful support we get 
from the Lancashire Foundation. These services fill the gaps which are 
not met through statutory agencies and without our interventions many 
of the clients we serve would be in freefall.  

Our clients are some of the most vulnerable members of society. Many 
have multiple issues around homelessness, mental health, substance 
misuse and repeat offending histories. Their needs are complex and  
for many St Giles Trust is one of the few places which is able to engage 
with them effectively. 

Throughout 2015, we developed our Peer Assist digital resettlement 
platform, which uses the latest digital technology to offer easily 
accessible, high quality online and over-the-phone resettlement  
support to anyone who needs it. Since its launch in February 2015,  
it is now receiving around 40-60 calls a day and has had 7,300 plus 
visits to its website. Lancashire’s support has been vital in helping  
us develop the platform through enabling us to adapt our telephony  
and infrastructure. 

But it’s not only the financial support that we feel so passionate and 
thankful about. Lancashire staff visited our project in HMP Send 
in July 2015 and met with some of the women working for us as Peer 
Advisors in the prison. The visit made a real impression on the women 
in the prison, who are always amazed that anyone is interested in them 
and their futures. Former Peer Advisors make up around 40 per cent  
of our paid staff and Lancashire staff are actively supporting this  
by volunteering as mentors to some of our up and coming ex-offender 
caseworker staff. 

David Hart, Caseworker at SGT, commented on the mentoring support 
received from Lancashire staff: “I feel like having someone so experienced 
has given me great confidence when approaching certain issues, it’s 
great to be able to speak with someone who can offer great advice, but 
not only great advice but something sensible and relevant to what the 
issue is”.

Voluntary funding is the lifeblood of St Giles Trust as it gives us the 
ability to innovate and tackle difficult and complex issues. On behalf  
of our staff and clients, we thank Lancashire for your kind support.”

Rob Owen OBE, 
Chief Executive, St Giles Trust 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

49

PERFORMANCE 
GOVERNANCE

Staying ahead

of the pack

Outperforming the competition comes  
from more than just the players on the pitch, 
and our management do more than just sit  
in the stands. We achieve our goals through 
strategic leadership and experienced direction.

GOVERNANCE

52 Chairman’s introduction
54 Board of Directors
59 Corporate governance report
62 Committee reports
71  Directors’ remuneration report
89 Directors’ report
93 Statement of Directors’ responsibilities

50 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

G
O
V
E
R
N
A
N
C
E

www.lancashiregroup.com 

51

 
CHAIRMAN’S INTRODUCTION

Martin Thomas
Non-Executive Chairman

STRATEGIC 
CREATIVITY

Good governance is not about 
slavishly following rules, but 
creating a structure with the 
flexibility to facilitate constructive 
debate and creative strategic 
decision making.

In my opening statement I gave a broad overview of 
the challenges addressed by the Board during 2015  
in ensuring that our business has the necessary 
flexibility to identify and meet its strategic goals in  
a challenging market. The following section contains 
a more detailed account of the work carried out by 
the Board and its Committees in exercising effective 
oversight, taking decisions and providing support 
and constructive challenge to the business.

52 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Q How does the Board set and monitor the governance 

objectives for the Group?

Lancashire seeks to achieve the highest standards of corporate governance. 
By virtue of its premium listing on the LSE, Lancashire measures its 
corporate governance compliance against the requirements of the UK 
Corporate Governance Code published by the UK FRC. The FCA requires 
each company with a premium listing to ‘comply or explain’ against the 
Code (i.e. to disclose how it has complied with Code provisions or, if the 
Code provisions have not been complied with, provide an explanation  
for the non-compliance). The Group monitors its compliance with the  
Code on at least a quarterly basis, and in this corporate governance section  
and throughout this Annual Report for the 2015 financial year, areas  
of corporate governance compliance are explained by reference to the 
Code. The Company also monitors its compliance with applicable corporate 
governance requirements under Bermuda law and regulations. I am pleased 
to be able to report that there are no areas of material non-compliance with 
the Code. This formal consideration of governance requirements is a useful 
driver for the structuring of agendas and the consideration of matters which 
are of real commercial and strategic benefit to the Group.

Q Is the Board effective?

In my opening remarks I noted that 2015 had been a year of continuity  
and consolidation in the composition of our Board and management team.  
I would like to thank all of our Directors for the diligence with which they  
have discharged their duties during the year. During 2015 we took the 
opportunity to use the services of Lintstock (a third-party provider of board 
evaluation services) who worked with the Board and the business to review  
the effectiveness of our Board, its Committees and our Directors. A summary 
report was discussed by the full Board and I am pleased to report the conclusion 
that the Board and each of its Committees are considered to have a balance  
of skills and perspectives that serve the Group effectively and to meet the 
challenges of the business. As a Board we have also gained useful insights  
and identified various areas for training and learning during the coming year. 

The acid test for Board effectiveness is the quality of strategic debate and 
decision making. I am confident that we have a Board which demonstrably 
shows strategic leadership in its insightful and informed debate and 
interaction with the management team and the business.

Q What changes have there been to the management teams during 2015?

As a Board we have welcomed Steve Hartley and Jas Bolla to the business as the 
Head of Internal Audit and Head of Human Resources respectively. Louise 
Wells, formerly Head of Internal Audit, has been appointed as Group Chief  
Risk Officer and we have also welcomed Beverley Todd to our LICL subsidiary 
Board (as a Non-Executive Director and Chairman).  We have bid farewell to 
Charles Mathias (our former Group Chief Risk Officer) and Dan Soares (the 
former LICL Chairman) as well as Peter Scales and John Lynch (respectively  
the CEO and CFO of the Cathedral Group and also Directors on the CUL 
Board) and we thank them all for their contributions to the success of our 
business over many years.

Q How does the Board shape and embed a healthy 

corporate culture?

Whilst as a Board we have formally adopted a set of values 
which we expect to inform and enhance the conduct  
of our business, and against which we appraise the 
performance of our employees, these are not a false 
construct or an imposition from above, but real working 
tools owned by everyone in our business. Good team work 
is essential to all our operations, we look for passion and  
a commitment to success in our people – for hard work, 
loyalty and an understanding of, and commitment to,  
our strategy and commercial objectives. Perhaps most 
importantly we are committed to values of respect. 
Amongst our workforce and on our Boards we value the 
benefits of a broad diversity, and we strive for our dealings 
with clients and counterparties to be honest, open and 
characterised by a strong sense of both individual and 
corporate integrity. We take particular pride in the facts 
that with three women among our eight Directors 
Lancashire is within the top ten FTSE 250 boards in terms 
of its gender diversity; and that 38 per cent of the Group's 
employees are women (see page 68 for further details).

Martin Thomas
Non-Executive Chairman

OUR GOVERNANCE STRUCTURE

Beverley Todd has extensive experience of international 
insurance and reinsurance, specifically with JLT 
Insurance Management where she has held senior  
roles in Bermuda and Florida. In particular, she has  
a detailed knowledge of Bermuda’s insurance regulatory 
framework which will be invaluable in her role as 
Chairman of the LICL Board of Directors.

INTRODUCING: BEVERLEY TODD
I am pleased to welcome Beverley Todd to the Lancashire Group  
as the Chairman of the Board of LICL, our Bermuda operating 
subsidiary.  Beverley has extensive knowledge of the governance  
and administration of Bermuda based insurance companies and her 
wealth of insurance and operational experience will further enhance 
the strong nexus of governance arrangements within the Group.

Group 
Board

LANCASHIRE HOLDINGS LIMITED
BOARD OF DIRECTORS

Group 
Committees

AUDIT 
COMMITTEE

NOMINATION 
& CORPORATE 
GOVERNANCE COMMITTEE

INVESTMENT 
COMMITTEE

UNDERWRITING
& UNDERWRITING
RISK COMMITTEE

REMUNERATION 
COMMITTEE

Page 62

Page 67

Page 66

Page 69

Page 70

Operational 
Boards

LUK 
BOARD

LICL  
BOARD

KCML 
BOARD

CUL
 BOARD

www.lancashiregroup.com 

53

GOVERNANCE 
BOARD OF DIRECTORS

From left to right:  
Elaine Whelan, Christopher Head, Alex Maloney, Martin Thomas, Tom Milligan,  
Samantha Hoe-Richardson, Peter Clarke, Simon Fraser, Emma Duncan

54 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

www.lancashiregroup.com 

55

GOVERNANCE 
BOARD OF DIRECTORS’ BIOGRAPHIES

OUR TEAM

MARTIN THOMAS (AGE 52),
NON-EXECUTIVE CHAIRMAN
Martin Thomas is a partner and board member of Altima 
Partners, LLP, the hedge fund manager, and a Director  
of el Tejar Limited. Prior to this, he was an official of the 
Bank of England, most recently on secondment to the EU 
Commission where he worked in the Financial Services 
Policy and Financial Markets Directorate of the Internal 
Market and Services Directorate General. Before Mr Thomas 
joined the Commission, he established the Financial Markets 
Law Committee at the Bank of England. Prior to that, he  
was Deputy Chief Executive of the Financial Law Panel  
and prior to that, senior counsel to the European Central 
Bank in Frankfurt. He started his career in private practice, 
specialising in corporate and commercial litigation at  
Travers Smith and in the law and regulation of financial 
services at Clifford Chance.

ALEX MALONEY (AGE 42),
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
Alex Maloney joined Lancashire in December 2005 and  
was appointed Group Chief Executive Officer in April 2014. 
On joining, Mr Maloney was responsible for establishing and 
building the energy underwriting team and account and, in 
May 2009, was appointed Group Chief Underwriting Officer. 
Since November 2010 Mr Maloney has served as a member 
of the Board and was appointed Chief Executive Officer of 
Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited in 2012. Mr 
Maloney also serves as a Director of Cathedral Underwriting 
Limited and has been closely involved in the development  
of the Group's Lloyd’s strategy. Mr Maloney has over  
20 years' underwriting experience and has also worked  
in the New York and Bermuda markets. 

ELAINE WHELAN (AGE 41),
CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
Elaine Whelan joined Lancashire in March 2006 and  
leads both the Group finance function and the Bermuda 
subsidiary, reporting to the Group Chief Executive Officer. 
Ms Whelan was previously Chief Accounting Officer of 
Zurich Insurance Company, Bermuda Branch. Prior to 
joining Zurich, Ms Whelan was an Audit Manager at 
PricewaterhouseCoopers, Bermuda, where she managed  
a portfolio of predomintely (re)insurance and captive 
insurance clients. Ms Whelan graduated from the University 
of Strathclyde in 1994 with a BA in Accounting and 
Economics and gained her Chartered Accountancy 
qualification from the Institute of Chartered Accountants  
of Scotland in 1997.

56 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

PETER CLARKE (AGE 56),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR
Peter Clarke was Group Chief Executive of Man Group plc 
between April 2007 and February 2013. In 1993 Mr Clarke 
joined Man Group plc, a leading global provider of 
alternative investment products and solutions as well as  
one of the world’s largest futures brokers. He was appointed 
to the board in 1997 and served in a variety of roles, 
including Head of Corporate Finance and Corporate  
Affairs and Group Company Secretary before becoming  
the Group Finance Director in 2000. During this period  
he was responsible for investing in and developing one of 
the leading providers of third-party capital insurance and 
reinsurance products. In November 2005, he was given the 
additional title of Group Deputy CEO. Mr Clarke is currently 
the Chairman of the National Teaching Awards Trust and  
a Non-Executive Director of both AXA Investment Managers 
S.A. and Lombard Odier Asset Management. He is a 
member of the Treasury Committee of King’s College 
London. Mr Clarke took a first in Law at Queens’ College, 
Cambridge and is a qualified solicitor, having practised at 
Slaughter and May, and has experience in the investment 
banking industry, working at Morgan Grenfell and Citibank. 

EMMA DUNCAN (AGE 56),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR
Emma Duncan is the Editor of Intelligent Life, The 
Economist’s sister magazine. She was Deputy Editor of  
The Economist and has held several other posts on the 
magazine, including Britain Editor and Asia Editor. She  
has covered the media business, the Middle East, home 
affairs, agriculture, commodities and the transport industry 
and has served as Delhi correspondent, covering India, 
Pakistan, Bangladesh and Sri Lanka. She has written special 
reports for the magazine on Saudi Arabia and the Gulf 
states, India, Pakistan and the food industry. Ms Duncan 
appears regularly on television and radio programmes.  
She has written widely on a freelance basis, for publications 
such as The Times, The Sunday Times, The Daily Telegraph, 
Vogue and Cosmopolitan. She has an honours degree in 
politics, philosophy and economics from Oxford University 
and started her career as a researcher and reporter at 
Independent Television News.

GS Reinsurance Group into Global Atlantic Financial Group 
(GAFG), before managing the sale of the Ariel businesses 
from GAFG to BTG Pactual in 2014. He is also a Non-
Executive Director of Managing Agency Partners Limited. 
Mr Milligan graduated from Durham University in 1991.

CHRISTOPHER HEAD (AGE 49),
COMPANY SECRETARY 
Christopher Head joined Lancashire in September 2010.  
Mr Head is Company Secretary of Lancashire Holdings 
Limited and advises on issues of corporate governance  
and generally on legal affairs for the Group. Prior to joining 
Lancashire, Mr Head was in-house Counsel with the Imagine 
Insurance Group, advising specifically on policy wording and 
the structuring of reinsurance transactions. He transferred 
to Max at Lloyd’s in 2008 as Lloyd’s and London Counsel. 
Between 1998 and 2006 Mr Head was Legal Counsel at 
KWELM Management Services Limited, where he managed 
an intensive programme of reinsurance arbitration and 
litigation for insolvent members of the HS Weavers 
underwriting pool. Mr Head is a qualified solicitor having 
trained at Barlow Lyde and Gilbert where he worked in the 
Reinsurance and International Risk Team. Mr Head has a 
history degree and legal qualification from Cambridge 
University, where he was a choral scholar in the choirs  
of King’s College and Trinity College.

SIMON FRASER (AGE 52),
SENIOR INDEPENDENT NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR
Simon Fraser was Head of Corporate Broking at Merrill 
Lynch and subsequently Bank of America Merrill Lynch 
until his retirement in 2011. He began his career in the  
City in 1986 with BZW and joined Merrill Lynch in 1997.  
He led Initial Public Offerings, Rights Issues, Placings, 
Demergers and Mergers and Acquisitions transactions 
during his career and advised many UK companies on  
stock market and LSE issues. Mr Fraser has an MA degree  
in modern history from the University of St Andrews.  
He is also a Non-Executive Director of Legal and General 
Investment Management (Holdings) Limited and Derwent 
London plc, where he chairs the Remuneration Committee 
and sits on the Audit and Nominations Committees.

SAMANTHA HOE-RICHARDSON (AGE 45),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR
Samantha Hoe-Richardson, who since 2014 has been 
Chairman of the Audit Committee, is Head of Environment 
and Sustainability for Network Rail. Prior to this, she was 
Head of Environment for Anglo American plc, one of the 
world’s leading mining and natural resources companies. 
She was also a director of Anglo American Zimele Green 
Fund (Pty) Ltd, which supports entrepreneurs in  
South Africa. Prior to her role with Anglo American,  
Ms Hoe-Richardson worked in investment banking and  
audit and she holds a masters degree in nuclear and 
electrical engineering from the University of Cambridge. 
She also has a chartered accountancy qualification.

TOM MILLIGAN (AGE 46),
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR
Tom Milligan was Co-Chief Executive Officer of Ariel Re 
Holdings Ltd., until his retirement in 2015. He began his 
career in the City in 1991 with Guy Carpenter & Co. and 
worked in both London and Bermuda as an insurance 
intermediary and underwriter. In 2005, Mr Milligan joined 
Goldman Sachs Group Inc. to start the GS Reinsurance 
Group’s non-life activities. As a Managing Director of 
Goldman Sachs, Mr Milligan served as Chief Underwriting 
Officer of Arrow Capital Re in Bermuda, before starting 
Goldman Sachs-owned Lloyd’s Syndicate 1910 in 2008  
and serving as Active Underwriter until 2012. In 2012,  
Mr Milligan led Goldman Sachs’ purchase of Ariel Re and 
served as Co-CEO from April 2012 until July 2014. During 
2013, Mr Milligan played a leading role in the spin-off of  

www.lancashiregroup.com 

57

GOVERNANCE 
OUR BOARD’S YEAR

HIGHLIGHTS OF THE BOARD’S YEAR

FEBRUARY / Q1 MEETING

APRIL / Q2 MEETING

JULY / Q3 MEETING CONTINUED

•  As part of its ongoing consideration of 
talent management and succession 
planning, the Board appointed Tom 
Milligan as a Non-Executive Director  
with effect from 3 February 2015 and as  
a member of the Investment Committee 
and the Underwriting and Underwriting 
Risk Committee. 

•  Following its quarterly review of capital 

management, the Board declared special 
and final ordinary dividends of $0.50 per 
common share and $0.10 per common 
share, respectively, in respect of the year 
ended 31 December 2014. 

•  The Board reviewed and approved the 
Group’s 2015 business plan that had  
been updated in light of the 1 January 
renewals and current market conditions.

•  The Board approved and adopted the 
Group’s 2015 framework for executive 
remuneration, including the three-year 
policy for Executive Directors’ 
remuneration. The Group’s Annual Report 
on Remuneration, as set out in the second 
part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report 
for the year ended 31 December 2014, was 
approved for presentation to shareholders 
at the 2015 AGM.

•  The Board approved and adopted  

the Group’s three-year strategic plan, 
including the Group’s risk, and capital  
and solvency appetites.

•  The Board reviewed and adopted the 
Group’s 2015 investment strategy.

•  The Board received an annual investor 
relations presentation from the Group’s 
corporate brokers.

•  The Company’s 2015 AGM was held at  
its Head Office on 29 April 2015. All 
resolutions were duly passed and approved 
by shareholders casting their votes. 

JUNE

•  The Board approved the appointment  
of Louise Wells to the role of Group  
Chief Risk Officer with effect from  
28 July 2015, subject to the relevant 
regulatory approval.

JULY / Q3 MEETING

•  The Board reviewed and approved the 

Group’s 2015 reforecast business plan in 
light of the 1 July renewals and actual 
experience to 30 June.

•  The Board declared an interim dividend 

of $0.05 per common share.

•  The Board approved amendments to the 
Group’s investment portfolio guidelines 
and to the terms of reference of the 
Investment Committee.

•  In light of industry M&A activity, the  

Board approved changes to the companies 
comprising the Group’s peer group for 
comparator purposes.

•  The Board approved an updated statement 
on the representation of women on the 
Board, on executive committees and in 
senior management, which is published  
on the Group’s website.

•  The Board approved the constitution of 
the RROC for the purpose of supporting 
it in reviewing Solvency II and other 
regulatory and public reporting outputs, 
and approved and adopted the RROC’s 
terms of reference.

NOVEMBER / Q4 MEETING

•  The Board considered the Group’s  

2016 business plan.

•  The Board declared a special dividend  
for 2015 of $0.95 per common share.

•  The Board received a final Solvency  

II project report following its transition  
to ‘business as usual’.

•  The Board approved and adopted  

an updated division of responsibilities 
between the Chairman and the CEO, 
together with the Group’s updated 
succession plan. 

•  The annual performance evaluation  
of the Board and its Committees and 
individual Directors was conducted, 
facilitated by Lintstock Limited. 

DECEMBER

•  The warrants to purchase the Company’s 
common shares that were issued on 16 
December 2005 expired on 16 December 
2015. All outstanding warrants were 
exercised prior to the date of expiry.

58 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

THE DIRECTORS
Appointments to the Board are made on merit, against 
objective criteria and with due regard for the benefits  
of diversity on the Board, including gender. The Board 
considers all of the Non-Executive Directors to be 
independent within the meaning of the Code.

Peter Clarke, Emma Duncan, Simon Fraser, Samantha 
Hoe-Richardson and Tom Milligan are independent, as  
each is independent in character and judgement and has  
no relationship or circumstance likely to affect his or her 
independence. Martin Thomas was independent upon his 
appointment as Chairman on 1 May 2007. At the Board 
meeting held on 17 February 2016, further to a 
recommendation by the Nomination and Corporate 
Governance Committee, the Board affirmed its judgement 
that five of the eight members of the Board are independent 
Non-Executive Directors. Therefore, in the Board’s 
judgement, the Board composition complies with the  
Code requirement that at least half the Board, excluding 
the Chairman, should comprise Non-Executive Directors 
determined by the Board to be independent. 

In accordance with the provisions of the Code, all the 
Directors of the Company are submitting themselves for 
re-election at the 2016 AGM with the exception of Martin 
Thomas, who will retire from the Board at the conclusion  
of the AGM.

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT

BOARD COMMITTEES

BOARD AND COMMITTEE ADMINISTRATION
The Board of Directors is responsible for the leadership and 
control and the long-term success of Lancashire’s business. 
The Board has reserved a number of matters for its decision, 
including responsibility for setting the Group’s values and 
standards, and approval of the Group’s strategic aims and 
objectives. The Board has delegated certain matters to 
Committees of the Board, as described below. Copies of the 
Schedule of Board Reserved Matters and Terms of Reference 
of the Board Committees are on the Company’s website at 
www.lancashiregroup.com. 

The Board has approved and adopted a formal division  
of responsibilities between the Chairman and the CEO.  
The Chairman is responsible for the leadership and 
management of the Board and for providing appropriate 
support and advice to the CEO. The CEO is responsible  
for the management of the Group’s business and for the 
development of the Group’s strategy and commercial 
objectives. The CEO is responsible with the executive  
team for implementing the Board’s decisions. 

The Board and its Committees meet on at least a quarterly 
basis. At the regular quarterly Board meetings, the Directors 
review all areas of the Group’s business and receive reports 
from management on underwriting, reserving, finance, 
capital management, internal audit, risk, compliance and 
other matters affecting the Group. Management provides 
the Board with the information necessary for it to fulfil  
its responsibilities. In addition, presentations are made  
by external advisers such as the independent actuary,  
the investment managers, the external auditors, the 
remuneration consultants and the corporate brokers.  
The Board Committees are authorised to seek independent 
professional advice at the Company’s expense.

The Board also meets to discuss strategic planning  
matters outside the formal meeting schedule. 

The Chairman holds regular meetings with the  
Non-Executive Directors without the Executive Directors 
present, to discuss a broad range of matters affecting  
the Group. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

59

GOVERNANCE 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT CONTINUED

INFORMATION AND TRAINING
On appointment, the Directors receive written information 
regarding their responsibilities as Directors and information 
about the Group. An induction process is tailored for each 
new Director in the light of his or her existing skill set and 
knowledge of the Group, and includes meeting with senior 
management and visiting the Group’s operations. 
Information and advice regarding the Company’s official  
list, legal and regulatory obligations and on the Group’s 
compliance with the requirements of the Code, is also 
provided on a regular basis. An analysis of the Group’s 
compliance with the Code is collated and summarised in 
quarterly reports together with a more general summary  
of corporate governance developments, which are prepared 
by the Group’s Legal and Compliance department for 
consideration by the Nomination and Corporate Governance 
Committee. The Directors have access to the Company 
Secretary who is responsible for advising the Board on  
all legal and governance matters. The Directors also have 
access to the Group General Counsel and independent 
professional advice as required. Regular sessions are  
held between the Board and management as part of the 
Company’s quarterly Board meetings, during which in-depth 
presentations covering areas of the Group’s business are 
made. During these presentations the Directors have the 
opportunity to consider, challenge and help shape the 
Group’s commercial strategy.

BOARD PERFORMANCE EVALUATION
A formal performance evaluation of the Board, its 
Committees and individual Directors is undertaken on an 
annual basis and the process is initiated by the Nomination 
and Corporate Governance Committee. The aim of this work 
is to assess the effectiveness of the Board and its Committees 
in terms of performance, composition, supporting processes 
and management of the Group, as well as to review each 
Director’s performance, training and development needs. 
The 2012 performance evaluation was facilitated by external 
consultants, whilst in 2013 and 2014 the evaluation was 
conducted internally.

The 2015 performance evaluation of the Board was 
facilitated by Lintstock Limited, a London-based corporate 
advisory firm with no other connection to the Group. The 
evaluation process involved each Director as well as the 
Company Secretary, the Group Chief Risk Officer and the 
Group General Counsel completing a confidential online 
questionnaire designed by Lintstock and the Nomination 
and Corporate Governance Committee. Responses to the 
completed questionnaires were collated by Lintstock, who 
then interviewed all of the respondents individually to 
discuss the operation and performance of the Board,  
each of the Committees, the Chairman and the Directors. 
Lintstock prepared a suite of reports which were discussed  
in draft with the Chairman before being distributed to  
each of the Directors. 

60 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

In February 2016, the Lintstock performance evaluation 
reports were discussed at meetings of the Nomination and 
Corporate Governance Committee and the Board and each 
of the other Committees discussed the report pertinent to  
its own operation and performance. The Board discussions 
were led by the Chairman and focused on such matters as 
strategic oversight, succession planning, Board composition 
and training. 

In summary, in the Board’s consideration of the 2015 
evaluation reports the Board concluded that it operates 
effectively and has a good blend of insurance, financial  
and regulatory expertise. All Non-Executive Directors are 
committed to the continued success of the Group and  
to making the Board and its Committees work effectively. 
Attendance at Board meetings was found to be good. The 
CEO and the CFO, the Company’s Executive Directors,  
were also found to be operating effectively.

Appropriate infrastructure, processes and governance 
mechanisms are in place to support the effective 
performance of the Board and its Committees. The Board  
is considered to manage risk effectively. The number of 
Directors on the Board is considered to be appropriate.

The process proved a useful learning exercise. The Board 
identified a number of areas for training for the coming year 
and also discussed options to optimise the focus of agendas, 
Board and Committee materials and flows of management 
information to the Board. The Board will also prioritise the 
implementation of a more formal staff training and talent 
management programme across the Group during 2016.

The Board will continue to review its procedures, training 
requirements, effectiveness and development in 2016. 

The Chairman’s performance appraisal was conducted by 
the Senior Independent Director, who consulted with the 
Non-Executive Directors with input from the Executive 
Directors during July 2015. The Non-Executive Directors 
also discussed the report prepared by Lintstock addressing 
the Chairman’s performance at the Board meeting held in 
February 2016. The Chairman’s performance was found to 
be effective.

At the end of the year, the Chairman met with the CEO,  
and the CEO met with the CFO, to conduct a performance 
appraisal in respect of 2015 and to set targets for 2016. The 
results of these performance evaluations were discussed by 
the Chairman and the Non-Executive Directors and are 
reported in the Directors' Remuneration Report 
commencing on page 71.

Original date of
appointment to Board

Board

Audit 
Committee

Investment  
Committee

Nomination  
and Corporate  
Governance  
Committee

Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk  
Committee

 Remuneration 
Committee

Non-Executive Directors
Peter Clarke1
Emma Duncan
Simon Fraser
Samantha Hoe-Richardson
Tom Milligan2
Martin Thomas3
Executive Directors
Alex Maloney                
Elaine Whelan                  

9 June 2014
4 August 2010
5 November 2013
20 February 2013
3 February 2015
15 September 2006

5 November 2010
1 January 2013

6/6
4/6
6/6
6/6
6/6
6/6

6/6
6/6

4/4
–
4/4
4/4
–
–

–
–

4/4
3/4
–
–
3/3
_

–
4/4

_
4/5
_
5/5
–
4/5

–
–

_
_
_
–
3/3
–

4/4
_

8/8
7/8
8/8
–
_
–

_
–

(1) Peter Clarke was appointed as Chairman of the Investment Committee with effect from 11 February 2015.

(2) Tom Milligan was appointed as a Non-Executive Director with effect from 3 February 2015. He was appointed as a member of the Investment Committee and of the Underwriting and Underwriting  

Risk Committee with effect from 11 February 2015.

(3) Martin Thomas was conflicted from attending the meeting of the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee held on 19 June 2015.

RELATIONS WITH SHAREHOLDERS
During 2015, the Group’s Head of Investor Relations, usually 
accompanied by one or more of the CEO, the CUO, the 
CFO, the Chairman or a senior member of the underwriting 
team, made presentations to major shareholders, analysts  
and the investor community. Formal reports of these meetings 
were provided to the Board on at least a quarterly basis. 

Conference calls with shareholders and analysts hosted by 
senior management are held quarterly following the 
announcement of the Group’s quarterly financial results.  
The CEO, CUO and CFO are generally available to answer 
questions at these presentations.

Shareholders are invited to request meetings with the 
Chairman, the Senior Independent Director and/or the other 
Non-Executive Directors by contacting the Head of Investor 
Relations. All of the Directors are expected to be available  
to meet with shareholders at the Company’s 2016 AGM.

The Company commissions regular independent shareholder 
analysis reports together with independent research on 
feedback from shareholders and analysts following the 
Company’s results announcements. This research, together 
with the analysts’ notes, is made available to all Directors.

ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT
The Board is responsible for setting the Group’s risk appetites 
and preferences, defining its risk tolerances, and monitoring 
and ensuring compliance with risk tolerances. During 2015, 
the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal 
risks affecting the Group’s business model, future 
performance, solvency and liquidity.

Further discussion of the risks affecting the Group and  
the policies in place to manage them can be found in  
the risk disclosures section on pages 112 to 138. 

Each of the Committees is responsible for various elements  
of risk. The CRO reports directly to the Group and subsidiary 
Boards and facilitates and aids the identification, evaluation, 
quantification and control of risks at a Group and subsidiary 
level. The CRO provides regular reports to the Group and 
subsidiary Boards covering, amongst other things, actual risk 
levels against tolerances, emerging risks and any lessons 
learned from risk events. The Board considers that a 
supportive ERM culture, established at the Board and 
embedded throughout the business, is of key importance.  
The facilitating and embedding of ERM and helping the 
Group to improve its ERM practices is a major responsibility 
assigned to the CRO. During 2015 the Board created the 
RROC to assist in risk management and reporting (see page 
39 for further details). The Group’s risk management is 
informed by the FRC’s Guidance on Risk Management, 
Internal Control and Related Financial and Business 
Reporting. The CRO’s remuneration is subject to  
annual review by the Remuneration Committee.

COMMITTEES
The Board has established Audit, Investment, Nomination 
and Corporate Governance, Underwriting and Underwriting 
Risk and Remuneration Committees. Each of the  
Committees has written Terms of Reference, which are 
reviewed regularly and are available on the Company’s  
website (www.lancashiregroup.com). The Committees’  
Terms of Reference were reviewed by the Board during 2015 
and some amendments were made to the Terms of Reference  
of the Investment Committee. The Committees are generally 
scheduled to meet quarterly, although additional meetings are 
arranged as business requirements dictate.The composition  
of the Committees as at 31 December 2015 was as set out in the 
table appearing above. A report from each of the Committees 
is set out from page 62 to page 70.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

61

GOVERNANCE 
 
COMMITTEE REPORTS

Samantha Hoe-Richardson
Chairman of the Audit Committee

“The Audit Committee has a particular 
role, acting independently from the 
executive, to ensure that the interests  
of shareholders are properly protected  
in relation to financial reporting and 
internal control.” (FRC – Guidance  
on Audit Committees).

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Audit Committee comprises three 
independent Non-Executive Directors and is 
chaired by Samantha Hoe-Richardson, a qualified 
accountant. The Board considers that the three 
independent Non-Executive Directors all have 
recent and relevant financial experience. The 
internal and external auditors have the right of 
direct access to the Audit Committee. The Audit 
Committee’s detailed Terms of Reference are 
available on the Company’s website. 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson (Chairman)
Peter Clarke
Simon Fraser

Meetings 
attended

4/4
4/4
4/4

62 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

AUDIT COMMITTEE

This report sets out the detailed responsibilities of the Committee as  
well as the significant areas of judgement or estimation focused on  
during the year.

SIGNIFICANT AREAS OF JUDGEMENT OR ESTIMATION
LOSS RESERVES AND EXPENSES
As detailed on pages 155 to 157 of the consolidated financial statements, 
the estimation of ultimate loss reserves is a complex actuarial process  
that incorporates a significant amount of judgement. The Committee 
considers the adequacy of the Group’s loss reserves at each Audit 
Committee meeting, for which purpose it receives quarterly reports from 
the Group’s Reserving Actuary. Ernst & Young LLP (EY) conduct a high 
level review of the Group's loss reserves as part of their Q1 and Q3 review 
procedures. Both the Reserving Actuary and EY present a comparison of 
Lancashire’s reserves to their own best estimates at the Q2 and Q4 Audit 
Committee meetings. During 2015, the Committee focused its discussions 
around the Group’s loss reserves on: the range of reasonable actuarial 
estimates and the divergence of the Group’s estimates to the external 
actuarial estimates; current and prior year loss development including 
‘back-testing’ of the Group’s prior year reserves; and reserving for each 
insurance operating subsidiary. Having reviewed and challenged these 
areas, the Committee concurred with management’s valuation of the 
Group’s loss reserves and the relevant disclosures around loss reserving  
in the Group’s consolidated financial statements.

INTANGIBLE ASSET VALUATION
The Company has two indefinite life intangible assets following the 
acquisition of Cathedral – goodwill and syndicate participation rights. 
Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are subject to an impairment 
review at least annually or sooner if there is an indication of impairment. 
Some of the key inputs in the impairment review are based on 
management judgement and/or estimation (see page 108 of the 
consolidated financial statements for further details). These inputs  
are reviewed by the Audit Committee annually and are considered 
reasonable. The Audit Committee also considers the Company’s internal 
stress tests and what stress scenarios would have to occur to indicate an 
impairment of its intangible assets. As a result of these considerations  
the Audit Committee agreed that there was no indication of an 
impairment of the Company’s intangible assets and that the carrying 
value of these assets was reasonable.

PRIORITIES FOR 2016
The Committee’s priorities for 2016 are to ensure the continued 
effectiveness of the Company’s control environment and the integrity  
of external financial reporting. During the year the Chairman of the 
Audit Committee will also lead a comprehensive and competitive  
external audit tender process for the provision of external audit  
services commencing in the 2017 financial year.

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2015

FINANCIAL REPORTING

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Monitors the integrity of the Company’s 
consolidated financial statements and  
any other formal announcement relating  
to the Company’s financial performance. 
Reports to the Board on significant financial  
reporting issues and judgements contained  
in the financial statements.

Reviews the content of the Annual Report  
and Accounts and advises the Board on 
whether, taken as a whole, it is fair,  
balanced and understandable. 

SOLVENCY II

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Monitors developments in the  
Solvency II regime.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
At each quarterly meeting the Committee reviews the Company’s quarterly financial 
statements for the purposes of recommending their approval by the Board. The 
Committee also monitors the activities of the Company’s Disclosure Committee and 
reviews the Company’s quarterly financial press releases, which it recommends to the 
Board for approval. The Committee receives quarterly reports from management on:

•  developments in accounting and financial reporting requirements;

•  any new and/or significant accounting treatments/transactions in the quarter; and

•  loss reserving (see page 155 for further details).

An annual paper is also presented that details the areas of judgement or estimation in  
the financial statements (see accounting policies page 106 for the details of these areas). 
Periodically the Audit Committee also undertakes a more detailed analysis of specific 
topics, such as its review of the accounting and disclosure for the Group's equity 
compensation plans undertaken in the third quarter of 2015. The Committee also 
considers quarterly reports on the financial statements from the external auditors, 
including an interim review report and a year-end audit results report. These are  
discussed with the external auditors at the Committee’s meetings.

Of the areas of judgement or estimation considered by the Committee in 2015, those  
that were considered significant are loss reserving and the valuation of intangible assets. 
These are explained in further detail on page 62. In accordance with auditing guidance, 
the external auditors’ report includes revenue recognition through the estimation  
of premium revenues as an area of risk. The Audit Committee considered this and 
concluded that for Lancashire revenue recognition is straightforward and low risk.  
While some premiums are subject to estimation, revenues are unlikely to be materially 
different from initial estimates, particularly on a consolidated Group basis.

The Chairman of the Committee reviews early drafts of the Annual Report and Accounts  
to keep appraised of its key themes and messages and to raise any issues early in the 
process. The Committee reviewed the 2015 Annual Report and Accounts at the  
February 2016 Audit Committee meeting and advised the Board that the Annual  
Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and  
provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company’s position  
and performance, business model and strategy.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
A quarterly report was provided during 2015 to the Audit Committee by the CRO detailing 
the Company’s progress towards meeting its Solvency II requirements. During 2015,  
the RROC was constituted by the Board to support it in reviewing Solvency II and other 
regulatory and public reporting outputs following the implementation of the Solvency II 
regime on 1 January 2016 when the PRA became the Group supervisor. The members  
of the RROC are the CEO, the CFO, the CRO and at least two Non-Executive Directors 
(currently Peter Clarke and Martin Thomas). The Group meets the requirements of the 
new regime and a comprehensive training programme has been put in place to ensure  
that all Board members are able to discharge their Solvency II responsibilities during 2016.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

63

GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

EXTERNAL AUDIT

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Oversees the relationship with the 
Group’s external auditors and is 
responsible for assessing annually 
their independence and objectivity, 
taking into account the relevant 
professional and regulatory 
requirements, specifically including:

•  An annual assessment of the 
qualifications, expertise and 
resources of the external  
auditors and the effectiveness  
of the external audit process.

•  The implementation of a policy  

on the supply of non-audit services 
to ensure that the provision of 
non-audit services by the external 
auditors does not impair their 
independence and objectivity. 

•  Making a recommendation to the 
Board, to be put to shareholders  
for approval at the AGM, in  
relation to the appointment, 
re-appointment and removal of  
the Company’s external auditors.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
The Committee reviews reports from the external auditors at each quarterly Committee meeting 
including the annual audit plan and an ongoing assessment of the effective performance of the 
audit compared to the plan. The Committee Chairman conducts informal meetings with the 
auditors and the CFO prior to, during, and after the quarterly results. The Committee meets  
in executive session with the external auditors and with management at least twice per annum.  
During 2015, an assessment of the effectiveness of the external audit process was conducted by  
the Company’s senior management with input from the Committee Chairman and the external 
auditors. The review enabled the Audit Committee to determine that the external audit process  
was effective and to note some minor development areas for future audits. 

The Committee has approved and adopted a non-audit services policy that is reviewed on an annual 
basis and was last updated in October 2015. The policy, which stipulates rules around approvals 
required for various types of non-audit services, can be found on the Company’s website.  
During 2015, EY provided non-audit services in relation to UK taxation. Fees for non-audit  
services provided in 2015 totalled $0.1 million representing 7.4 per cent of total fees paid to EY.  
The Committee gave careful consideration to the nature of the non-audit services provided and  
the level of fees charged, and has determined that they would not affect the independence and 
objectivity of EY as auditors.

The Committee has recommended to the Board the re-appointment of EY to perform the 2016 
external audit. EY have been the Group’s external auditors since 2005 and Angus Millar has been  
the lead audit partner since 2012. When making its recommendation to the Board, the Committee 
considered and had regard to EY’s length of tenure and any non-audit services provided during  
the year, and continued to be satisfied with EY’s performance, independence and objectivity, level 
of fees charged, compliance with ethical standards and policy on audit partner rotation. During 
2014, the Board approved a recommendation by the Committee that the external audit contract  
for the provision of external audit services commencing in the financial year 2017 be put out to 
tender during 2016. This is consistent with the mandatory rotation of the current EY lead audit 
partner. A recommendation will then be made to shareholders at the 2017 AGM.

64 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

INTERNAL AUDIT

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Monitors and reviews the  
effectiveness of the Group’s  
Internal Audit function in the  
context of the Group’s overall  
risk management system.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
The Group’s Internal Audit function reports directly to the Committee. Each year the Head of 
Internal Audit presents an audit plan to the Committee for consideration and approval. The key 
objective of Internal Audit is to audit on at least an annual basis those areas of the Group’s business 
that are deemed to pose the greatest risk to the achievement of the Group’s business objectives, 
and to audit all other areas of the Group’s operations at least once every three years. The findings 
of each internal audit are reported to the Committee at the quarterly meetings. The Committee  
has a responsibility to ensure the timely implementation of agreed management actions and to 
review the status of these at its meetings. 

During 2015, the Committee reviewed and approved an updated Internal Audit Charter. This  
can be viewed on the Company’s website. An assessment of the effectiveness of the Internal Audit 
function was conducted by the executive, with a report issued to the Committee. The Committee 
discussed the report and its findings with the executive and the Head of Internal Audit and noted 
that no significant issues were raised. The Committee concluded that the Internal Audit function  
is operating effectively and efficiently in the context of the Group’s overall risk management 
system, and is adequately resourced. The Committee also appointed a new Head of Internal Audit.

INTERNAL CONTROLS AND RISK MANAGEMENT SYSTEMS

COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITY
Reviews the adequacy and 
effectiveness of the Group’s  
internal financial controls and 
internal control and financial  
risk management systems  
(including financial, operational  
and compliance controls).

Reviews for adequacy and security  
of the Company’s ‘whistleblowing’ 
arrangements, procedures for 
detecting fraud and systems and 
controls for the prevention of  
bribery and money laundering.

COMMITTEE ACTIVITIES
The Board has ultimate responsibility for maintaining a robust framework of internal controls  
and risk management and for overseeing and ensuring the effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management and internal control systems and has delegated the monitoring and review of this 
framework to the Committee. The system of internal control is designed to manage rather than 
eliminate the risk of failure to achieve business objectives, and can only provide reasonable and  
not absolute assurance against material misstatement or loss. The Committee receives an annual 
paper detailing the effectiveness of the Company’s internal controls, which is reviewed and 
discussed by the Committee. This paper covers all material controls including financial, operating 
and compliance controls. In 2015, the Committee was satisfied that the Company’s internal control 
framework was operating effectively.

During 2015, the Committee reviewed and recommended the adoption by the Board of updated 
policies and procedures for anti-money laundering, bribery and financial crime, conflicts of  
interest and whistleblowing. The Committee regularly reviews the Company’s procedures for 
detecting fraud. The Committee also keeps under review the adequacy and effectiveness of  
the Company’s legal and compliance function.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

65

GOVERNANCE 
INVESTMENT COMMITTEE

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Recommend investment strategies, guidelines and policies for the Board  
of the Company and other members of the Group to approve annually.

•  Recommend and set risk asset definitions and risk tolerance levels.

•  Recommend to the relevant Boards the appointment of investment  

managers to manage the Group’s investments.

•  Monitor the performance of investment strategies within the risk framework.

•  Establish and monitor compliance with investment operating guidelines 
relating to custody of investments, internal controls and accounting.

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2015
During 2015, the Investment Committee undertook a strategic asset  
allocation study that resulted in recommended changes to the Group  
asset allocations. The Committee also recommended changes to the 
Company’s investment guidelines.

The Committee considered regular reports on investment performance,  
asset allocation and compliance with pre-defined guidelines and tolerances. 

PRIORITIES FOR 2016
The Investment Committee will continue to focus on achieving the 
appropriate balance of risk and return in the implementation of the Group’s 
investment strategy, preserving capital and managing interest rate risk.

COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

Peter Clarke
Chairman of the Investment Committee

“The focus of the Committee continues to  
be on capital preservation and liquidity  
to support and complement the Group’s 
underwriting operations. ”

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Investment Committee comprises three 
Non-Executive Directors and one Executive 
Director (the CFO) together with the Head of 
Investments and Treasury (who is not a Director).

Peter Clarke (Chairman)1
Emma Duncan
Tom Milligan2
Denise O’Donoghue
Elaine Whelan

Meetings 
attended

4/4
3/4
3/3
4/4
4/4

(1) Peter Clarke was appointed as Chairman of the Investment Committee 

with effect from 11 February 2015.

(2) Tom Milligan was appointed as a member of the Investment Committee 

with effect from 11 February 2015.

66 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Martin Thomas
Chairman of the Nomination and  
Corporate Governance Committee

“A particular focus of the Committee 
during 2015 has been succession 
planning for the Board and  
its Committees to ensure their  
continued effective performance  
through continuity of leadership.” 

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
A majority of the members of the Nomination  
and Corporate Governance Committee are 
independent Non-Executive Directors. The 
Committee Chairman is Martin Thomas,  
who is the Chairman of the Board.

Martin Thomas1 (Chairman)
Emma Duncan
Samantha Hoe-Richardson

Meetings 
attended

4/5
4/5
5/5

(1) Martin Thomas was conflicted from attending the meeting of the 

Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee held on 19 June 2015. 

NOMINATION AND 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Review the structure, size and composition (including the skills, knowledge, 

experience and diversity) of the Board.

•  Consider succession planning for Directors and other senior executives.

•  Nominate candidates to fill Board vacancies.

•  Make recommendations to the Board concerning Non-Executive Director 

independence, membership of Committees, suitable candidates for the role of 
Senior Independent Director and the re-election of Directors by shareholders.

•  Review the Company’s corporate governance arrangements and compliance.

•  Oversee donations by the Group to the Lancashire Foundation and  

to monitor the activities of the Foundation.

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2015
BOARD COMPOSITION
The Committee reviewed the composition of the Board to ensure that the 
balance of skills, experience and diversity continued to be appropriate for  
the Group’s business to meet the strategic objectives. The Committee also 
considered whether any additional skills and experience would be needed, 
either to complement those already on the Board, or to plan for filling 
vacancies due to the retirement of Directors. Following Martin Thomas’s 
decision to retire from the Board at the 2016 AGM, the Committee 
recommended the appointment of Peter Clarke as Chairman of the Board. 

In its consideration of the appointment of a new Chairman, the Committee 
noted that an independant external search consultancy had been used  
in relation to the appointments of Peter Clarke and Tom Milligan as  
Non-Executive Directors in 2014 and 2015, respectively. It was therefore 
agreed that given this process, and the availability of Peter Clarke as a very 
strong candidate, the utilisation of a further external search consultancy or 
open advertising would be of little benefit to the Company at this time. The 
Committee recommended changes to the composition of the Investment 
Committee and the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee  
during the year.

SUCCESSION PLANNING
The Committee reviewed the Company’s succession plan for Executive 
Directors and other senior executives, taking into account the Company’s  
risk environment and strategic objectives, as well as the anticipated demands  
of the business. A particular area of focus during 2015 has been that of talent 
development and monitoring. Following the appointment of Jas Bolla as the 
Group Head of HR effective talent mapping and management has been 
identified as an area for further development and standardisation across  
the Group in the coming year. 

APPOINTMENT OF DIRECTORS TO SUBSIDIARY BOARDS
In early 2016 the Committee recommended to the Board the appointment  
of Beverley Todd to the role of Chairman of the Board of LICL.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

67

GOVERNANCE 
LHL BOARD MEMBERS

Men
Women

GROUP MANAGEMENT  
EXCLUDING LHL  
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS

Male: 80%
Female: 20%

OVERALL LANCASHIRE 
GROUP EMPLOYEES

Men
Women

LHL BOARD MEMBERS

Male: 62%
Female: 38%

GROUP MANAGEMENT 
EXCLUDING LHL NON-EXECUTIVE 
BOARD DIRECTORS

Men
Women

OVERALL 
GROUP EMPLOYEES

Male: 62%
Female: 38%

COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
The Committee keeps under review the Company’s 
corporate governance, particularly compliance with the 
Code, and is responsible for making recommendations to 
the Board concerning the process for conducting and 
facilitating the annual performance evaluation of the Board, 
its Committees and the individual Directors – see page 60.

During 2015, the Committee recommended the adoption by 
the Board of revised Terms of Reference for the Investment 
Committee. It also made recommendations to the Board 
regarding the Terms of Reference and membership of a  
new RROC that was established to support the Board in 
reviewing Solvency II and other regulatory and public 
reporting outputs. 

The Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee 
also recommended the approval by the Board of an updated 
protocol for the division of responsibilities and roles of the 
Chairman and Group CEO and the responsibilities and 
reporting lines of the CEOs of Group subsidiaries.

The Committee recommended approval by the Board of an 
updated statement on the representation of women on the 
Board, on executive committees and in senior management. 
This is published on the Company’s website. In the context 
of Lord Davies's reports, the Committee recognises the 
benefits that a broad diversity of skills, experience and 
gender, amongst other factors, brings to enhance Board 
performance, but considers that quotas are not the best 
option for achieving diversity. 

The Committee considered statistics relevant to the gender 
composition of the Board, Group management excluding 
Non-Executive Directors, and overall Group employees. 
These statistics are shown opposite.

The Committee recommended the approval and adoption 
by the Board of a statement on slavery and human 
trafficking, which is published on the Company’s website. 
The Group is committed to social responsibility and has  
zero tolerance for slavery and human trafficking. 

THE LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION
The Committee is responsible for monitoring and making 
recommendations to the Board in relation to the Company’s 
charitable giving policy and the operation of, and reporting 
requirements for, the Lancashire Foundation.

PRIORITIES FOR 2016
The Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee’s 
priorities for 2016 will include a continued focus on 
corporate governance matters, and on succession planning, 
to support management in the development of talent 
planning within the business.

68 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Alex Maloney
Chairman of the Underwriting and  
Underwriting Risk Committee

“The Committee is an important forum  
for discussing and setting the right 
underwriting risk appetites. It also 
monitors the Company’s underwriting 
performance against the risk tolerances.”

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Underwriting and Underwriting Risk 
Committee comprises one Executive Director  
(the Group CEO) and one Non-Executive  
Director together with the Group CUO, the  
CUO of LICL, the CUO and Reinsurance  
Manager of LUK and the Head of Capital 
Modeling (who are not Directors).

Alex Maloney (Chairman)
Paul Gregory
Hayley Johnston
Tom Milligan1
Sylvain Perrier
Ben Readdy

Meetings 
attended

4/4
3/4
3/4
3/3
4/4
4/4

(1)  Tom Milligan was appointed as a member of the Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk Committee with effect from 11 February 2015.

UNDERWRITING AND 
UNDERWRITING RISK 
COMMITTEE

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Formulate Group underwriting strategy.

•  Oversee the development of, and adherence to, underwriting guidelines  

by operating company CUOs.

•  Review underwriting performance.

•  Review significant changes in underwriting rules and policies.

•  Establish, review and maintain strict underwriting criteria and limits.

•  Monitor underwriting risk and its consistency with the Group's risk profile  

and risk appetite.

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2015
Underwriting risk is one of the key risks faced by the Group, and the 
Committee is actively engaged in the development of strategy and 
underwriting risk tolerances, which are approved by the Board. The 
Committee also monitors underwriting performance on a quarterly basis.  
In what has been a challenging ratings environment, Lancashire continues  
to prioritise good risk selection first and foremost, and the portfolio mix  
since inception has been relatively stable. The soft market has presented 
opportunities for the business to increase its reinsurance purchasing thereby 
de-risking the portfolio. The strategic underwriting priority for the business  
is to service the needs of clients and their brokers and thereby build a core 
book of business capable of sustaining a relevant and viable operation over  
the insurance cycle. During 2015, the Cathedral platform has afforded 
opportunities for new lines of business within the Lloyd’s market through  
the ongoing build out of Syndicate 3010. The Committee has also received 
regular reports on the progress made in the development of the Kinesis 
platform during 2015. The Committee receives quarterly reports of  
significant claims to the business.

During 2015, the Committee meetings were open to attendance by all  
the Board members and provided a useful forum for the discussion of 
underwriting performance, risk tolerances and strategic initiatives. The 
Committee and Board place great importance on the management of the 
Company’s capital so as to match capital to the underwriting requirements  
of the business. 

A more detailed analysis of the Lancashire underwriting performance  
appears in the Business Review section of this Annual Report and Accounts  
on pages 30 to 38.

PRIORITIES FOR 2016
For the coming year the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee  
will continue to monitor the development of a forward-looking and disciplined 
underwriting strategy appropriate for the Group’s three underwriting 
platforms, within a framework of appropriate risk tolerances.

www.lancashiregroup.com 

69

GOVERNANCE 
COMMITTEE REPORTS CONTINUED

Simon Fraser
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee

“The Committee seeks to align the interests 
of the Company’s owners with those of  
its senior executives. Our remuneration 
policy affords financial rewards that  
are closely linked to performance.”

COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP
The Remuneration Committee comprises three 
independent Non-Executive Directors.

Simon Fraser (Chairman)
Peter Clarke
Emma Duncan

Meetings 
attended

8/8
8/8
7/8

70 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

REMUNERATION COMMITTEE

PRINCIPAL RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE
•  Set the remuneration policy for the Company’s Chairman, the Executive 
Directors, Company Secretary and other designated senior executives, to 
deliver long-term benefits to the Company.

•  Determine the total individual remuneration packages, including pension 

arrangements, of the Company’s Chairman, the Executive Directors, 
Company Secretary and other designated senior executives. Agree personal 
objectives for each Executive Director and the related performance and  
pay-out metrics for the performance element of the annual bonus.

•  Determine each year whether awards will be made under the Company’s 
restricted share scheme and, if so, the overall amount of such awards, the 
individual awards to Executive Directors and other designated senior 
executives, and the performance targets to be used.

•  Ensure that contractual terms on termination or retirement, and any 

payments made, are fair to the individual and the Company.

•  Oversee any major changes in employee benefit structures throughout  

the Group.

HOW THE COMMITTEE DISCHARGED ITS RESPONSIBILITIES DURING 2015
During 2015, the Committee reviewed the Group incentivisation packages  
to ensure that remuneration is structured appropriately to promote the 
long-term success of the Company. The Committee also reviewed the RSS 
structure for Executive Directors to ensure that the performance metrics 
continue to align the interests of the Company, its investors and management. 
The Committee considered the salary and bonus awards for 2015 for  
Executive Directors and other designated senior executives. The  
Committee also approved the grant of awards under the Company’s RSS.

The Committee reviewed Executive Directors’ shareholdings in the context  
of the Company’s share ownership guidelines for senior/key executives and 
modified the guidelines to introduce for Executive Directors a post-vesting 
two-year holding period for three-year performance-linked RSS awards, 
thereby increasing the alignment with shareholders on such awards to a  
period of at least five years. 

The Committee also reviewed the policy for Executive Director remuneration 
which has a three-year life after it was approved by shareholders at the 2014 
AGM. The Committee considers the policy fit for purpose and does not 
propose any amendments for the 2016 AGM.

The Directors’ Remuneration Policy and the Annual Report on Remuneration 
for which the Committee is responsible can be found on pages 71 to 88.

During 2015, the Committee undertook a review of, and recommended 
changes to, the companies comprising the Company’s peer group for 
comparator purposes in light of recent M&A activity. (A list of peer  
companies is on page 85.)

PRIORITIES FOR 2016
During the coming year, the Remuneration Committee will review the ongoing 
appropriateness and relevance of the Group’s remuneration structures. The 
Committee will also undertake a further review of the policy for Executive 
Director remuneration, for presentation to shareholders for approval at the 
2017 AGM. 

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT 

ANNUAL STATEMENT 
Dear Shareholder, 

I am pleased to present the 2015 Directors’ Remuneration Report 
to shareholders.  

As a company incorporated in Bermuda, LHL is not bound by  
UK law or regulation in the area of Directors’ remuneration to  
the same extent that it applies to UK incorporated companies. 
However, by virtue of the Company’s premium listing on the LSE, 
and reflecting the Committee’s approach to good governance, 
shareholders were given the opportunity to approve our 
remuneration policy at the 2014 AGM. We are not proposing any 
changes to our remuneration policy this year and as the current 
policy on pages 74 to 76 has a three-year life, a new policy will be 
put forward for consideration at the 2017 AGM. 

REMUNERATION AND STRATEGY 
The Group’s goal continues to be to reward its employees fairly and 
responsibly, by providing an appropriate balance between fixed 
and variable remuneration, linked to the achievement of suitably 
challenging Group and individual performance measures.  

There is a strong link between the remuneration policy and the 
business strategy. As highlighted at the front of this Annual Report 
and Accounts, our strategy focuses on the effective operation of the 
business necessary to maximise long-term and sustainable RoE and 
the delivery of superior total shareholder returns on a risk-adjusted 
basis over the course of the insurance cycle. Our remuneration 
policy is closely aligned to this strategy. 

PERFORMANCE OUTCOME FOR 2015 
The Group has delivered solid results in a market which remained 
challenging during 2015 (see the performance review of this report 
on pages 81 to 84).  

Against this background of challenging market conditions there 
was an increase in total remuneration of 5.1 per cent for the CEO 
between 2014 and 2015. For the CFO there was an increase of  
28.9 per cent between 2014 and 2015 in total remuneration (see 
the comparison table for single figure remuneration on page 80).  
This movement is consistent with a warrant adjusted RoE of  
13.5 per cent for 2015 compared to 14.7 per cent for 2014 and a 
total shareholder return of 25.9 per cent for the year compared  
to the disappointing -24.2 per cent for 2014 (see page 27 for 
further details). In the case of the CFO, it should be noted that 
the increase in total remuneration is principally the result of the 
vesting of the 2013 Performance RSS awards which were awarded 
following Elaine Whelan’s promotion. 

The annual bonus was focused on both absolute RoE and relative 
RoE and also on individual objectives. Executive Directors’ 
performance targets set at the beginning of 2015 for financial 
performance were stretching, and reflecting the Company's 2015 
performance were achieved at slightly above target level (and at  
63 per cent of maximum bonus for the CEO and at 63 per cent  
of maximum bonus for the CFO), subject to confirmation of peer 
group performance data. The potential percentage of maximum 
bonus for both the CEO and CFO could rise to 78 per cent should 
the Company performance be ranked at or above the upper 
quartile against peers. 

Consistent with the approach taken last year, due to the large 
number of outstanding warrants which were due to be, and were  
in fact, exercised prior to their expiry date in December 2015, and 
the potentially volatile impact of exercises on the annual bonus 
performance metrics, the Committee decided in respect of both 
the 2014 and 2015 years that for the annual bonus performance 
targets for both the absolute and relative elements there should  
be an adjustment for the impact of warrant exercises (including an 
adjustment for dividend equivalent payments made on outstanding 
warrants for the relative RoE calculation). Accordingly the warrant 
adjusted RoE used for purposes of the absolute RoE metric is 13.5 
per cent, which represents an uplift of 2.6 per cent on the 2015 
actual RoE of 10.9 per cent. For full details of Executive Directors’ 
bonuses and the associated performance delivered see page 82.  

In relation to long-term incentives, the 2013 Performance RSS 
awards were 75 per cent based on absolute RoE targets and 25 per 
cent on relative TSR against specified peer group companies over 
the three-year period to 31 December 2015. Our TSR performance 
(in USD) over this period ranked the Company below the median 
of the designated peer group of 11 companies, resulting in 0 per 
cent vesting for the TSR component. This, in part, was a reflection 
of the out-performance of the Company’s share price relative to  
its peer group comparator companies in 2012, with a high base 
point resulting in a weaker TSR performance by comparison  
to peers during the relevant three-year period. 

Our average RoE performance, adjusted for warrants, over  
this three-year performance period was 15.7 per cent against a 
threshold target of the 13-week Treasury bill rate plus 6 per cent 
and a maximum pay-out of the 13-week Treasury bill rate plus  
15 per cent, resulting in 100 per cent of the RoE component  
of the 2013 Performance RSS award vesting. Overall, the 2013 
performance RSS awards vested at 75 per cent. This compared  
to the overall 50 per cent vesting of the 2012 RSS Performance 
awards due to 100 per cent vesting of the RoE portion of the 
awards, which we reported last year.  

The total remuneration received by our current Executive 
Directors in 2015 was higher than that received in 2014 (see page 
80 for the comparison data). It is to be noted that in the current 
challenging underwriting environment total remuneration for 
Executive Directors is lower than in many previous years, as 
demonstrated by the chart of Total Remuneration History for the 
CEO on page 87. The Committee believes in setting challenging 
performance criteria and having a significant proportion of the 
overall package linked to Company performance. However, the 
Committee also recognises the need to ensure that Executive 
Directors are appropriately remunerated and incentivised even in 
the more challenging phases of the insurance cycle, as at present.  
It is also important that the Committee and the Board ensure that 
Executive Director compensation is structured in such a way so as 
not to encourage excessive risk to the business. The like for like 
employee costs for the Group were $80.1 million in 2015 compared 
with $77.4 million in 2014 (see page 143 for further detail). 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

71 
71

G
G
O
O
V
V
E
E
R
R
N
N
A
A
N
N
C
C
E
E

GOVERNANCE 
 
The disclosures provide shareholders with the information 
necessary to form a judgement as to the link between Company 
performance and how the Executive Directors are paid. This 
Annual Statement together with the Annual Report on 
Remuneration will be subject to an advisory vote and I hope that 
you will be able to support the resolution at the forthcoming AGM. 

Further to the Committee’s commitment in last year’s Annual 
Report and Accounts, the Committee has concluded that 
arrangements for our Executive Directors are appropriate and 
achieve the desired alignment of remuneration with performance.  

The Committee is committed to maintaining an open and 
constructive dialogue with our shareholders on remuneration 
matters and I welcome any feedback you may have.  

Simon Fraser 
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee 

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

Overall, in light of the annual and three-year performance 
delivered, the Committee is satisfied that there has been a robust 
link between performance and reward. 

APPLICATION OF REMUNERATION POLICY FOR 2016 
The Remuneration Committee has reviewed the policy approved by 
shareholders and considers it to remain fit for purpose. That said, 
we have made a number of changes in the way we will operate our 
policy for 2016. 

•  The minimum and maximum absolute RoE targets attached to 

our annual bonus plan have been modified to reflect the current 
challenging market environment. The target and maximum  
pay-out percentages have been maintained at 11 per cent and  
19 per cent respectively. However, in order to reflect the market 
outlook and budgeted returns, the threshold target payout 
percentage has been reduced to 7 per cent. The Committee  
and Board consider that, in light of the challenging business 
environment and the need to moderate risk exposures in the 
current market, these targets are appropriate for the 2016 
financial year. 

•  The Committee and Board have agreed an amendment to the 
management share ownership guidelines to stipulate that, in 
respect of future grants of RSS awards having a performance 
period of at least three years, Executive Directors are expected  
to hold the resultant vested RSS awards (or the resultant net  
of tax shares), for a further period of not less than two years 
following vesting. The additional two-year holding period is in 
line with recent institutional investor guidelines and, together 
with our management share ownership guidelines, provides 
further alignment between management and our shareholders. 

The final section of this report is the Annual Report on 
Remuneration which provides detailed disclosure on how  
the policy will be implemented for 2016 and how Directors  
have been paid in relation to 2015. 

72 
72 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION POLICY SECTION 
This part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report sets out the 
Remuneration Policy for the Company’s Directors. The policy  
has been developed taking into account the principles of the  
Code and the views of our major shareholders. The policy was 
voted into effect from the date of the 2014 AGM and is currently 
intended to operate until the AGM in 2017.  

Although not required by the regulations, the substantive terms  
of the Remuneration Policy are reproduced below for ease of 
reference. However, any details that are specific to 2015 or earlier 
years (including, for example, the disclosure of the illustrative 
remuneration scenarios) have been updated where applicable.  
The full Policy Report approved by the Company's shareholders  
at the 2014 AGM can be accessed in the 2013 Annual Report on  
the Company's website.  

GOVERNANCE AND APPROACH 
The Company's Remuneration Policy is geared towards providing  
a level of remuneration which attracts, retains and motivates 
Executive Directors of the highest calibre to further the Company's 
interests and to optimise long-term shareholder value creation, 
within appropriate risk parameters. The Remuneration Policy  
also seeks to ensure that Executive Directors are provided with 
appropriate incentives to drive individual performance and to 
reward them fairly for their contribution to the successful 
performance of the Company. 

The Remuneration Committee and the Board have considered 
whether any element of the current Remuneration Policy could 
conceivably encourage Executive Directors to take inappropriate 
risks and have concluded that this is not the case, given the 
following: 

•  there is an appropriate balance between fixed and variable  
pay, and therefore Executive Directors are not required to  
earn performance related pay to maintain their day-to-day  
living expenses; 

•  there is a blend of short-term and long-term performance 

metrics with an appropriate mix of performance  
conditions, meaning that there is no undue focus  
on any one particular metric; 

•  there is a high level of share ownership amongst Executive 

Directors, meaning that there is a strong focus on sustainable 
long-term shareholder value; and 

•  the Company has the power to claw back bonuses (including the 
deferred element of the annual bonus) and long-term incentive 
payments made to Executive Directors in the event of material 
misstatements in the Company’s consolidated financial 
statements, error in the calculation of any performance 
condition, or the Executive Director ceasing to be a Director 
and/or employee due to gross misconduct. 

HOW THE VIEWS OF SHAREHOLDERS ARE TAKEN  
INTO ACCOUNT 
The Committee Chairman and, where appropriate, the  
Company Chairman, will consult with major investors and 
representative bodies on any significant remuneration  
proposal relating to Executive Directors. Views of shareholders  
at the AGM, and feedback received at other times, will be 
considered by the Committee.  

HOW THE VIEWS OF EMPLOYEES ARE TAKEN  
INTO ACCOUNT 
The Remuneration Committee takes into account levels of pay 
elsewhere in the Group when determining the pay levels for 
Executive Directors. The Remuneration Policy for all staff is,  
in principle, the same as that for Executive Directors in that any  
of the Group’s employees may be offered similarly structured 
packages, with participation in annual bonus and long-term 
incentive plans, although award types (restricted cash or restricted 
stock) and size may vary between different categories of staff. For 
Executive Directors with higher remuneration levels, a higher 
proportion of the compensation package is subject to performance 
pay, share based remuneration and deferral. This ensures that 
there is a strong link between remuneration, Company 
performance and the interests of shareholders. 

The Company does not consult with employees on Executive 
Directors’ remuneration. However, as noted above, the Committee 
is made aware of pay structures across the wider Group when 
setting the Remuneration Policy for Executive Directors.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

73 
73

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

POLICY TABLE 
Base Salary 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Helps recruit, motivate and retain high-calibre Executive Directors by offering salaries at market 

Operation  

competitive levels.  
Reflects individual experience and role. 

Reviewed annually and fixed for 12 months, effective from 1 January. Positioning and annual increases 
influenced by: 
•  role, experience and performance; 
•  change in broader workforce salary; and 
•  changes in responsibility or position. 
Salaries are benchmarked periodically against insurance company peers in the UK and in Bermuda. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

Benefits 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Market competitive structure to support recruitment and retention.  

Operation  

Medical cover aims to ensure minimal business interruption as a result of illness. 

Executive Directors are entitled to healthcare, dental, vision, gym membership and life insurance. 
Executive Directors who are expatriates may be eligible for a housing allowance or other  
relocation-related expenses. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

Pension 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Contribution towards funding post-retirement lifestyle. 

Operation  

The Company operates a defined contribution pension scheme (via outsourced pension providers)  
or cash-in-lieu of pension where contributions would exceed HMRC pension limits in the UK. 
There is a salary sacrifice structure in the UK. 
There is the opportunity for additional voluntary contributions to be made by individuals, if elected. 

Opportunity 

Company contribution is currently 10 per cent of base salary. 

Annual Bonus1,2 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Rewards the achievement of financial and personal targets. 

Operation 

Bonus targets (percentage of salary) are based on mechanistic calculations for financial and personal 
performance. 
The precise weightings may differ each year, although there will be a greater focus on financial as  
opposed to personal performance. 
The Committee, based upon input from the CEO, will have the ability to override the results of any 
mechanistic bonus calculation to either increase or decrease the amount payable (subject to the cap)  
to ensure a robust link between reward and performance. 
At least 25 per cent of each Executive Director’s bonus is automatically deferred into shares as nil  
cost options over three years, with one third vesting each subsequent year. 
A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on  
unvested deferred bonus shares in the form of nil cost options up to the point of exercise. 
If Lancashire’s comprehensive income in the relevant full financial year should be negative, there will  
be no pay-out possible under the Relative Financial Performance element (details of the bonus metrics  
are included on page 78 of the Annual Report). 
The bonus is subject to claw back if the financial statements of the Company were materially misstated  
or an error occurred in assessing the performance conditions on bonus and/or if the Executive ceased  
to be a Director or employee due to gross misconduct. 

74 
74 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Opportunity3 

Performance Metrics 

Bonus for achieving target level of performance as a percentage of salary is: 
•  CEO – 200 per cent 
•  CUO – 175 per cent (note this is not currently an Executive Director position) 
•  CFO – 150 per cent 
Maximum opportunity is two times target. 
Note: The Committee may set bonus opportunities less than the amounts set out above – see Implementation 
of Policy section of the Annual Report on Remuneration.  

Financial Performance 
The financial component is based on the Company's key financial measures of performance. For any year, 
these may include RoE, growth in BVS, combined ratio, investment return or any other financial KPI4. 
A sliding scale of targets applies for financial performance targets. Bonus is earned on an incremental basis 
once a predetermined threshold level is achieved. 25 per cent of the total bonus opportunity is payable  
for achieving threshold/median rising to maximum bonus for stretch/upper quartile performance. 
The degree of stretch in targets may vary each year depending on the business aims and the broader 
economic or industry environment at the start of the relevant year. 
Personal Performance 
Personal performance is based upon achievement of clearly articulated objectives. A performance rating  
is attributed to participating Executive Directors, which determines the pay-out for this part of the bonus. 
The weightings applying to the bonus measures and the degree of stretch in objectives may vary each year 
depending on the business aims and the broader economic or industry environment at the start of the 
relevant year. For Executive Directors, the financial component will have a higher weighting than the 
personal element. 

Long Term Incentives (LTI)  

Purpose and Link  
to Strategy 

Operation2,4 

Opportunity 

Performance Metrics  

Rewards Executive Directors for achieving superior returns for shareholders over a longer-term time frame. 
Enables Executive Directors to build a meaningful shareholding over time and align goals with shareholders.

RSS awards are made annually in the form of nil cost options with vesting dependent on the achievement  
of performance conditions over at least three financial years, commencing with the year of grant. This  
three-year period is longer than the typical pattern of loss reserve development on the Group’s insurance 
business, which is approximately two years. 
The number of awards will normally be determined by reference to the share price at 1 January in the year  
of grant unless the Committee at its discretion determines otherwise. 
The Remuneration Committee considers carefully the quantum of awards each year to ensure that they are 
competitive in light of peer practice and the targets set. 
Awards are subject to claw back if there is a material misstatement in the Company’s financial statements,  
an error in the calculation of any performance conditions or if the Executive Director ceases to be a  
Director or employee due to gross misconduct. 
A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on RSS  
awards up to the point of exercise. 

Award levels are determined primarily by seniority. A maximum individual grant limit of 350 per cent  
of salary applies.  

Awards vest at the end of a three-year performance period based on performance measures reflecting  
the long-term strategy of the business at the time of grant.  
These may include measures such as TSR, RoE/BVS, Company profitability or any other relevant  
financial measures. 
If more than one measure is used, the Committee will review the weightings between the measures  
chosen and the target ranges prior to each LTI grant to ensure that the overall balance and level of  
stretch remains appropriate. 
A sliding scale of targets applies for financial metrics with no more than 25 per cent vesting at  
threshold performance. 
For TSR, none of this part of the award will vest below median ranking and full vesting will require upper 
quartile performance or better. Awards vest on a proportionate basis for performance between the median 
and upper quartiles. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

75 
75

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

POLICY TABLE CONTINUED 
Share Ownership Guidelines5   

Under the guidelines, the CEO is expected to maintain an interest equivalent in value to no less than two times salary over time. For  
other Executive Directors the threshold is one times salary. Until such time as the guideline threshold is achieved Executive Directors  
are required to retain no less than 50 per cent of the net of tax value of awards that vest under the RSS. 

Chairman and Non-Executive Directors’ (NEDs) fees 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Helps recruit, motivate and retain a Chairman and Non-Executive Directors of a high calibre by offering  

Operation 

a market competitive fee level. 

The Chairman is paid a fee for his responsibilities as Chairman and also receives a separate fee for  
his position as Chairman of LUK. The level of these fees is reviewed periodically by the Committee  
and the CEO by reference to broadly comparable businesses in terms of size and operations. 
In general, the Non-Executive Directors are paid a single fee for all responsibilities, although  
supplemental fees may be payable where additional responsibilities are undertaken. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

(1)  The Committee operates the annual bonus plan and RSS according to their respective rules and in accordance with the Listing Rules. The Committee, consistent with normal market practice, retains 

discretion over a number of areas relating to the operation and administration of these plans and this discretion forms part of this policy. 

(2) All historic awards that were granted under any current or previous share schemes operated by the Company but remain outstanding remain eligible to vest based on their original award terms and  

this provision forms part of the policy. 

(3) The target bonuses set at the 2014 AGM in this policy were based on the incumbents in the roles at the time.  

(4) Performance Measures: these may include the performance indicators shown on pages 26 to 27 or others described within the Annual Report and Accounts Glossary commencing on page 172. 

(5) Share Ownership interest equivalent is defined as wholly owned shares or fully vested rights over shares; since November 2014 unvested annual RSS bonus awards do not count towards share ownership. 

ILLUSTRATIONS OF ANNUAL APPLICATION OF REMUNERATION POLICY 
The charts below show the potential total remuneration opportunities for the Executive Directors in 2016 at different levels  
of performance under the policy. 

)

M
$
(
N
O
I
T
A
S
N
E
P
M
O
C
L
A
T
O
T

6

5

4

3

2

1

0

5.32
38%

45%

17%

3.10

33%

38%

29%

0.89

100%

2.23
33%

37%

30%

0.68
100%

3.78
39%

43%

18%

Fixed pay

On-target

Maximum

Fixed pay

On-target

Maximum

CEO

CFO

Fixed pay

Annual bonus

LTI Awards (RSS)

Fixed pay = 2016 Salary + Actual Value of 2015 Benefits + 2016 Pension Contribution. 

On-target = Fixed Pay + Target Bonus (being half the Maximum Bonus Opportunity) + Target Value of 2016 RSS grant  
(assuming 50 per cent vesting with face values of grant).  

Maximum = Fixed Pay + Maximum Bonus Opportunity + Maximum Value of 2016 RSS grant (assuming 100 per cent vesting  
shown as the face values of grant). 

No account has been taken of any share price growth or dividend equivalent accruals. 

76 
76 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
APPROACH TO RECRUITMENT REMUNERATION 
The remuneration package for a new Executive Director would be set in accordance with the terms of the Company’s prevailing approved 
Remuneration Policy at the time of appointment and take into account the skills and experience of the individual, the market rate for  
a candidate of that experience and the importance of securing the relevant individual. 

Salary would be provided at such a level as is required to attract the most appropriate candidate. The annual bonus and LTI potential 
would be in line with the Policy. In addition, the Committee may offer additional cash and/or share based elements to replace deferred 
or incentive pay forfeited by an executive leaving a previous employer. It would seek to ensure, where possible, that these awards would  
be consistent with awards forfeited in terms of vesting periods, expected value and performance conditions. 

For an internal Executive Director appointment, any variable pay element awarded in respect of the prior role may be allowed to pay  
out according to its terms, adjusted as relevant to take into account the appointment. In addition, any other ongoing remuneration 
obligations existing prior to appointment may continue.  

The Committee may agree that the Company will meet certain relocation expenses as appropriate. 

SERVICE CONTRACTS AND LOSS OF OFFICE PAYMENT POLICY FOR EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS 
Executive Directors have service contracts with six-month notice periods. In the event of termination, the Executive Directors’ contracts 
provide for compensation up to a maximum of base salary plus the value of benefits to which the Executive Directors are contractually 
entitled for the unexpired portion of the notice period. No Executive Director has a contractual right to a bonus for any period of notice 
not worked.  

The Company seeks to apply the principle of mitigation in the payment of compensation on the termination of the service contract of  
any Executive Director. There are no special provisions in the service contracts for payments to Executive Directors on a change of 
control of the Company. 

In the event of an exit of an Executive Director, the overriding principle will be to honour contractual remuneration entitlements and 
determine on an equitable basis the appropriate treatment of deferred and performance linked elements of the package, taking account 
of the circumstances. Failure will not be rewarded. 

Depending on the leaver classification, an Executive Director may be eligible for certain payments or benefits continuation after cessation 
of employment. 

If an Executive Director resigns or is summarily dismissed, salary, pension and benefits will cease on the last day of employment and  
there will be no further payments. 

LEAVER ON ARRANGED TERMS OR GOOD LEAVER 
If an Executive Director leaves on agreed terms, including compassionate circumstances, there may be payments after cessation of 
employment. Salary, pension and benefits will be paid up to the length of the agreed notice period or agreed period of gardening leave.  

Subject to performance, a bonus may be payable at the discretion of the Committee pro-rata for the portion of the financial year worked.  

Vested but unexercised deferred bonus shares will remain exercisable. Unvested deferred bonus shares will ordinarily vest in full, relative 
to the normal vesting period. All such vested awards must be exercised within 12 months of the vesting date. The Committee has 
discretion to permit such unvested awards to vest early rather than continue on the normal vesting timetable and also retains discretion, 
acting fairly and reasonably, as to whether or not to apply (or to apply to a lesser extent) the pro-rata reduction to the bonus shares  
where it feels the reduction would be inappropriate. 

Vested but unexercised RSS awards may remain exercisable for 12 months. Unvested awards may vest on the normal vesting date unless 
the Committee determines that such awards shall instead vest at the time of cessation. Unvested awards will only vest to the extent that  
the performance conditions have been satisfied (over the full or curtailed period as relevant). A pro-rata reduction in the size of awards 
may apply, based upon the period of time after the grant date and ending on the date of cessation of employment relative to the  
three-year vesting period.  

Depending upon circumstances, the Committee may consider other payments in respect of an unfair dismissal award, outplacement 
support and assistance with legal fees. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

77 
77

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

TERMS OF APPOINTMENT FOR NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS  
The Non-Executive Directors serve subject to the Company’s Bye-laws and under letters of appointment. They are appointed subject  
to re-election at the AGM and are also terminable by either party on six months’ notice except in the event of earlier termination  
in accordance with the Bye-laws. The Non-Executive Directors are typically expected to serve for up to six years, although the Board  
may invite a Non-Executive Director to serve for an additional period. Their letters of appointment are available for inspection at  
the Company’s registered office and at each AGM. The Company encourages share ownership by the Non-Executive Chairman and  
Non-Executive Directors, and Non-Executive Directors who do not own shares are encouraged to use a proportion of their fees to  
buy shares in the Company and retain such shareholdings for their remaining periods of office. 

In accordance with best practice under the Code, the Board proposes to submit the Directors individually for re-election by the 
shareholders at the 2016 AGM.  

ANNUAL REPORT ON REMUNERATION  
This Annual Report on Remuneration together with the Chairman’s Statement, as detailed on page 10, will be subject to an advisory vote 
at the 2016 AGM. The information on page 80 with respect to Directors’ emoluments and onwards through page 88 has been audited.  

IMPLEMENTATION OF REMUNERATION POLICY FOR 2016 
In relation to the Policy described in the previous section, the following section sets out additional disclosure on the expected application 
of the Policy for 2016. 

BASE SALARY AND FEES 
Executive Directors 
Increases and resulting salaries effective from 1 January 2016 are set out below: 

•  CEO – salary increased by 3 per cent to $795,675. 

•  CFO – salary increased by 3 per cent to $546,364. 

•  For 2016, increases of 3 per cent are in line with the salary increases across the general workforce population. 

Non-Executives 
The Chairman's and Non-Executive Directors' fees are as follows for 2016: 

•  The fee for the outgoing Chairman is $325,000 per annum and the additional fee he receives for the role of Chairman of LUK is 
$100,000. These will be pro-rated up to the date of the 2016 AGM, when Martin Thomas intends to step down from the Boards. 

•  The fee for the incoming Chairman (Peter Clarke) is to be $350,000 per annum. Mr Clarke will not hold the additional position of 

Chairman of LUK. The Committee noted that the current LHL Chairman’s fee had not been amended since 2010. New Bridge Street 
were commissioned to carry out a peer company benchmarking review. In light of that review, the Board decided to increase the fee  
for the incoming Chairman to ensure appropriate alignment with peers. 

•  The Non-Executive Director fee will remain at $175,000 per annum.  

ANNUAL BONUS 
For 2016, the CEO will have a target bonus of 150 per cent of salary and, therefore, a maximum opportunity of 300 per cent of 
salary which is within the approved policy limit and is in line with last year and represents a maximum bonus opportunity which  
is 100 per cent of salary less than the set policy limit. The CFO's target bonus opportunity will be in line with the policy at  
150 per cent of salary (maximum 300 per cent). 

The financial and personal portions of the annual bonus will remain unchanged with 75 per cent on financial performance and  
25 per cent on personal performance.  

Financial Performance (75 per cent) 
The Company's most important financial KPI is RoE, which is the core indicator of the delivery of our strategic priorities of ensuring 
strong underwriting, effectively balancing risk and return and managing capital nimbly through the insurance cycle (see the strategic 
overview on pages 20 and 21 of this report). Accordingly, for 2016, the financial component comprises two parts – 60 per cent of this 
element is based on the performance of the Group’s absolute RoE (measured as the internal rate of return of the change in the fully 
converted book value per share or ‘FCBVS’) plus dividends accrued and 40 per cent is based on the Group's relative RoE (measured  
by comparing the Group’s growth in basic book value per share or ‘BVS’) performance against appropriate peer companies (peer 
companies can be located on page 85).  

78 
78 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
•  Absolute RoE: 

Absolute financial performance is measured by growth in fully converted book value per share, plus dividends. A sliding scale range  
of RoE targets is set with 25 per cent of bonus target payable if the threshold level of RoE is achieved (being 7 per cent), rising to 
100 per cent of bonus target being payable for target growth in RoE of 11 per cent and 200 per cent of bonus target being payable  
for achieving the maximum RoE growth target of 19 per cent or higher. There is linear interpolation between these points. The Board 
considers that these target ranges are appropriately challenging in a difficult market and that the stretch target of 19 per cent would 
represent exceptional performance in the current market, but without encouraging excessive risk taking. The Committee and Board 
considers these targets to be appropriate to the present risk appetite given the current challenging insurance market conditions. 

•  Relative RoE:  

Relative financial performance is measured by comparing the Group’s growth in basic book value per share, plus dividends, measured 
against an identified comparator group of companies which can be seen on page 85. Payout will be based on performance against  
a sliding scale with no payout (0 per cent) for below median performance, 50 per cent of target shall be payable for achieving a  
median ranking, and up to 200 per cent of target shall be payable for upper quartile performance or better. Payout for performance  
in between the median and upper quartiles is determined on a proportionate basis. 

Personal Performance (25 per cent) 
This element of the bonus plan is based upon the individual achievement of clearly articulated objectives created at the beginning of  
each year. The table below sets out a broad summary of the 2016 personal objectives for each Executive Director. 

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney 

Personal Performance 

Effective leadership and management of the senior executive team and Group. 

Development of the general business strategy. 

Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Group Values. 

Elaine Whelan 

Effective leadership and management of the finance function and the Bermuda office. 

Development of the general business strategy. 

Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Group Values. 

The personal targets are broadly common among the Executive Directors, with variances being attributable to the specifics of their 
respective roles. Specific granular areas for personal development within the set broad personal objectives are discussed between the 
Chairman and the Executive Directors and agreed by the Committee. As part of the 2016 annual performance reviews each Executive 
Director receives a performance rating which will determine the level of personal performance bonus pay-out for which each Executive 
Director will be eligible. 

RESTRICTED SHARE SCHEME 
Performance Conditions 
For Executive Directors, 2016 RSS awards are subject to RoE and relative TSR performance conditions measured by reference to a period 
ending on 31 December 2018. These metrics were chosen as RoE provides a focus on the Company's underlying financial performance 
and cycle management, and relative TSR provides an objective reward for stock market performance against the Company’s peers. 

Weighting  
For 2016, the TSR/RoE weighting is 25 per cent on TSR and 75 per cent on RoE. 

Target ranges  
The RoE target range for 2016 awards is unchanged from the previous year: 

•  threshold – average RoE compared to the 13-week Treasury bill rate + 6 per cent; 

•  maximum – average RoE compared to the 13-week Treasury bill rate + 15 per cent; and 

•  none of the award will vest if RoE is below threshold, 25 per cent of the award will vest at threshold, and 100 per cent of the award  

will vest at maximum. Performance between threshold and maximum is determined on a straight-line basis. 

The Board and Committee consider that given current market conditions the stretch target represents exceptional and consistent  
cross-cycle out-performance above the Group’s stated strategic cross-cycle return of risk free rate plus 13 per cent. The target range  
closely aligns the longer-term remuneration of our Executive Directors with consistent out-performance and the interests of our 
shareholders, but is not so stretching as to encourage excessive risk taking. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

79 
79

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

TSR target for 2016 awards: 

The Group’s TSR is compared against a comparator group comprising 11 peer companies as disclosed on page 85. 

•  0 per cent will vest for a below median ranking; 
•  25 per cent of the award will vest if Lancashire’s performance is at the median; 
•  100 per cent will vest for upper quartile and above performance; and 
•  vesting will be on a proportionate basis for performance between median and upper quartile. 

Award levels 
2016 RSS award levels are as follows: 

•  CEO – 219,254 shares (257 per cent of salary); 
•  CFO – 157,104 shares (268 per cent of salary); 
The number of shares awarded was determined based on the share price at 1 January 2016.  

Post vesting holding period 
Under the management share ownership guidelines, for RSS awards made in 2016 or subsequent years, Executive Directors are expected 
to hold vested RSS awards (or the resultant net of tax shares) having a performance period of at least three years, for a further period of 
not less than two years following vesting. 

SINGLE FIGURE ON REMUNERATION 
The following table presents the Executive Directors’ emoluments in U.S. Dollars in respect of the years ended 31 December 2015 and  
31 December 2014. 

Executive Directors  

Alex Maloney4,5, CEO 

Elaine Whelan4, CFO 

Richard Brindle4,7, Former 
CEO 

2015 

2014 

2015 

2014 

2015 

2014 

Salary 
$ 

770,955 

675,181 

530,224 

518,117 

–  

Pension
$

77,096

78,573

55,880

51,500

– 

Taxable 
Benefits1
$ 

Annual Bonus6,9
$ 

Long-Term  
 Incentives  
 (RSS)2,3. 10 
$  

19,785

1,466,557

1,377,834 

9,620 

1,562,765 

1,205,919  

83,220

1,007,036

1,212,022 

95,738 

1,101,011 

474,119  

– 

– 

–  

Other8
$ 

Total4
$ 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

3,712,227

3,532,058

2,888,382

2,240,485

– 

368,576 

36,858

7,127 

1,180,355 

4,690,533  

644,914

6,928,363

(1)    Benefits comprise Bermudian payroll taxes, social insurance, medical, dental and vision coverage and housing and other allowances paid by the Company for expatriates (as is the case for the CFO),  

but exclude UK National Insurance contributions. 

(2)   For 2015, the long-term incentive values are based on the 2013 RSS awards which vest at 75 per cent on 18 February 2016 and are based on a three-year performance period that ended on 31 December 

2015. The values are based on the share price at 31 December 2015 and include the value of dividends accrued on vested shares. 

(3)   For 2014, the long-term incentive values were based on the 2012 RSS awards which vested at 50 per cent on 12 February 2015 and were based on a three-year performance period that ended on 31 

December 2014. The values are based on the share price at 31 December 2014 and include the value of dividends accrued on vested shares. 

(4)   Some amounts were paid in pounds sterling and converted at the average exchange rate of 1.5344 for the year as they are set in USD. 

(5)   For 2014, Alex Maloney's base salary and pension reflect his UK salary sacrifice pension contributions arrangement and are calculated at four months in his post as CUO (at an annual rate of $515,000)  

and eight months as CEO (at an annual rate of $750,000).  

(6)   For 2015, the Lancashire Group delivered solid results in a challenging market. Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2015 and based on a clear split between Company financial performance and 

personal performance on a 75:25 basis. Company financial performance had two components, absolute financial performance and relative financial performance weighted 60:40 respectively. The absolute 
component paid out at 131.25 per cent of target as the warrant adjusted RoE was 13.5 per cent against a warrant adjusted budget of 8.8 per cent and the relative component is provisionally cited at 58.3 per 
cent (based on an estimated 50 per cent of maximum pay-out) pending the final audited results of peer companies needed in order to calculate the final bonus payable. For the personal element of 
Executive Directors’ bonus opportunity the pay-out will be 75 per cent of the maximum for the CEO and 75 per cent of the maximum for the CFO. For full details of Executive Directors’ bonuses and the 
associated performance delivered see pages 81 and 82. 25 per cent of Executive Director’s annual bonus is deferred into the long-term incentive scheme without performance conditions, vesting at 33.33 
per cent over a three-year period. 

(7)   Richard Brindle retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014. Mr Brindle was afforded good leaver status and all RSS award interests were agreed to vest upon his departure using estimated 
TSR and RoE values at the time of his retirement. The amounts in the table above reflect all awards vesting in 2014. Further particulars of the vesting appear on page 72 of the 2014 Annual Report and 
Accounts. 

(8)   For 2014, this includes all payments made to Mr Brindle in lieu of his six-month notice period and converted at the exchange rate of 1.6885 as at 30 April 2014. Further particulars of the vesting appear on 

page 72 of the 2014 Annual Report. 

(9)   Annual bonus figures for Alex Maloney and Elaine Whelan for 2014 have been restated to reflect final relative performance data which was used to calculate the bonus figures and were finalised after all 
peer data was released in 2015, after the 2014 Directors’ Remuneration Report was published for circulation. For 2014, the relative component had been provisionally stated to pay out at 0 per cent, 
however after final results of all peers were released, this element paid out at 141.80 per cent of target (being 70.9 per cent of the maximum).  

(10) For Elaine Whelan, the increased value of Performance RSS awards noted for 2015 compared to that of 2014 is a result of vesting of the 2013 Performance RSS awards which were awarded following Elaine 

Whelan’s promotion. 

80 
80 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTORS’ FEES 

Current Non-Executive Directors 

Peter Clarke1 

Emma Duncan 

Simon Fraser 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 

Tom Milligan2 

Martin Thomas 

Former Non-Executive Directors 

John Bishop3 

Neil McConachie3 

Ralf Oelssner3 

Robert Spass4 

William Spiegel4 

Fee  
$ 

Other 
$

Total 
$

175,000 
98,077 

175,000 

175,000 

175,000 

175,000 

175,000 

175,000 

158,958 

– 

325,000 

325,000 

Fee  
$ 

– 

58,333 

– 

58,333 

– 

–
–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

100,000

100,000

Other 
$

–

–

–

–

–

175,000
98,077

175,000

175,000

175,000

175,000

175,000

175,000

158,958

–

425,000

425,000

Total 
$

–

58,333

–

58,333

–

58,333 

10,000

68,333

– 

175,000 

– 

175,000 

–

–

–

–

–

175,000

–

175,000

2015
2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

2015

2014

(1)  Peter Clarke was appointed as a Non-Executive Director with effect from 9 June 2014.  

(2) Tom Milligan was appointed as Non-Executive Director with effect from 3 February 2015. 

(3) John Bishop, Neil McConachie, and Ralf Oelssner retired from the Board on 30 April 2014.  

(4) Robert Spass and William Spiegel retired from the Board on 31 December 2014. 

2016 ANNUAL BONUS PAYMENTS IN RESPECT OF 2015 PERFORMANCE 
As detailed in the Policy Report, each Executive Director participates in the annual bonus plan, under which performance is  
measured over a single financial year.  

The target value of bonus was 150 per cent of salary for the CEO and CFO respectively, and the maximum payable was two times the 
target value. The warrant adjusted RoE is 13.5 per cent, which reflects the total impact of warrants of 2.6 per cent on the actual 2015  
RoE of 10.9 per cent. In setting the annual bonus RoE targets for 2015 the Committee agreed that the effect of warrant exercises and 
dividend equivalent payments should be excluded for annual bonus purposes due to the large number of warrants expiring in 2015  
and potential volatile impact on the annual bonus performance metrics. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

81 
81

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE 
75 per cent of the 2015 bonus was based on Company performance conditions and the extent to which they were achieved is as follows:  

Performance Measures 

Absolute RoE 

Relative RoE 

Total 

Weighting  
(of total Company 
 element of 75%) 
% 

60 

40 

Threshold
%

9

50

Target
%

11

N/A

Max
%

19

75

Actual 
performance
%

13.5

58.3

100 
(75 per cent of Total Bonus) 

% payout

131.3 of Target

100.0 of Target

118.8 of Target payable in 
respect of Company performance

For 2015, the Lancashire Group delivered solid results in a challenging market. The absolute component paid out at 131.3 per cent  
of target as the warrant adjusted RoE was 13.5 per cent against a warrant adjusted target of 8.8 per cent and the relative component 
against the results of peer companies is provisionally stated at median performance (100 per cent pay-out of target, and 50 per cent  
of the maximum) pending the final audited results of peer companies needed in order to calculate the final bonus payable. Any  
changes to the bonus numbers reported will be restated in the 2016 Directors’ Remuneration Report as final numbers. 

PERSONAL PERFORMANCE 
25 per cent of the 2015 bonus was based on performance against clearly defined personal objectives set at the start of the year.  

The table below sets out a summary of the 2015 personal objectives for each Executive Director. 

Executive Director 

Personal Performance 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Effective leadership and management of the senior executive team and Group. 
Development of the general business strategy. 
Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Values. 

Effective leadership and management of the finance function and the Bermuda office. 
Development of the general business strategy. 
Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Values. 

The personal targets were broadly common among the Executive Directors, with variances being attributable to the specifics of  
their respective roles and the perceived need for areas of personal development within their fields of expertise to be emphasised. 

During the 2015 annual performance reviews of each Executive Director, a performance rating was assigned to determine the level  
of bonus pay-out for which each Executive Director was eligible.  

As expected for a solid performance year in a challenging market, the Executive Directors each achieved a strong performance rating 
against their objectives. For the 2015 performance against personal objectives the following ratings were determined, expressed as a 
percentage of the maximum award for personal performance: CEO – 75 per cent, and CFO – 75 per cent.  

A table of performance measures and total 2015 bonus achievement is set out below:  

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Financial 
performance
 (max % of
 total bonus)
%

Personal 
performance 
(max % of 
total bonus)
%

Bonus
% of maximum 
awarded 
%

Total1  
bonus value  
$  

Value of bonus 
paid in cash
 (75 per cent of 
total bonus)
$

Value of bonus 
 deferred into 
RSS (25 per cent 
of total bonus)2
$ 

75

75

25

25

63

63

1,466,557 

1,099,917

1,007,036 

755,277

366,640

251,759

(1)  For 2015 the Group delivered solid results in a challenging market. Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2015 and based on a clear split between Company financial performance and personal 

performance on a 75:25 basis. Company financial performance had two components, absolute financial performance and relative financial performance weighted 60:40 respectively. The absolute component 
paid out at 131.25 per cent of target as the warrant adjusted RoE was 13.5 per cent against a warrant adjusted budget of 8.8 per cent and the relative component is provisionally cited at 58.3 per cent (based 
on an estimated median payout calculation) pending the final audited results of peer companies needed in order to calculate the final bonus payable. For the personal element of Executive Directors’ bonus 
opportunity the pay-out will be 75 per cent of the maximum for the CEO and 75 per cent of the maximum for the CFO. For full details of Executive Directors’ bonuses and the associated performance 
delivered see pages 81 and 82. 

(2) 25 per cent of total bonus award will be deferred into LHL shares with one third vesting annually, each year, over a three-year period with the first third becoming exercisable in February 2017, subject  

to the Company being in an ‘open period’. These awards vest on the relevant dates subject to continued employment only. 

82 
82 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
LONG-TERM SHARE AWARDS WITH PERFORMANCE PERIODS ENDING IN THE YEAR – 2013 RSS AWARD 
The 2013 RSS awards are based on a three-year performance period ending on 31 December 2015 and vest following the determination 
of financial results by the Board. The tables below set out the achievement against the performance conditions attached to the award, 
resulting in aggregate vesting of 75 per cent, and the actual number of awards vesting (with their estimated value). 

Performance level 

Below threshold 

Threshold 

Stretch or above 

Actual achieved 

TSR  
(relative to a comparator group of 11 companies) 

Average annual RoE  
(over three years in excess of 13-week Treasury Bill Rate)

(relevant to 25% of the 2013 RSS awards) 

(relevant to 75% of the 2013 RSS awards) 

Performance required

% vesting

Performance required (%)

% vesting

Below median

Median

Upper quartile or above

Below median

0

25

100

0

Below 6

6

15 or above

15.7

0

25

100

100

Details of the performance RSS awards granted on 28 February 2013 with a performance period of 1 January 2013 – 31 December 2015 
vesting for each Executive Director, based on the above vesting, are shown in the table below: 

Executive3 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan  

Number of 
shares at grant

Number of
 shares to lapse

Number of  
shares to vest 

Dividend accrual 
on vested shares 
value2 
$ 

Value of shares 
 including 
dividend 
 accrual1
$ 

131,969

116,087

32,993

29,022

98,976 

87,065 

456,302

1,377,834

401,389

1,212,022

(1)  The value of the vested shares is based on the 2013 RSS awards which vest at 75 per cent on 18 February 2016 and are based on a three-year performance period that ended on 31 December 2015.  
The values are based on the share price at 31 December 2015 (being $9.31 based on the exchange rate of 1.4826). The vested awards are subject to the claw back provision set out on page 75.  

(2) Dividends accrue on awards at the date of a dividend payment and upon exercise the cash value of the accrued dividends is paid to the employee on the number of vested awards. 

(3) Details of the former CEO’s award can be found in the Loss of Office Payments section on page 72 of the 2014 Annual Report and Accounts. 

SCHEME INTERESTS AWARDED DURING THE YEAR 
The table below sets out the performance RSS share awards that were granted as nil-cost options on 12 February 2015.  

Executive 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Number of 
awards  
granted during  
the year 

Face value 
of awards 
 granted during 
the year1,3
$ 

Grant date2

12-Feb-2015 

 244,208  

2,388,354 

12-Feb-2015 

 168,149  

1,644,497 

% vesting 
at threshold 
performance

25

25

(1)  The share price on the date of performance awards grant was $9.78, when the RSS share awards were granted as nil-cost options. The awards were based on the share price as at 31 December 2014  

(being $8.69, based on the exchange rate of 1.5534). 

(2) These awards are due to vest subject to performance conditions being met at the end of the performance period ending 31 December 2017 and becoming exercisable after the meeting of the Board  

in February 2018. 

(3) The exercise share price is determined once an award has vested on the basis of the share price on the date an award is exercised. 

LOSS OF OFFICE PAYMENTS 
There were no loss of office payments during the 2015 year. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

83 
83

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

DETAILS OF ALL OUTSTANDING SHARE AWARDS 
In addition to awards made during the 2015 financial year, the table below sets out details of all outstanding RSS awards held by  
Executive Directors. 

PERFORMANCE AND DEFERRED BONUS AWARDS UNDER THE NIL-COST OPTION RESTRICTED SHARE SCHEME (RSS) 

Grant date1 

Exercise 
price

Awards held 
at 1-Jan-15

Awards 
granted 
during the 
year

Awards vested 
during the 
year

Awards lapsed 
during the 
year

Awards 
exercised 
during the 
year  

Awards
 held at 
31-Dec-15

End of 
performance 
period

Alex Maloney, 
Group CEO 

Performance RSS2,3   

28-Feb-12  

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

5-Mar-12  

Total 

Elaine Whelan, 
Group CFO & 
LICL CEO 

Performance RSS2,3 

28-Feb-13  

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

5-Mar-13  

Performance RSS2,3 

19-Feb-14  

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

5-Mar-14  

Performance RSS2,3 

12-Feb-15 

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

20-Mar-15 

Performance RSS2,3  

28-Feb-12  

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

5-Mar-12  

Performance RSS – 
Interim2,3 

4-May-12  

Performance RSS2,3 

28-Feb-13  

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

5-Mar-13  

Performance RSS2,3 

19-Feb-14  

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

5-Mar-14  

Performance RSS2,3 

12-Feb-15 

Deferred Bonus RSS4 

20-Mar-15 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 187,165 

4,485

 131,969 

11,695

124,333

29,430

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

244,208

41,929

93,583

93,582

93,583 

– 31-Dec-14

4,485

–

5,847

 – 

9,810 

–

–

–

–

–

 –  

 –  

–

–

4,485 

–

– 

131,969 31-Dec-15

5,847 

5,848

–   124,333 31-Dec-16

9,810 

19,620

– 

– 

244,208 31-Dec-17

41,929

489,077

286,137

113,725

93,582

113,725 

567,907

 48,586 

5,159

 25,000 

 116,087 

10,080

102,989

23,956

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

 – 

–

–

–

–

168,149

29,540

24,293

24,293

24,293 

– 31-Dec-14

5,159

–

5,159 

–

12,500

12,500

12,500 

– 31-Dec-14

–

5,040

 – 

7,985

–

–

–

–

 –  

 –  

–

–

– 

116,087 31-Dec-15

5,040 

5,040

 –  

 102,989  31-Dec-16

7,985 

15,971  

– 

– 

168,149 31-Dec-17

29,540  

Total 

331,857

197,689

54,977

36,793

54,977 

437,776  

 (1)  The market values of the common shares on the dates of grant were: 

•  28 February 2012 £7.90 

•  5 March 2012 £7.58 

•  4 May 2012 £7.99 

•  28 February 2013 £9.09 

•  5 March 2013 £9.08 

•  19 February 2014 £7.34 

•  5 March 2014 £7.26 

•  12 February 2015 £6.36 

•  20 March 2015 £6.30 

(2) The vesting of the RSS performance awards prior to 2013 grants is subject to two performance 

conditions as follows:  

•  Half of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the TSR performance of the 
Company against the TSR performance of a select group of comparator companies (see page 85 
for a list of comparator companies for each grant year), over a three-year performance period.  
25 per cent of this half of the award vests for median performance by the Company, rising to  
100 per cent vesting of this half of the award for upper quartile performance by the Company  
or better (with proportionate vesting between these two points). 

•  The other half of each award is subject to a performance condition based on average annual RoE 
over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this half of the award will vest if average 
annual RoE over the performance period exceeds the criteria set out in the table on page 85, 
whilst all of this part of the award will vest if the Company’s average RoE is equal to the more 
stringent criteria set out in the table on page 85. Between these two points vesting will take  
place on a straight-line basis from 25 per cent to 100 per cent for RoE performance. 

The vesting of the RSS performance awards from 2013 grants forward is subject to two 
performance conditions as follows:  

•  25 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the TSR performance 
of the Company against the TSR performance of a select group of comparator companies (see 
page 85 for a list of comparator companies for each grant year), over a three-year performance 
period. 25 per cent of this part of the award vests for median performance by the Company,  
rising to 100 per cent vesting of this part of the award for upper quartile performance by the 
Company or better (with proportionate vesting between these two points). 

•  The other 75 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition based on average 

annual RoE over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this part of the award will vest 
if average annual RoE over the performance period exceeds the criteria set out in the table on 
page 85, whilst all of this part of the award will vest if the Company’s average RoE is equal to 
the more stringent criteria set out in the table on page 85. Between these two points vesting  
will take place on a straight-line basis from 25 per cent to 100 per cent for RoE performance.  

(3) The vesting dates of the RSS performance awards are subject to being out of a close period and are 

as follows: 

•  2012 – 12 February 2015; 

•  2013 – 18 February 2016; 

•  2014 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2016 year-end results. 

•  2015 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2017 year-end results. 

(4) The vesting dates of the RSS Deferred Bonus awards are subject to being out of a close period and, 

for the 2012 to 2015 Deferred Bonus awards, are as follows: 

•  2012 – vested 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the 

release of the Company’s year-end results for 2012, 2013 and 2014; 

•  2013 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the release 

of the Company’s year-end results for 2013, 2014 and 2015;  

•  2014 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the release 

of the Company’s year-end results for 2014, 2015 and 2016; and 

•  2015 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the release 

of the Company’s year-end results for 2015, 2016 and 2017. 

84 
84 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
TSR TARGETS FOR RSS 

100% 

25% 

Nil 

ROE TARGETS FOR RSS 

100% 

25% 

Nil 

2012

2013*

2014*

2015* 

2016*

 75th percentile

75th percentile

75th percentile 

75th percentile  

75th percentile 

= median

< median

= median

< median

= median 

< median 

 = median  

< median  

= median 

< median 

2012

2013*

2014*

2015* 

2016*

13 week Tr + 15% 13 week Tr + 15% 13 week Tr +15%  13 week Tr +15%  

13 week Tr +15%

13 week Tr + 6% 13 week Tr + 6% 13 week Tr + 6%  13 week Tr + 6%  

13 week Tr + 6% 

<13 week Tr + 6% <13 week Tr + 6% <13 week Tr + 6%  <13 week Tr + 6%   <13 week Tr + 6% 

*  From 2013 onwards the split of targets has changed from 50 per cent RoE / 50 per cent TSR to 75 per cent RoE and 25 per cent TSR. 

Peer Companies 

Amlin plc1  

Argo Group International Holdings, Ltd. 

Aspen Insurance Holdings Limited 

Axis Capital Holdings Limited 

Beazley plc 

Catlin Group Ltd.2 

Endurance Specialty Holdings Ltd.3 

Everest Re Group, Ltd.4 

Flagstone Reinsurance Holdings Limited5 

Hannover Re6 

Hiscox Ltd. 

Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd.3 

Novae Group plc7 

Renaissance Re Holdings Ltd. 

Validus Holdings Ltd. 

2012 awards

2013 awards 

2014 awards

2015 awards 

2016 awards

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

–

X

–

X

X

–

X

X

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

– 

 – 

– 

X 

X 

– 

X 

X 

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

–

–

–

X

X

–

X

X

X 

X 

X 

X 

X 

– 

X 

X 

– 

X 

X 

– 

X 

X 

X 

–

X

X

X

X

–

X

X

–

X

X

–

X

X

X

(1)  Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Company announced on 8 September 2015 that it intended to acquire Amlin plc. The transaction completed on 1 February 2016. Accordingly, the Committee decided  

to use Amlin plc as a comparator company up to 30 June 2015. 

(2) Catlin Group Ltd. was acquired by the XL Group with effect from 1 May 2015 and so was used as a comparator company up to 31 December 2014. 

(3) Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd. was acquired by Endurance with effect from 31 July 2015 and so was used as a comparator company up to 31 December 2014. 

(4) Everest Re Group, Ltd. was added to the peer group of companies with effect from 1 July 2015 as a replacement for Amlin plc. 

(5) Flagstone Reinsurance Holdings Limited was acquired by Validus with effect from 30 November 2012 and so was used as a comparator company for 2012 up to 30 September 2012. 

(6) Hannover Re was added to the peer group of companies with effect from 1 January 2015 as a replacement for Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd. 

(7) Novae Group plc was added to the peer group of companies with effect from 1 January 2015 as a replacement for Catlin Group Ltd. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

85 
85

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

DIRECTORS' SHAREHOLDINGS AND SHARE INTERESTS 
A policy for formal shareholding guidelines was introduced in 2012. This requires the CEO to build and maintain a shareholding in  
the Company worth two times annual salary and for the CFO to build and maintain a shareholding of one times annual salary as set  
out in the Policy Report. 

Details of the Directors' interests in shares are shown in the table below.  

Director 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Peter Clarke 

Emma Duncan  

Simon Fraser 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson  

Tom Milligan 

Martin Thomas  

At 1 January 2015

At 31 December 2015 

Number of Ordinary Shares 

Legally owned

Legally owned

Subject to 
deferral 
under the RSS

Subject to 
performance 
conditions 
under the RSS

Vested but 
unexercised 
awards under 
other share  
based plans 

321,841

233,820

382,008

287,169

67,397

50,551

500,510

387,225

–

–

–

3,947

N/A

6,950

–

–

1,000

3,947

1,000

6,950

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

– 

– 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

N/A 

Total

949,915

724,945

–

–

1,000

3,947

1,000

6,950

Shareholding
guideline
achieved?

Yes

Yes

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Note: For the purpose of the shareholding guideline, legally owned shares are counted together with the net of tax value of deferred bonus and vested (but unexercised) long-term incentive awards. 

PERFORMANCE GRAPH  
The following graph shows the Company’s performance, measured by TSR, compared with the performance of the FTSE 250 Index.  
The Company’s common shares commenced trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009 and the Company joined the 
FTSE 250 Index on 22 June 2009 and is currently a constituent of this. 

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN

£

400

350

300

250

200

150

100

50

0

2008

2009

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

2015

LRE

FTSE 250 Index

Source: Thomson Reuters

This graph shows the value, by 31 December 2015, of £100 invested in LHL on 31 December 2008 compared with the value of  
£100 invested in the FTSE 250 Index. The other points plotted are the values at intervening financial year-ends. 

86 
86 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
TOTAL REMUNERATION HISTORY FOR CEO 
The table below sets out the total single figure remuneration for the CEOs over the last seven years with the annual bonus paid as  
a percentage of the maximum and the percentage of long-term share awards vesting in each year. 

Total remuneration ($000s) 

Annual bonus (%) 

LTI vesting (%) 

2009 

7,244 

68 

N/A 

2010

9,945

94

99.57

2011

9,623

73

100

2012

Richard Brindle  
20141 

Alex Maloney 
20142

2013

10,460

10,175

10,0725  

2,4054 

73

99

80

100

80  

613 

734 

50 

2015

3,712

63

75

(1)  Richard Brindle was the CEO from 2005 until he retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014.  

(2) Alex Maloney was appointed CEO effective 1 May 2014, after the retirement of Mr Brindle. For the purposes of this table his numbers have been pro-rated to account for only his time in office as  

CEO for 2014.  

(3) Mr Brindle was afforded good leaver status and all RSS award interests were vested upon his departure, using estimated TSR and RoE values at the time of his retirement. The amounts in the table  

above reflect all awards which vested in 2014. Further particulars of the vesting were reported in the Company’s 2014 Annual Report. 

(4) Alex Maloney’s 2014 total remuneration and annual bonus have been restated in the above table to reflect changes made after the publication of the 2014 Annual Report. These changes are primarily  

due to the disclosed relative RoE performance which impacted his annual bonus figure for 2014, as disclosed on page 80.  

(5) Richard Brindle’s total remuneration figure has also been restated in the above table to reflect changes made after the publication of the 2014 Annual Report; this change is primarily due to including  

Mr Brindle’s payment in lieu of six month’s notice which had not been included in 2014. 

The table above shows the total remuneration figure for the former CEO during each of the relevant financial years; the current CEO is 
reflected since his appointment to the position on 1 May 2014. The total remuneration figure includes the annual bonus and LTI awards 
which vested based on performance in those years. The annual bonus and LTI percentages show the pay-out for each year as a percentage 
of the maximum. 

PERCENTAGE CHANGE IN CEO REMUNERATION 
The following table sets out the percentage change in the aggregate value of salary, benefits and bonus for the Chief Executive from  
the preceding year and the average percentage change in respect of the employees of the Company taken as a whole. 

Base salary 

Benefits 

Bonus 

Year on 
 year change 
CEO2,3
% 

Average year 
on year change 
employees1
% 

-11

-6

-34

5

8

13

(1) Employee numbers were calculated on a per headcount basis as at 31 December 2015 and 31 December 2014, inclusive of the CEO.  

(2) A blended CEO rate was used for 2014 to account for CEO changes through the year.  

(3) Some amounts were paid in pounds sterling and converted at the average exchange rate of 1.5344 for the year.  

RELATIVE IMPORTANCE OF THE SPEND ON PAY 
The following table sets out the percentage change in dividends and overall spend on pay in the year ended 31 December 2015 compared to 
the year ended 31 December 2014.  

Employee remuneration costs 

Dividends 

2015  
$m 

80.1 

317.5 

2014 
$m

77.4 

321.0 

Percentage
 change
%

3

-1

COMMITTEE MEMBERS, ATTENDEES AND ADVICE 
The Remuneration Committee comprised the following members during the year and to the date of this Report (all of whom  
are independent Non-Executive Directors): 

Remuneration Committee 
Members 

Position 

Comments 

Simon Fraser 

LHL Remuneration Committee Chairman  Independent; Attended 8 of a potential maximum meetings of 8 in 2015

Peter Clarke 

Member from 4 November 2014 

Independent; Attended 8 of a potential maximum meetings of 8 in 2015

Emma Duncan 

Member from 5 November 2010 

Independent; Attended 7 of a potential maximum meetings of 8 in 2015

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

87 
87

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION REPORT CONTINUED 

The Remuneration Committee’s responsibilities are contained in its Terms of Reference, a copy of which is available on the Company’s 
website. These responsibilities include determining the framework for the remuneration, including pension arrangements, for all 
Executive Directors, the Chairman and senior executives. The Committee is also responsible for approving employment contracts  
for senior executives. 

REMUNERATION COMMITTEE ADVISER 
The Remuneration Committee is advised by NBS, a trading name of Aon Hewitt, being a subsidiary of Aon plc. NBS was appointed  
by the Remuneration Committee in 2007. NBS has discussions with the Remuneration Committee Chairman regularly on Committee 
process and topics, which are of particular relevance to the Company.  

Aon Benfield (which is part of Aon but is a separate business division to Aon Hewitt) provides reinsurance broking services to the Group.  

The primary role of NBS is to provide independent and objective advice and support to the Committee's Chairman and members.  
In order to manage any possible conflict of interest, NBS operates as a distinct business within the Aon Group and there is a robust 
separation between the business activities and management of NBS and all other parts of Aon Hewitt and the wider Aon Group.  
The Committee is satisfied that the advice that it receives is objective and independent. NBS is also a signatory to the Remuneration 
Consultants Group ('RCG') Code of Conduct which sets out guidelines for managing conflicts of interest, and has confirmed to the 
Committee its compliance with the RCG Code.  

The total fees paid to NBS in respect of its services to the Committee for the year ended 31 December 2015 were $132,330  
(2014 – $160,691). Fees are predominantly charged on a 'time spent' basis.  

ENGAGEMENT WITH SHAREHOLDERS 
Details of votes cast for and against the resolution to approve last year’s Remuneration Report are shown below and any matters  
discussed with shareholders during the year are provided in the Implementation of Remuneration Policy for 2016 section of the  
report starting on page 78.  

For  

Against 

Total 

Abstentions 

Vote to approve 2014 Annual Report on 
Remuneration 

Total number 
of votes

% of
 votes cast

92,692,097

39,185,080

131,877,177

8,472,313

70.3

29.7

100.0

The Board made a public announcement on 30 April 2015, which included the following statement: 

“The Board has noted the level of abstentions and the significant number of votes against the remuneration report at the AGM. 
Resolution 2 received 70.28 per cent of votes for and 29.71 per cent of votes against the resolution, with 8,472,313 of shares 
abstaining. Lancashire consulted with its major shareholders particularly on the topic of its remuneration policy and practice  
in advance of the 2015 AGM. The Board understands that the principal concern of shareholders was in relation to the exercise  
by the Board of discretion when settling the retirement remuneration package for Richard Brindle. The Board considered that the 
retirement arrangements for Richard Brindle were an appropriate reward for Mr Brindle’s unique contribution to Lancashire as a 
founder and chief executive and were also appropriate to secure an orderly and successful transition. These were necessarily unique 
circumstances and we will continue to engage with shareholders.”  

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board 

Simon Fraser 
LHL Remuneration Committee Chairman 

17 February 2016 

88 
88 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT 

OVERVIEW OF THE GROUP 
Lancashire Holdings Limited (the Company) is a Bermuda incorporated company (Registered Company No. 37415) with operating 
subsidiaries in Bermuda and London, and two Syndicates at Lloyd’s.  

The Company’s common shares were admitted to trading on AIM in December 2005 and were subsequently moved up to the  
Official List and to trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009. The shares have been included in the FTSE 250  
Index since 22 June 2009. 

PRINCIPAL ACTIVITIES 
The Company’s principal activity, through its wholly owned subsidiaries, is the provision of global specialty insurance and reinsurance 
products. On 7 November 2013, the Company completed the acquisition of CCL, an established Lloyd’s insurer, and in July 2013 
established Kinesis, a third-party capital and underwriting management facility, to complement the Group’s longstanding specialty 
insurance activities. An analysis of the Group’s business performance can be found in the Business review on pages 30 to 38. 

DIVIDENDS  
For the year ended 31 December 2015, the following dividends were declared:  

•  an interim dividend of $0.05 per common share and warrant was declared on 28 July 2015 and paid on 25 September 2015 in  

pounds sterling at the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate of 1.5388 or £0.0325 per common share and warrant;  

•  a special dividend of $0.95 per common share and warrant was declared on 4 November 2015 and paid on 18 December 2015  

in pounds sterling at the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate of 1.5049 or £0.6313 per common share and warrant; and 

•  a final dividend of $0.10 per common share was declared on 17 February 2016 to be paid on 23 March 2016 in pounds sterling  
at the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate on the record date of 26 February 2016 or approximately £0.07 per common share.  

DIVIDEND POLICY 
The Group intends to maintain a strong balance sheet at all times, while generating an attractive risk-adjusted total return for 
shareholders. We actively manage capital to achieve those aims. Capital management is expected to include the payment of a sustainable 
annual (interim and final) dividend, supplemented by special dividends from time to time. Dividends will be linked to past performance 
and future prospects. 

Under most scenarios, the annual dividend is not expected to reduce from one year to the next. Special dividends are expected to vary 
substantially in size and in timing. The Board may cancel the payment of any dividend between declaration and payment for purposes  
of compliance with regulatory requirements or for exceptional business reasons. 

DIRECTORS 
•  Peter Clarke (Non-Executive Director) 

•  Emma Duncan (Non-Executive Director) 

•  Simon Fraser (Senior Independent Non-Executive Director) 

•  Samantha Hoe-Richardson (Non-Executive Director) 

•  Alex Maloney (Chief Executive Officer) 

•  Tom Milligan (Non-Executive Director) (appointed effective 3 February 2015) 

•  Martin Thomas (Non-Executive Chairman) 

•  Elaine Whelan (Chief Financial Officer) 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

89 
89

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED 

DIRECTORS’ INTERESTS 
The Directors’ beneficial interests in the Company’s common shares as at 31 December 2015 and 2014 including interests held by  
family members were as follows: 

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE – COMPLIANCE STATEMENT 

The Company’s compliance with the Code is summarised in the Corporate Governance section of this Report on pages 59 to 61.  

The Company confirms, in accordance with the principle of ‘comply or explain’, that there are no areas of material non-compliance  

Director 

Peter Clarke 

Emma Duncan 

Simon Fraser1 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 

Alex Maloney2 

Tom Milligan3 

Martin Thomas 

Elaine Whelan4 

Common shares 
held as at
31 December 2015

Common shares 
held as at 
31 December 2014

–

–

1,000

3,947

382,008

1,000

6,950

287,169

–

–

–

3,947

321,841

–

6,950

233,820

There have been no changes in Directors’ shareholdings between the end of the financial year and the date of this Report. 

(1)  Simon Fraser conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  5 May – purchase of 1,000 shares at a price of £6.25 costing £6,246. 

(2) Includes 100,000 shares owned by his spouse, Amanda Maloney. Alex Maloney conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  25 March – exercise of 93,583 RSS awards and 20,142 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 53,558 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.30 realising £337,205. 

(3) Tom Milligan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  25 June – purchase of 1,000 shares at a price of £6.21 costing £6,205. 

(4)  Includes 2,600 shares owned by her spouse, Kilian Whelan. Elaine Whelan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  9 September – exercise of 36,793 RSS awards and 18,184 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 1,628 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.89 realising £11,217. 

TRANSACTION IN OWN SHARES 
The Company did not repurchase any of its own common shares during 2015. 

The Company repurchased 2,498,433 of its own common shares from 8 September 2014 through 20 November 2014 for a total 
consideration of approximately $25.0 million. These repurchases were made pursuant to resolutions of the shareholders passed  
at the AGM held on 30 April 2014 granting authority for the repurchase of up to 18,544,580 shares. All of the repurchased shares  
were initially held in treasury. 

The Group’s current repurchase programme has 20,034,191 common shares remaining to be purchased as at 31 December 2015 
(approximately $186.5 million at the 31 December 2015 share price). The purpose of the Company’s repurchase programme is to  
acquire shares to use in the future towards satisfying its obligations under its RSS awards. Further details of the share repurchase  
authority and programme are set out in note 23 to the consolidated financial statements on page 164. The repurchase programme  
is subject to renewal at the 2016 AGM in an amount of up to 10 per cent of the then issued common share capital. 

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION 
Details of the Directors’ remuneration are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 71 to 88. 

CREDITOR PAYMENT POLICY 

The Group aims to pay all creditors promptly and in accordance with contractual and legal obligations. 

SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS 
As at 17 February 2016, the Company was aware of the following interests of 3 per cent or more in the Company’s issued share capital: 

Name 

Invesco Limited 

Woodford Investment Management LLP 

Setanta Asset Management Limited 

Vidacos Nominees Ltd 

Legal & General Group Plc 

BlackRock, Inc. 

Franklin Mutual Advisers, LLC 

Number of 
shares as at 
17 February 
2016

39,968,928

21,595,170

14,613,832

10,342,300

9,739,779

8,976,004

7,856,956

% of shares
 in issue

20.0

10.8

7.3

5.2

4.9

4.5

3.9

90 
90 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

www.lancashiregroup.com 

91 

with the Code. 

DONATIONS 

of 2014. 

During 2015 the Company facilitated a donation of $2.5 million to the Lancashire Foundation from a third party. In view of this 

substantial donation, the Company decided not to make any further donation to the Foundation during 2015. The Foundation held 

warrants in the Company, which were exercised in May 2015, and the dividend equivalent payments received on the warrants, which  

had been an important income stream for the Foundation, will be taken into account when considering the appropriate level of 

donations to be made by the Company in the future. The Foundation now owns 330,713 common shares in the Company and will  

receive any dividends declared on those shares. 

In November 2013, the Board of Directors approved a cash donation of $2.0 million to the Lancashire Foundation, payable in respect  

Lancashire established the Lancashire Foundation as a Bermuda charitable trust in 2007, with the aim of creating a trust for the benefit  

of charitable causes in Bermuda, the UK and worldwide. During 2012, the assets of the Lancashire Foundation were transferred to the 

Lancashire Foundation charitable trust established in England and Wales and registered with the Charity Commission. The Lancashire 

Foundation’s trustees are two senior employees, a subsidiary Non-Executive Director and the Group Chairman. The Trustees make 

donations following recommendations made by the Company’s Donations Committee consisting of the Group’s employees.  

A summary of the work of the Lancashire Foundation during 2015 can be found in the Corporate Responsibility section on  

The Group did not make any political donations or expenditure during 2015 or 2014. 

pages 44 to 49. 

HEALTH AND SAFETY 

The Group considers the health and safety of its employees to be a management responsibility equal to that of any other function.  

The Group operates in compliance with health and safety legislative requirements in Bermuda and the UK. 

GREENHOUSE GAS EMISSIONS 

The Group’s greenhouse gas emissions are detailed in the Corporate Responsibility section on page 47. 

G

O

V

E

R

N

A

N

C

E

EMPLOYEES 

The Group is an equal opportunity employer, and does not tolerate unfair discrimination of any kind in any area of employment or 

corporate life. The Group believes that education and training for employees is a continuous process and employees are encouraged  

to discuss training needs with their managers. The Group’s health and safety, equal opportunities, training and other policies are 

available to all employees in the staff handbook which is available on the Group’s intranet. 

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK EXPOSURES  

Information regarding the Group’s risk exposures is included in the risk disclosures section on pages 112 to 138 of the consolidated 

financial statements. The Group’s use of derivative financial instruments can be found on pages 127 to 130. 

ACCOUNTING STANDARDS 

The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS  

as adopted by the European Union. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance 

products, the IFRS framework allows reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Board 

determines appropriate measurement bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, 

using their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP. 

 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED 

DIRECTORS’ INTERESTS 

family members were as follows: 

Director 

Peter Clarke 

Emma Duncan 

Simon Fraser1 

Alex Maloney2 

Tom Milligan3 

Martin Thomas 

Elaine Whelan4 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 

The Directors’ beneficial interests in the Company’s common shares as at 31 December 2015 and 2014 including interests held by  

Common shares 

Common shares 

held as at

held as at 

31 December 2015

31 December 2014

–

–

1,000

3,947

382,008

1,000

6,950

287,169

–

–

–

–

3,947

321,841

6,950

233,820

Number of 

shares as at 

17 February 

2016

39,968,928

21,595,170

14,613,832

10,342,300

9,739,779

8,976,004

7,856,956

% of shares

 in issue

20.0

10.8

7.3

5.2

4.9

4.5

3.9

There have been no changes in Directors’ shareholdings between the end of the financial year and the date of this Report. 

(1)  Simon Fraser conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  5 May – purchase of 1,000 shares at a price of £6.25 costing £6,246. 

(2) Includes 100,000 shares owned by his spouse, Amanda Maloney. Alex Maloney conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  25 March – exercise of 93,583 RSS awards and 20,142 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 53,558 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.30 realising £337,205. 

(3) Tom Milligan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  25 June – purchase of 1,000 shares at a price of £6.21 costing £6,205. 

(4)  Includes 2,600 shares owned by her spouse, Kilian Whelan. Elaine Whelan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2015: 

•  9 September – exercise of 36,793 RSS awards and 18,184 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 1,628 shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £6.89 realising £11,217. 

TRANSACTION IN OWN SHARES 

The Company did not repurchase any of its own common shares during 2015. 

The Company repurchased 2,498,433 of its own common shares from 8 September 2014 through 20 November 2014 for a total 

consideration of approximately $25.0 million. These repurchases were made pursuant to resolutions of the shareholders passed  

at the AGM held on 30 April 2014 granting authority for the repurchase of up to 18,544,580 shares. All of the repurchased shares  

were initially held in treasury. 

The Group’s current repurchase programme has 20,034,191 common shares remaining to be purchased as at 31 December 2015 

(approximately $186.5 million at the 31 December 2015 share price). The purpose of the Company’s repurchase programme is to  

acquire shares to use in the future towards satisfying its obligations under its RSS awards. Further details of the share repurchase  

authority and programme are set out in note 23 to the consolidated financial statements on page 164. The repurchase programme  

is subject to renewal at the 2016 AGM in an amount of up to 10 per cent of the then issued common share capital. 

Details of the Directors’ remuneration are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 71 to 88. 

As at 17 February 2016, the Company was aware of the following interests of 3 per cent or more in the Company’s issued share capital: 

DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION 

SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS 

Name 

Invesco Limited 

Woodford Investment Management LLP 

Setanta Asset Management Limited 

Vidacos Nominees Ltd 

Legal & General Group Plc 

BlackRock, Inc. 

Franklin Mutual Advisers, LLC 

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE – COMPLIANCE STATEMENT 
The Company’s compliance with the Code is summarised in the Corporate Governance section of this Report on pages 59 to 61.  

The Company confirms, in accordance with the principle of ‘comply or explain’, that there are no areas of material non-compliance  
with the Code. 

DONATIONS 
During 2015 the Company facilitated a donation of $2.5 million to the Lancashire Foundation from a third party. In view of this 
substantial donation, the Company decided not to make any further donation to the Foundation during 2015. The Foundation held 
warrants in the Company, which were exercised in May 2015, and the dividend equivalent payments received on the warrants, which  
had been an important income stream for the Foundation, will be taken into account when considering the appropriate level of 
donations to be made by the Company in the future. The Foundation now owns 330,713 common shares in the Company and will  
receive any dividends declared on those shares. 

In November 2013, the Board of Directors approved a cash donation of $2.0 million to the Lancashire Foundation, payable in respect  
of 2014. 

Lancashire established the Lancashire Foundation as a Bermuda charitable trust in 2007, with the aim of creating a trust for the benefit  
of charitable causes in Bermuda, the UK and worldwide. During 2012, the assets of the Lancashire Foundation were transferred to the 
Lancashire Foundation charitable trust established in England and Wales and registered with the Charity Commission. The Lancashire 
Foundation’s trustees are two senior employees, a subsidiary Non-Executive Director and the Group Chairman. The Trustees make 
donations following recommendations made by the Company’s Donations Committee consisting of the Group’s employees.  

A summary of the work of the Lancashire Foundation during 2015 can be found in the Corporate Responsibility section on  
pages 44 to 49. 

The Group did not make any political donations or expenditure during 2015 or 2014. 

HEALTH AND SAFETY 
The Group considers the health and safety of its employees to be a management responsibility equal to that of any other function.  

The Group operates in compliance with health and safety legislative requirements in Bermuda and the UK. 

GREENHOUSE GAS EMISSIONS 
The Group’s greenhouse gas emissions are detailed in the Corporate Responsibility section on page 47. 

EMPLOYEES 
The Group is an equal opportunity employer, and does not tolerate unfair discrimination of any kind in any area of employment or 
corporate life. The Group believes that education and training for employees is a continuous process and employees are encouraged  
to discuss training needs with their managers. The Group’s health and safety, equal opportunities, training and other policies are 
available to all employees in the staff handbook which is available on the Group’s intranet. 

CREDITOR PAYMENT POLICY 
The Group aims to pay all creditors promptly and in accordance with contractual and legal obligations. 

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK EXPOSURES  
Information regarding the Group’s risk exposures is included in the risk disclosures section on pages 112 to 138 of the consolidated 
financial statements. The Group’s use of derivative financial instruments can be found on pages 127 to 130. 

ACCOUNTING STANDARDS 
The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS  
as adopted by the European Union. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance 
products, the IFRS framework allows reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Board 
determines appropriate measurement bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, 
using their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP. 

G
O
V
E
R
N
A
N
C
E

90 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

91 
91

GOVERNANCE 
 
 
 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT CONTINUED 

ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 
The notice of the 2016 AGM, to be held on 4 May 2016 at the Company’s head office, 29th Floor, 20 Fenchurch Street, London  
EC3M 3BY, UK, is contained in a separate circular to shareholders which is made available to shareholders at the same time as  
this Annual Report and Accounts. The notice of the AGM is also available on the Company’s website. 

ELECTRONIC AND WEB COMMUNICATIONS 
Provisions of the Bermuda Companies Act 1981 enable companies to communicate with shareholders by electronic and/or website 
communications. The Company will notify shareholders (either in writing or by other permitted means) when a relevant document  
or other information is placed on the website and a shareholder may request a hard copy version of the document or information. 

GOING CONCERN AND VIABILITY STATEMENT 
The Business Review section on pages 30 to 38 sets out details of the Group’s financial performance, capital management, business 
environment and outlook. In addition, further discussion of the principal risks and material uncertainties affecting the Group can be 
found on pages 42 to 43. Starting on page 112, the risk disclosures section of the consolidated financial statements sets out the principal 
risks to which the Group is exposed, including insurance, market, liquidity, credit, operational and strategic, together with the Group’s 
policies for monitoring, managing and mitigating its exposures to these risks. The Board considers annually and on a rolling basis a three-
year strategic plan for the business which the Company progressively implements. A three-year plan period aligns to the short-tail nature 
of the Group’s liabilities and the agility in the business model, allowing the Group to adapt capital and solvency quickly in response to 
market cycles, events and opportunities. This is consistent with the outlook period in the Group’s ORSA. The three-year strategic plan  
was last approved by the Board on 29 April 2015. The Board receives quarterly reports from the CRO and sets and approves risk 
tolerances for the business.  

During 2015, the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten  
its business model, future performance, solvency or liquidity. As part of this assessment the business plan was stressed for a number of 
scenarios and the impact on capital (on both an IFRS and Solvency II basis) evaluated. The Directors believe that the Group is well  
placed to manage its business risks successfully, having taken into account the current economic outlook. Accordingly, the Board  
believes that, taking into account the Group’s current position, and subject to the principal risks faced by the business, the Group  
will be able to continue in operation and to meet its liabilities as they fall due for the period up to 31 December 2017, being the  
period considered under the Group’s current three-year strategic plan. 

The Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Company will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they  
fall due over the period to 31 December 2017. Accordingly, the Board has adopted and continues to consider appropriate the going 
concern basis in preparing the Annual Report and Accounts. 

AUDITORS 
Resolutions will be proposed at the Company’s 2016 AGM to re-appoint EY as the Company’s auditors and to authorise the Directors  
to set the auditors’ remuneration. Ernst & Young have served as the Company’s auditors since 2005. 

The Company plans to carry out an audit tender process during 2016 and to recommend an auditor to the shareholders to vote on  
at the 2017 AGM. 

DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION TO THE AUDITORS 
Each of the persons who is a Director at the date of approval of this Annual Report and Accounts confirms that: 

•  so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Company’s auditors are unaware; and  

•  the Director has taken all the steps that he or she ought to have taken as a Director in order to make himself or herself aware  

of any relevant audit information and to establish that the Company’s auditors are aware of that information. 

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board. 

Christopher Head 
Company Secretary 

17 February 2016 

92 
92 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
STATEMENT OF DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITIES 

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and Accounts and the Group’s consolidated financial statements  
in accordance with applicable law and regulations. 

Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial statements for each financial year that give a true and fair view of the state  
of affairs of the Company and the Group and of the profit or loss of the Group for that period. The consolidated financial statements 
have been prepared in accordance with IFRS. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement  
of insurance products, U.S. GAAP is considered. Further detail on the basis of preparation is described in the consolidated financial 
statements. In preparing the consolidated financial statements, the Directors are required to: 

•  select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently; 

•  make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent; 

•  state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRS; 

•  state whether applicable accounting standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the  

Group’s consolidated financial statements;  

•  provide additional disclosures where compliance with the specific requirements of IFRS are considered to be insufficient to enable 
users to understand the impact of particular transactions, events and conditions on the financial position and performance; and 

•  prepare the consolidated financial statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Company and 

the Group will continue in business. 

The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the Company’s and  
the Group’s transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the Company and the Group,  
and enable them to ensure that the consolidated financial statements comply with applicable laws and regulations. They are also 
responsible for safeguarding the assets of the Group and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of  
fraud and other irregularities. 

DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITY STATEMENT 
The Directors confirm that to the best of their knowledge: 

1.  the consolidated financial statements, prepared in accordance with IFRS, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities,  

financial position and profit of the Group;  

2.  the Board considers the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, are fair, balanced and understandable and provide  

the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company’s position and performance, business model and strategy; and  

3.  the Strategy and the Business review include a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position  

of the Group, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that the Group faces. 

Legislation in Bermuda governing the preparation and dissemination of the consolidated financial statements may differ from legislation  
in other jurisdictions. In addition, the rights of shareholders under Bermuda law may differ from those for shareholders of companies 
incorporated in other jurisdictions. 

By order of the Board 

17 February 2016 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

93 
93

GOVERNANCE 
 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Traction 

in the marketplace

We know how difficult it is to gain a 
foothold in the marketplace and we 
know the importance of getting stuck 
in and digging deep to ensure our 
performance doesn’t slip.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

96  Independent auditors’ report
102  Consolidated primary statements
106  Accounting policies
112  Risk disclosures
139  Notes to the accounts

94 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 

95

 
 
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT TO THE MEMBERS OF LANCASHIRE HOLDINGS LIMITED 

OUR OPINION ON THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS  
In our opinion the consolidated financial statements: 

•  give a true and fair view of the state of the Group's affairs as at 31 December 2015 and of its profit for the year then ended; and 

•  have been properly prepared in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by the European Union.  

WHAT WE HAVE AUDITED 
LHL’s financial statements comprise: 

•  the consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 2015; 

•  the consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the year then ended; 

•  the consolidated statement of changes in shareholders' equity for the year then ended; 

•  the statement of consolidated cash flows for the year then ended; and  

•  the accounting policies, the risk disclosures, and the related notes to the accounts 1 to 31.  

The financial reporting framework that has been applied in their preparation is applicable law and International Financial  
Reporting Standards (IFRSs) as adopted by the European Union.  

This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with our engagement letter dated 7 August 2015. Our 
audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are required to state to them in an 
auditors’ report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone 
other than the Company and the Company’s members as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed.  

OVERVIEW OF OUR AUDIT APPROACH 

Risks of material misstatement 

•  Valuation of loss reserves 

•  Goodwill and intangible assets 

•  Revenue recognition – premium estimates 

Audit scope 

•  We performed an audit of the complete financial information of 4 components 

•  The components where we performed full or specific audit procedures accounted for 100 per cent 

of profit before tax, 100 per cent of gross premiums written and 100 per cent of insurance  
contract liabilities 

Materiality 

 Overall Group materiality of $8.6 million, which represents 5 per cent of profit before tax 

OUR ASSESSMENT OF RISKS OF MATERIAL MISSTATEMENT AND RESPONSE TO THOSE RISKS  
We identified the risks of material misstatement described below as those that had the greatest effect on our overall audit strategy, the 
allocation of resources in the audit and the direction of the efforts of the audit team. These risks are consistent with those identified 
during the 2014 audit. In addressing these risks, we have performed the procedures below which were designed in the context of the 
consolidated financial statements as a whole and, consequently, we do not express any opinion on these individual areas.  

96 
96 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
VALUATION OF LOSS RESERVES 
Refer to page 62 (Audit Committee report), page 109 (accounting policies), page 120 (risk disclosures), and page 155 (disclosures) 

Risk 

  Response 

The valuation of loss 
reserves incorporates a 
significant amount of 
judgement. It is reasonably 
possible that uncertainties 
inherent in the reserving 
process, delays in insureds  
or ceding companies 
reporting losses to the 
Group, together with the 
potential for unforeseen 
adverse developments, could 
lead to the ultimate amount 
paid varying materially from 
the amount estimated at this 
reporting date. 

We understood, assessed and tested the design and operational effectiveness 
of the key controls in the Group’s reserving process, including the review and 
approval of the reserves, and controls over the extraction of data from the 
claims systems.  

Supported by our actuarial specialists, we evaluated management’s 
methodology against market practice and challenged management’s 
assumptions and their assessment of major sensitivities, based on our market 
knowledge and industry data where available. The main areas of judgement 
include the level of reserves held for specific losses, the loss development 
patterns selected and the initial expected loss ratios. 

Using management’s data, we independently re-projected the loss and loss 
adjustment expense reserves for LUK, LICL, and Cathedral on both a gross 
and net basis, investigating significant differences between our projections 
and management’s booked reserves. Using our own re-projection we then 
considered whether the loss and loss adjustment expense reserves held at  
the year-end fall within a reasonable range of possible estimates. 

We considered the results of the third-party actuarial review of the loss and 
loss adjustment reserves as at the reporting date, presented to the Audit 
Committee, again specifically to identify and understand any significant 
differences in projections.  

In light of our work outlined above, we considered the adequacy of 
disclosures of the judgements and uncertainties being made by the  
Directors in the insurance risk note on page 114 and note 13 related  
to losses and loss adjustment expenses. 

What we concluded to the Audit 
Committee 

Taken as a whole, we 
consider that management’s 
judgement in the areas 
highlighted is reasonable 
based on the information 
available at the date of this 
report. Consistent with  
the prior period, the 
Group’s booked reserves  
lie within what we consider 
to be a reasonable range  
of estimates. 

In addition we consider  
that the disclosures made 
are satisfactory, and they 
provide information that 
assists in understanding the 
uncertainty inherent in the 
valuation of loss reserves. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

97 
97

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT TO THE MEMBERS OF LANCASHIRE HOLDINGS LIMITED CONTINUED 

What we concluded to the Audit 
Committee 

We agreed with 
management’s assessment  
at 30 September 2015, that 
the recoverable amounts 
exceeded the recorded 
values with headroom 
remaining when key 
assumptions were stressed 
for what we consider to  
be cautious assumptions, 
and that as a result,  
no impairment of the 
goodwill and indefinite  
lived intangible assets  
was required. 

We also agreed with 
management’s assessment 
that no impairment triggers 
occurred in the final quarter 
of the year. 

What we concluded to the Audit 
Committee 

Based on the results of the 
procedures performed we 
have concluded that the 
premium estimates are 
recorded in line with the 
Group’s accounting policy. 

GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS 
Refer to page 62 (Audit Committee report), page 108 (accounting policy) and page 159 (disclosures) 

Risk 

  Response 

During 2015 we considered 
the risk that the goodwill 
and intangible assets arising 
from the Cathedral 
acquisition may be impaired. 

In testing for impairment, 
judgement is applied by 
management in deriving:  

•  the forecast cash flows; 

and 

•  the pre-tax discount  
rate applied to those  
cash flows. 

Management's impairment assessment of the recorded value of goodwill and 
the syndicate participation rights was performed as at 30 September 2015.  
We evaluated and challenged this assessment, including: 

•  validating that the base cash flows used are consistent with the three year 

forecast approved by the Board; 

•  challenging the three year plan, having regard to back testing performed 
by management to support the robustness of the forecast process and 
having regard to market conditions; 

•  satisfied ourselves whether the pre-tax discount rate applied is appropriate 
by assessing the cost of capital for the Group and comparable businesses; 
and 

•  assessing whether long term growth assumptions are consistent with 
economic and industry forecasts; and challenging the adequacy of 
sensitivity analysis performed by management, by re-performing our  
own stress tests of the pre-tax discount rate, forecast cash flows, and  
long term growth rate assumptions in isolation and in combination  
to consider reasonably possible alternative scenarios. 

REVENUE RECOGNITION – PREMIUM ESTIMATES 
Refer to page 63 (Audit Committee report) and page 108 (accounting policy)  

Risk 

  Response 

We evaluated and tested the key controls over the premium estimation 
process, which include the periodic review by management of estimated 
premiums, taking into account any third-party information received from 
intermediaries or insureds.  

For a sample of policies we verified the year end estimated premium income, 
including considering the basis of estimation and corroborating evidence 
such as information from brokers.  

We have analysed the development, during the period, of estimates 
recognised as at 31 December 2014 to identify if there is any indication  
of management bias. 

For certain contracts written, 
premium revenues are 
initially recognised based  
on estimates of ultimate 
premiums. This occurs for 
contracts where pricing is 
based on variables which  
are not known with certainty 
at the point of binding  
the contract. Subsequent 
adjustments to those 
estimates, which arise  
as updated information 
relating to those pricing 
variables becomes available, 
are recorded in the  
period in which they  
are determined.  

These estimates are 
judgemental and  
therefore could result  
in misstatements of  
revenue recognised  
in the consolidated  
financial statements. 

98 
98 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
THE SCOPE OF OUR AUDIT 
TAILORING THE SCOPE 
Our assessment of audit risk, our evaluation of materiality and our allocation of performance materiality determine our audit scope  
for each component within the Group. Taken together, this enables us to form an opinion on the consolidated financial statements.  
We take into account size, risk profile, the organisation of the Group and effectiveness of group-wide controls, changes in the business 
environment and other factors such as recent Internal Audit results when assessing the level of work to be performed at each component. 

In assessing the risk of material misstatement to the consolidated financial statements, and to ensure we had adequate quantitative 
coverage of significant accounts in the consolidated financial statements, we selected all of the reporting components of the Group, 
covering the insurance entities within UK and Bermuda, namely LUK, LICL, and Cathedral, the Group Companies, which include the 
third-party capital management business, Kinesis, and the Group’s investment in associate. 

We performed an audit of the complete financial information of the four components (“full scope components”) which were selected 
based on their size or risk characteristics. We carried out specific audit procedures on the balances arising from the Group’s investment  
in associate. 

The reporting components where we performed audit procedures accounted for 100 per cent (2014: 97 per cent) of the Group’s profit 
before tax, 100 per cent (2014: 100 per cent) of the Group’s gross premiums written and 100 per cent (2014: 100 per cent) of the Group’s 
insurance contract liabilities. 

The charts below illustrate the coverage obtained from the work performed by our audit teams. 

PROFIT BEFORE TAX

GROSS PREMIUMS WRITTEN

INSURANCE CONTRACT LIABILITIES

98% Full scope audit procedures
2% Specific scope audit procedures

100% Full scope audit procedures

100% Full scope audit procedures

CHANGES FROM THE PRIOR YEAR  
There have been no material scoping changes from the prior year. 

INVOLVEMENT WITH COMPONENT TEAMS 
In establishing our overall approach to the Group audit, we determined the type of work that needed to be undertaken at each of the 
components by us, as the primary audit engagement team, or by component auditors from other EY global network firms operating 
under our instruction.  

The Group audit team visited all of the full scope components. These visits involved discussing the audit approach with the component 
team and any issues arising from their work, meeting with local management, and reviewing key audit working papers on the Group risk 
areas. The primary team interacted regularly with the component teams where appropriate during various stages of the audit, reviewed 
key working papers and were responsible for the scope and direction of the audit process. This, together with the additional procedures 
performed at Group level, gave us appropriate evidence for our opinion on the consolidated financial statements. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

99 
99

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT TO THE MEMBERS OF LANCASHIRE HOLDINGS LIMITED CONTINUED 

OUR APPLICATION OF MATERIALITY  
We apply the concept of materiality in planning and performing our audit, in evaluating the effect of identified misstatements on  
our audit and in forming our audit opinion. 

MATERIALITY 
The magnitude of an omission or misstatement that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions  
of the users of the financial statements. Materiality provides a basis for determining the nature and extent of our audit procedures. 

We determined materiality for the Group to be $8.6 million (2014: $10.0 million), which is approximately 5 per cent (2014: 
approximately 5 per cent) of profit before tax. This provided a basis for determining the nature, timing and extent of risk assessment 
procedures, identifying and assessing the risk of material misstatement and determining the nature, timings and extent of further  
audit procedures. The decrease in materiality from the prior period is due to the reduced profit before tax during the current period. 

PERFORMANCE MATERIALITY 
The application of materiality at the individual account or balance level. It is set at an amount to reduce to an appropriately low level the probability  
that the aggregate of uncorrected and undetected misstatements exceeds materiality. 

On the basis of our risk assessments, together with our assessment of the Group’s overall control environment, our judgement was  
that performance materiality was 50 per cent (2014: 50 per cent) of our planning materiality, namely $4.3 million (2014: $5.0 million). 

Audit work at component locations for the purpose of obtaining audit coverage over significant financial statement accounts is 
undertaken based on a percentage of total performance materiality. The performance materiality set for each component is based on  
the relative scale and risk of the component to the Group as a whole and our assessment of the risk of misstatement at that component.  
In the current year, the range of performance materiality allocated to components was $4.3 million to $2.4 million (2014: $4.0 million  
to $1.2 million).  

REPORTING THRESHOLD 
An amount below which identified misstatements are considered as being clearly trivial. 

We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would report to them all uncorrected audit differences in excess of $0.5 million  
(2014: $0.5 million), as well as differences below that threshold that, in our view, warranted reporting on qualitative grounds.  

In forming our opinion, we evaluate any uncorrected misstatements against both the quantitative measures of materiality discussed  
above and in the light of other relevant qualitative considerations. 

SCOPE OF THE AUDIT OF THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
An audit involves obtaining evidence about the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements sufficient to give 
reasonable assurance that the consolidated financial statements are free from material misstatement, whether caused by fraud or  
error. This includes an assessment of: whether the accounting policies are appropriate to the Group’s circumstances and have been 
consistently applied and adequately disclosed; the reasonableness of significant accounting estimates made by the Directors; and the 
overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements.  

In addition, we read all the financial and non-financial information in the Annual Report and Accounts to identify material 
inconsistencies with the audited consolidated financial statements and to identify any information that is apparently materially  
incorrect based on, or materially inconsistent with, the knowledge acquired by us in the course of performing the audit. If we  
become aware of any apparent material misstatements or inconsistencies we consider the implications for our report.  

RESPECTIVE RESPONSIBILITIES OF DIRECTORS AND AUDITORS  
As explained more fully in the Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities set out on page 93, the Directors are responsible for the 
preparation of the consolidated financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view. Our responsibility is to 
audit and express an opinion on the consolidated financial statements in accordance with applicable law and International Standards  
on Auditing (UK and Ireland). Those standards require us to comply with the Auditing Practices Board’s Ethical Standards for Auditors.  

The Company has also instructed us to audit the section of the Directors’ Remuneration Report that has been described as audited  
and state whether it has been properly prepared in accordance with the basis of preparation described therein. 

To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the  
Company’s members as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed. 

100 
100 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
OPINION ON OTHER MATTER 
In our opinion the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report that is described as having been audited has been properly prepared  
in accordance with the basis of preparation as described therein. 

MATTERS ON WHICH WE ARE REQUIRED TO REPORT BY EXCEPTION  

ISAs (UK and Ireland) 
reporting 

We are required to report to you if, in our opinion, financial and non-financial 
information in the Annual Report and Accounts is:  

•  materially inconsistent with the information in the audited consolidated financial 

statements; or  

•  apparently materially incorrect based on, or materially inconsistent with, our  
knowledge of the Group acquired in the course of performing our audit; or  

•  otherwise misleading.  

In particular, we are required to report whether we have identified any inconsistencies 
between our knowledge acquired in the course of performing the audit and the Directors' 
statement that they consider that the Annual Report and Accounts taken as a whole is fair, 
balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to 
assess the entity's performance, business model and strategy; and whether the Annual 
Report and Accounts appropriately addresses those matters that we communicated to the 
Audit Committee that we consider should have been disclosed. 

We have no 
exceptions  
to report. 

Listing Rules review 
requirements 

We are required to review the part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating  
to the Company’s compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance  
Code specified for our review. 

We have no 
exceptions  
to report 

STATEMENT ON THE DIRECTORS’ ASSESSMENT OF THE PRINCIPAL RISKS THAT WOULD THREATEN THE SOLVENCY OR LIQUIDITY 
OF THE ENTITY 

ISAs (UK and Ireland) 
reporting 

We are required to give a statement as to whether we have anything material to add or  
to draw attention to in relation to: 

•  the Directors' confirmation in the Annual Report and Accounts that they have carried 
out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the entity, including those that 
would threaten its business model, future performance, solvency or liquidity; 

•  the disclosures in the Annual Report and Accounts that describe those risks and  

explain how they are being managed or mitigated; 

•  the Directors' statement in the Annual Report and Accounts about whether they 

considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in preparing 
them, and their identification of any material uncertainties to the entity's ability to 
continue to do so over a period of at least twelve months from the date of approval  
of the consolidated financial statements; and 

•  the Directors' explanation in the Annual Report and Accounts as to how they have 

assessed the prospects of the entity, over what period they have done so and why they 
consider that period to be appropriate, and their statement as to whether they have a 
reasonable expectation that the entity will be able to continue in operation and meet  
its liabilities as they fall due over the period of their assessment, including any related 
disclosures drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or assumptions. 

We have no 
exceptions  
to report. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

Ernst & Young LLP 
London 

17 February 2016 

(1)  The maintenance and integrity of the Lancashire Holdings Limited website is the responsibility of the Directors; the work carried out by the auditors does not involve consideration of these matters and, 

accordingly, the auditors accept no responsibility for any changes that may have occurred to the consolidated financial statements since they were initially presented on the website. 

(2) Legislation in the United Kingdom governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

101 
101

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME 
For the year ended 31 December 2015 

Gross premiums written 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 

Net premiums written 

Change in unearned premiums  

Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Net investment income 

Net other investment (losses) income  

Net realised (losses) gains and impairments 

Share of profit of associates 

Other income 

Net foreign exchange losses  

Total net revenue 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Net insurance losses 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Other operating expenses 

Equity based compensation 

Total expenses 

Results of operating activities 

Financing costs 

Profit before tax 

Tax credit 

Profit for the year 

Profit for the year attributable to: 

Equity shareholders of LHL 

Non-controlling interests 

Profit for the year 

Other comprehensive loss to be reclassified to 
profit or loss in subsequent periods 

Net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments 

Tax provision on net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments 

Other comprehensive loss 

Total comprehensive income for the year 

Total comprehensive income attributable to: 

Equity shareholders of LHL 

Non-controlling interests 

Total comprehensive income for the year 

Earnings per share 

Basic 

Diluted 

102 
102 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Notes 

2 

2 

2 

2 

3 

3 

3 

17 

27 

2, 13 

2, 13 

2, 4 

2, 4 

5, 6, 25 

6 

7 

8 

3, 10 

10 

10 

2015 
$m

641.1

(159.4)

481.7

79.9

5.5

567.1

29.8

(1.3)

(2.8)

4.1

19.9

(2.4)

614.4

177.5

(21.8)

155.7

148.2

(2.0)

106.6

15.8

424.3

190.1

18.4

171.7

10.0

181.7

181.1

0.6

181.7

(11.6)

0.3

(11.3)

170.4

169.8

0.6

170.4

26 

26 

$0.93

$0.91

2014 
$m

907.6

(164.8)

742.8

(37.0)

9.8

715.6

28.6

1.4

(5.9)

5.9

19.3

(0.1)

764.8

237.9

(11.4)

226.5

161.8

(8.4)

111.3

23.3

514.5

250.3

23.8

226.5

3.1

229.6

229.3

0.3

229.6

(2.2)

0.1

(2.1)

227.5

227.2

0.3

227.5

$1.24

$1.16

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET 
As at 31 December 2015 

Assets 

Cash and cash equivalents 

Accrued interest receivable  

Investments  

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants 

Reinsurance assets 

– Unearned premiums on premiums ceded 

– Reinsurance recoveries 

– Other receivables  

Other receivables  

Corporation tax receivable 

Investment in associate 

Property, plant and equipment 

Deferred acquisition costs  

Intangible assets 

Total assets 

Liabilities 

Insurance contracts 

– Losses and loss adjustment expenses 

– Unearned premiums 

– Other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers  

Deferred acquisition costs ceded 

Other payables 

Corporation tax payable 

Deferred tax liability 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total liabilities 

Shareholders’ equity 

Share capital 

Own shares 

Other reserves 

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income 

Retained earnings  

Total shareholders' equity attributable to equity shareholders of LHL 

Non-controlling interests 

Total shareholders’ equity 

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity 

Notes 

9, 22 

10, 11, 22 

14 

12 

13 

12, 14 

11, 17 

18 

15 

19 

13 

20 

20, 21 

12, 21 

15 

21 

16 

22 

22 

23 

23 

24 

10 

27 

2015 
$m

2014 
$m

291.8

6.5

1,773.3

253.7

30.2

83.9

2.7

37.8

–

47.5

7.2

87.2

153.8

2,775.6

671.0

399.2

36.2

26.6

0.3

67.0

1.8

25.6

4.8

303.5

7.7

1,986.9

316.2

24.7

112.4

5.3

36.6

4.3

52.7

9.1

104.6

153.8

3,117.8

752.6

479.1

40.8

34.2

0.1

83.5

–

38.7

4.9

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

322.3

1,554.8

326.6

1,760.5

100.7

(30.4)

880.8

(10.5)

279.7

96.1

(43.3)

887.1

0.8

416.1

1,220.3

1,356.8

0.5

1,220.8

2,775.6

0.5

1,357.3

3,117.8

The consolidated financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 17 February 2016 and signed on its behalf by: 

Martin Thomas  
Director/Chairman 

Elaine Whelan 
Director/CFO 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

103 
103

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
For the year ended 31 December 2015 

Share 
capital 
$m

Own
 shares 
$m

Share 
premium 
$m

Other 
reserves 
$m

Notes 

Accumulated 
other 
comprehensive 
income (loss) 
$m

Retained 
earnings  
$m 

Shareholders’ 
equity 
attributable 
to equity 
shareholders 
of LHL  
$m 

Non-
controlling 
interests 
$m

Total 
shareholders’ 
equity 
$m

Balance as at 31 December 2013 

92.7

(36.8)

192.2

700.9

2.9

507.8 

1,459.7 

0.7

1,460.4

Total comprehensive income for  
the year 

10 

Share premium reclassification 

24, 28, 29 

Share repurchases 

Purchase of shares from non-
controlling interests 

Distributed by trust 

Shares donated to trust 

Dividends on common shares 

Dividend equivalents on warrants 

Warrant exercises  

RSS compensation 

Equity based compensation – tax 

Equity based compensation – 
expense 

23 

24, 27 

23, 24 

23, 24, 27 

23 

23 

23, 24 

 24 

8, 24 

6, 24 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(25.0)

–

21.6

(8.1)

–

–

3.4

5.0

–

–

–

–

–

–

Balance as at 31 December 2014 

96.1

(43.3)

Total comprehensive income for 
the year 

10 

Shares purchased by trust 

23, 24, 27, 28 

Distributed by trust 

Dividends on common shares 

Dividend equivalents on warrants 

Dividends paid to minority interest 
holders 

23, 24 

23 

23 

–

0.5

–

–

–

–

–

(9.3)

12.5

–

–

–

Warrant exercises  

23, 24, 28 

4.1

9.7

Equity based compensation – tax 

Equity based compensation – 
expense 

8, 24 

6, 24 

–

–

–

–

Balance as at 31 December 2015 

100.7

(30.4)

–

–

(2.1)

229.3 

227.2 

0.3

227.5

(192.2)

192.2

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(0.6)

(28.3)

8.1

–

–

5.7

(9.8)

(4.4)

23.3

887.1

–

8.8

(17.2)

–

–

–

(13.8)

0.1

15.8

880.8

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

(25.0)

(0.6)

(6.7)

– 

(288.9)

(288.9)

(32.1)

(32.1)

– 

– 

– 

– 

14.1 

(9.8)

(4.4)

23.3 

–

–

–

(25.0)

(0.5)

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(1.1)

(6.7)

–

(288.9)

(32.1)

14.1

(9.8)

(4.4)

23.3

0.8

416.1 

1,356.8 

0.5

1,357.3

(11.3)

181.1 

169.8 

0.6

170.4

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

– 

– 

– 

(4.7)

(316.0)

(316.0)

(1.5)

(1.5)

–

–

–

–

–

(4.7)

(316.0)

(1.5)

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

0.1 

15.8 

(0.6)

(0.6)

–

–

–

–

0.1

15.8

(10.5)

279.7 

1,220.3 

0.5

1,220.8

104 
104 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
STATEMENT OF CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOWS 
For the year ended 31 December 2015 

Cash flows from operating activities 

Profit before tax 

Tax refunded 

Depreciation 

Amortisation of intangible asset 

Interest expense on long-term debt 

Interest and dividend income 

Net amortisation of fixed income securities 

Equity based compensation 

Foreign exchange losses  

Share of profit of associates 

Net other investment losses (income)  

Net realised losses (gains) and impairments 

Net unrealised (gains) losses on interest rate swaps 

Changes in operational assets and liabilities 

– Insurance and reinsurance contracts 

– Other assets and liabilities 

Net cash flows from operating activities 

Cash flows from investing activities 

Interest and dividends received 

Net purchase of property, plant and equipment  

Investment in associates 

Purchase of investments 

Proceeds on sale of investments 

Net cash flows from investing activities 

Cash flows used in financing activities 

Interest paid 

Dividends paid 

Dividend paid to minority interest holders 

Share repurchases 

Warrant exercises 

RSS compensation 

Distributions by trust 

Purchase of shares from non-controlling interests 

Net cash flows used in financing activities 

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents 

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year 

Effect of exchange rate fluctuations on cash and cash equivalents 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year 

Notes 

2015 
$m

2014 
$m

171.7

4.4

1.9

–

15.1

(40.9)

8.1

15.8

10.8

(4.1)

1.3

2.8

(0.1)

(71.0)

(17.7)

98.1

42.1

–

9.3

226.5

1.0

2.1

23.4

15.5

(50.5)

9.9

23.3

7.3

(5.9)

(1.4)

5.9

4.7

(35.5)

(13.8)

212.5

52.0

(8.7)

17.9

(990.8)

(2,153.7)

1,173.5

234.1

2,159.0

66.5

(15.2)

(317.5)

(0.6)

–

–

–

(4.7)

–

(15.5)

(321.0)

–

(25.0)

14.1

(9.8)

(6.7)

(1.1)

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

(338.0)

(365.0)

(5.8)

303.5

(5.9)

291.8

(86.0)

403.0

(13.5)

303.5

5 

19 

7 

6 

17 

3 

3 

27 

23 

27 

9 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

105 
105

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ACCOUNTING POLICIES 
For the year ended 31 December 2015 

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES 
The basis of preparation, consolidation principles and significant accounting policies adopted in the preparation of these consolidated 
financial statements are set out below.  

BASIS OF PREPARATION 
The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS  
as adopted by the European Union.  

Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS framework allows 
reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Group determines appropriate measurement 
bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement and considering 
U.S. GAAP. 

All amounts, excluding share data or where otherwise stated, are in millions of U.S. dollars.  

While a number of new or amended IFRS and IFRIC standards have been issued there are no standards issued that have had a material 
impact on the Group. 

IFRS 4, Insurance Contracts, issued in March 2004, specifies the financial reporting for insurance contracts by an insurer. The current 
standard is Phase I in the IASB’s insurance contract project and, as noted above, does not specify the recognition or measurement of 
insurance contracts. This will be addressed in Phase II of the IASB’s project and is expected to include a number of significant changes 
regarding the measurement and disclosure of insurance contracts. The Group will continue to monitor the progress of the project in 
order to assess the potential impacts the new standard will have on its results and the presentation and disclosure thereof.  

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, has been issued but is not yet effective, and therefore has not yet been 
adopted by the Group. The Group continues to apply IAS 39, Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement and classifies its  
fixed income, equity securities and hedge funds as AFS or FVTPL. The new standard is effective for annual periods beginning on or  
after 1 January 2018, although it is likely to be deferred to insurers to better align with the implementation date of IFRS 4 Phase II. 
IFRS 9 is not expected to have a material impact on the results and disclosures reported in the consolidated financial statements.  

The consolidated balance sheet of the Group is presented in order of decreasing liquidity.  

USE OF ESTIMATES 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires the Group to make estimates and assumptions that affect  
the reported and disclosed amounts at the balance sheet date and the reported and disclosed amounts of revenues and expenses  
during the reporting period. Actual results may differ materially from the estimates made. 

The most significant estimate made by management is in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses. This is discussed on page 109  
and also in the risk disclosures section from page 120. Estimates in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable are 
discussed on page 109. 

Estimates are also made in determining the estimated fair value of certain financial instruments and equity compensation plans. The 
estimation of the fair value of financial instruments is discussed on pages 109 and 110 and in note 10. Management judgement is applied  
in determining impairment charges. The estimation of the fair value of equity based compensation awards granted is discussed in note 6.  

Intangible assets are recognised on the acquisition of a subsidiary. The fair value of intangible assets arising from the acquisition of a 
subsidiary is largely based on the estimated expected cash flows of the business acquired and the contractual rights of that business.  
The Group determines whether indefinite life intangible assets are impaired at least on an annual basis. This requires an estimation  
of the recoverable amount of the CGU to which the intangible assets are allocated. The assumptions made by management in performing 
impairment tests of intangible assets are subject to estimation uncertainty. Details of the key assumptions used in the estimation of the 
recoverable amounts of the CGU are contained in note 19.  

106 
106 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
BASIS OF CONSOLIDATION 
The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries as at and for the year ended 
31 December 2015. Control is achieved when the Group is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the 
investee and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the investee. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date  
of acquisition, being the date on which the Group obtains control, and continue to be consolidated until the date when such control 
ceases. Intercompany balances, profits and transactions are eliminated. The Group participates on two Syndicates at Lloyd’s, which are 
managed by the Group’s managing agent subsidiary. In view of the several liability of underwriting members at Lloyd’s, the Group 
recognises its proportion of all the transactions undertaken by the Syndicates in which it participates within its consolidated statement  
of comprehensive income. Similarly, the Group’s proportion of the Syndicates’ assets and liabilities has been reflected in its consolidated 
balance sheet. This proportion is calculated by reference to the Group’s participation as a percentage of each Syndicate’s total capacity 
for each year of account. 

Subsidiaries’ accounting policies are generally consistent with the Group’s accounting policies. Where they differ, adjustments are made 
on consolidation to bring accounting policies in line. 

ASSOCIATES 
Investments, in which the Group has significant influence over the operational and financial policies of the investee, are recognised at  
cost and thereafter accounted for using the equity method. Under this method, the Group records its proportionate share of income  
and loss from such investments in its consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the period. Adjustments are made to 
associates’ accounting policies, where necessary, in order to be consistent with the Group’s accounting policies. 

FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION 
The functional currency, which is the currency of the primary economic environment in which operations are conducted, for all  
Group entities is U.S. dollars. Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are measured using the  
functional currency. The consolidated financial statements are also presented in U.S. dollars. 

Foreign currency transactions are recorded in the functional currency for each entity using the exchange rates prevailing at the  
dates of the transactions, or at the average rate for the period when this is a reasonable approximation. Monetary assets and liabilities 
denominated in foreign currencies are translated at period end exchange rates. The resulting exchange differences on translation  
are recorded in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Non-monetary assets and liabilities carried at historical cost and 
denominated in a foreign currency are translated at historic rates. Non-monetary assets and liabilities carried at estimated fair value and 
denominated in a foreign currency are translated at the exchange rate at the date the estimated fair value was determined, with resulting 
exchange differences recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity.  

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

107 
107

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
ACCOUNTING POLICIES CONTINUED 

INTANGIBLE ASSETS 
The cost of intangible assets acquired in a business combination is their fair value as at the date of acquisition. Following initial 
recognition, intangible assets are carried at cost less any accumulated amortisation and any accumulated impairment losses. The useful 
lives of intangible assets are assessed to be either finite or indefinite depending on the nature of the asset. Intangible assets with finite  
lives are amortised over their useful economic life and assessed for impairment whenever there is an indication that the intangible asset  
may be impaired. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are tested for impairment at least annually at the CGU level by comparing 
the net present value of the future earnings stream of the CGU to the carrying value of the intangible asset. Such intangible assets are  
not amortised. The useful life of an intangible asset with an indefinite life is reviewed annually to determine whether the indefinite life 
assessment continues to be supportable. 

GOODWILL 
Goodwill is deemed to have an indefinite life and, after initial recognition, is measured at cost less any accumulated impairment  
losses. Goodwill is tested for impairment annually, or when events or changes in circumstances indicate that it might be impaired.  

SYNDICATE PARTICIPATION RIGHTS 
Syndicate participation rights purchased in a business combination are initially measured at fair value and are subsequently measured  
at cost less any accumulated impairment losses. Syndicate participation rights are considered to have an indefinite life as they will  
provide benefits over an indefinite future period and are therefore not subject to an annual amortisation charge. The value of the 
syndicate participation rights is reviewed for impairment at least annually, or when events or changes in circumstances indicate that 
it might be impaired. 

VALUE OF IN-FORCE BUSINESS 
The value of in-force business acquired in a business combination is initially recognised as the difference between the fair value of the  
net unearned premiums acquired and the measurement of the net unearned premiums acquired using the Group’s existing accounting 
policies. The value of in-force business has a finite useful life and subsequent to initial recognition it is carried at cost less accumulated 
amortisation and is amortised over the remaining life of the acquired insurance contracts. The portion of the value of in-force business 
which replaced the deferred acquisition costs carried on Cathedral’s historical balance sheet was amortised in net acquisition costs in  
the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. The remaining amortisation was charged to other operating expenses.  

INSURANCE CONTRACTS 
CLASSIFICATION 
Insurance contracts are those contracts that transfer significant insurance risk at the inception of the contract. Contracts that do  
not transfer significant insurance risk are accounted for as investment contracts. Insurance risk is transferred when an insurer agrees  
to compensate a policyholder if a specified uncertain future event adversely affects the policyholder.  

PREMIUMS AND ACQUISITION COSTS 
Premiums are first recognised as written at the later of a contract’s binding or inception date. The Group writes both excess of loss and 
pro-rata (proportional) contracts. For the majority of excess of loss contracts, premiums written are recorded based on the minimum  
and deposit or flat premium, as defined in the contract. Subsequent adjustments to the minimum and deposit premium are recognised  
in the period in which they are determined. For pro-rata contracts and excess of loss contracts where no deposit is specified in the 
contract, premiums written are recognised based on estimates of ultimate premiums provided by the insureds or ceding companies.  
Initial estimates of premiums written are recognised in the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract  
is bound if later. Subsequent adjustments, based on reports of actual premium by the insureds or ceding companies, or revisions in 
estimates, are recorded in the period in which they are determined.  

Premiums written are earned rateably over the term of the underlying risk period of the insurance contract, except where the period  
of risk differs significantly from the contract period. In these circumstances, premiums are recognised over the period of risk in 
proportion to the amount of insurance protection provided. The portion of the premium related to the unexpired portion of  
the risk period is reflected in unearned premiums. 

Where contract terms require the reinstatement of coverage after an insured’s or ceding company’s loss, the estimated mandatory 
reinstatement premiums are recorded as premiums written when a specific loss event occurs. Reinstatement premiums are not  
recorded for losses included within the provision for IBNR which do not relate to a specific loss event. 

108 
108 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants are recorded net of commissions, brokerage, premium taxes and other levies  
on premiums, unless the contract specifies otherwise. These balances are reviewed for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised  
as an expense in the period in which it is determined.  

Acquisition costs represent commissions, brokerage, profit commissions and other variable costs that relate directly to the successful 
securing of new contracts and the renewing of existing contracts. They are generally deferred over the period in which the related 
premiums are earned to the extent they are recoverable out of expected future revenue margins. All other acquisition costs are  
recognised as an expense when incurred.  

OUTWARDS REINSURANCE  
Outwards reinsurance premiums comprise the cost of reinsurance contracts entered into. Outwards reinsurance premiums are accounted 
for in the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. The provision for reinsurers’ share  
of unearned premiums represents that part of reinsurance premiums ceded which are estimated to be earned in future financial periods. 
Unearned reinsurance commissions are recognised as a liability using the same principles.  

Any amounts recoverable from reinsurers are estimated using the same methodology as the underlying losses. The Group monitors  
the creditworthiness of its reinsurers on an ongoing basis and assesses any reinsurance assets for impairment, with any impairment  
loss recognised as an expense in the period in which it is determined.  

LOSSES 
Losses comprise losses and loss adjustment expenses paid in the period and changes in the provision for outstanding losses, including  
the provision for IBNR and related expenses. Losses and loss adjustment expenses are charged to income as they are incurred.  

A portion of the Group’s business is in classes with high attachment points of coverage, including property catastrophe excess of loss. 
Reserving for losses in such programmes is inherently complicated in that losses in excess of the attachment level of the Group’s policies 
are characterised by high severity and low frequency and other factors which could vary significantly as losses are settled. This limits the 
volume of industry loss experience available from which to reliably predict ultimate losses following a loss event.  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses represent the estimated ultimate cost of settling all losses and loss adjustment expenses arising from 
events which have occurred up to the balance sheet date, including a provision for IBNR. The Group does not discount its liabilities for 
unpaid losses. Outstanding losses are initially set on the basis of reports of losses received from third parties. ACRs are determined where 
the Group’s best estimate of the reported loss is greater than that reported. Estimated IBNR reserves may also consist of a provision for 
additional development in excess of losses reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for losses which have occurred 
but which have not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. IBNR reserves are set on a best estimate basis and are estimated  
by management using various actuarial methods as well as a combination of own loss experience, historical insurance industry loss 
experience, underwriters’ experience, estimates of pricing adequacy trends and management’s professional judgement.  

The estimation of the ultimate liability arising is a complex process which incorporates a significant amount of judgement. It is reasonably 
possible that uncertainties inherent in the reserving process, delays in insureds or ceding companies reporting losses to the Group, 
together with the potential for unforeseen adverse developments, could lead to a material change in losses and loss adjustment expenses.  

LIABILITY ADEQUACY TESTS 
At each balance sheet date, the Group performs a liability adequacy test using current best estimates of future cash outflows generated  
by its insurance contracts, plus any investment income thereon. If, as a result of these tests, the carrying amount of the Group’s insurance 
liabilities is found to be inadequate, the deficiency is charged to income for the period, initially by writing off deferred acquisition costs 
and subsequently by establishing a provision.  

FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS 
Cash and cash equivalents are carried in the consolidated balance sheet at amortised cost and include cash in hand, deposits held on  
call with banks and other short-term highly liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less at the date of purchase. Carrying 
amounts approximate fair value due to the short-term nature and high liquidity of the instruments.  

Interest income earned on cash and cash equivalents is recognised on the effective interest rate method. The carrying value of accrued 
interest income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

109 
109

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
ACCOUNTING POLICIES CONTINUED 

INVESTMENTS  
The Group’s fixed income and equity securities are quoted or unquoted investments that are classified as AFS or at FVTPL and are 
carried at estimated fair value. The classification of the Group’s financial assets is determined at the time of initial purchase and depends 
on the nature of the investment. A financial asset is classified at FVTPL if it is managed and evaluated on a fair value basis and if acquired 
principally for the purpose of selling in the short term, or if it forms part of a portfolio of financial assets in which there is evidence of 
short-term profit taking. AFS financial assets are non-derivatives that are not classified as FVTPL or in any of the other categories. 

The Group’s hedge funds are unquoted investments classified at FVTPL and are carried at estimated fair value. Estimated fair values  
are determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each fund’s independent administrator and the estimated 
performance provided by each hedge fund manager. 

Regular way purchases and sales of investments are recognised at estimated fair value including transaction costs on the trade date and  
are subsequently carried at estimated fair value. The estimated fair values of quoted investments are determined based on bid prices  
from recognised exchanges, broker-dealers, recognised indices or pricing vendors. Unrealised gains and losses from changes in estimated 
fair value of AFS investments are included in accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity. Changes in estimated 
fair value of investments classified at FVTPL are recognised in current period net other investment income. 

Investments are derecognised when the Group has transferred substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership. On derecognition  
of an AFS investment, previously recorded unrealised gains and losses are removed from accumulated other comprehensive income in 
shareholders’ equity and included in current period income. Realised gains and losses are included in income in the period in which  
they arise. 

Amortisation and accretion of premiums and discounts on AFS fixed income securities are calculated using the effective interest rate 
method and are recognised in current period net investment income. Interest income is recognised on the effective interest rate method. 
The carrying value of accrued interest income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity. 
Dividends on equity securities are recorded as income on the date the dividends become payable to the holders of record. 

The Group regularly reviews the carrying value of its AFS investments for evidence of impairment. An investment is impaired if its  
carrying value exceeds the estimated fair value and there is objective evidence of impairment to the asset. Such evidence would include  
a prolonged decline in estimated fair value below cost or amortised cost, where other factors, such as expected cash flows, do not support 
a recovery in value. If an impairment is deemed appropriate, the difference between cost or amortised cost and estimated fair value is 
removed from accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity and charged to current period income. Impairment 
losses on fixed income securities may be subsequently reversed through income while impairment losses on equity securities are not 
subsequently reversed through income. 

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 
Derivatives are recognised at estimated fair value on the date a contract is entered into, the trade date, and are subsequently carried at 
estimated fair value. Derivative instruments with a positive estimated fair value are recorded as derivative financial assets and those with  
a negative estimated fair value are recorded as derivative financial liabilities.  

Derivative financial instruments include exchange-traded future and option contracts, forward foreign currency contracts, interest rate 
swaps, credit default swaps and interest rate swaptions. They derive their value from the underlying instrument and are subject to the  
same risks as that underlying instrument, including liquidity, credit and market risk. Estimated fair values are based on exchange or 
broker-dealer quotations, where available, or discounted cash flow models, which incorporate the pricing of the underlying instrument, 
yield curves and other factors. Changes in the estimated fair value of instruments that do not qualify for hedge accounting are recognised 
in current period income. The Group does not currently hold any derivatives classified as hedging instruments. For discounted cash  
flow techniques, estimated future cash flows are based on management’s best estimates and the discount rate used is an appropriate 
market rate. 

Derivative financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount is reported in the consolidated balance sheet only to the  
extent there is a legally enforceable right of offset and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realise the assets and liabilities 
simultaneously. Derivative financial assets and liabilities are derecognised when the Group has transferred substantially all of the risks  
and rewards of ownership or the liability is discharged, cancelled or expired. 

OTHER INCOME 
Managing agents fees and commissions and underwriting service fees are recognised in line with services provided. Contingent  
profit commissions are recognised when it is virtually certain that they will be realised. 

LONG-TERM DEBT 
Long-term debt is recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Thereafter it is held at amortised cost, with the 
amortisation calculated using the effective interest rate method. Derecognition occurs when the obligation has been extinguished. 

110 
110 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT 
Property, plant and equipment is carried at historical cost, less accumulated depreciation and any impairment in value. Depreciation  
is calculated to write off the cost over the estimated useful economic life on a straight-line basis as follows: 

IT equipment 
Office furniture and equipment 

Leasehold improvements 

33% per annum  
20% to 33% per annum  

20% per annum 

The assets’ residual values, useful lives and depreciation methods are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. 

An item of property, plant or equipment is derecognised on disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from  
the continued use of the asset.  

Gains and losses on the disposal of property, plant and equipment are determined by comparing proceeds with the carrying amount  
of the asset, and are included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Costs for repairs and maintenance are charged  
to income as incurred. 

LEASES 
Rentals payable under operating leases are charged to income on a straight-line basis over the lease term. 

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS 
EQUITY COMPENSATION PLANS 
The Group currently operates an RSS under which nil-cost options have been granted. The Group has also operated a management 
warrant plan and an LTIP option plan in the past. The fair value of the equity instruments granted is estimated on the date of grant.  
The estimated fair value is recognised as an expense pro-rata over the vesting period of the instrument, adjusted for the impact of any  
non-market vesting conditions. No adjustment to vesting assumptions is made in respect of market vesting conditions.  

At each balance sheet date, the Group revises its estimate of the number of RSS nil-cost options that are expected to become exercisable.  
It recognises the impact of the revision of original estimates, if any, in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, and a  
corresponding adjustment is made to other reserves in shareholders’ equity over the remaining vesting period.  

On exercise, the differences between the expense charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income and the actual cost  
to the Group, if any, is transferred to other reserves.  

PENSIONS 
The Group operates a defined contribution plan. On payment of contributions to the plan there is no further obligation for the  
Group. Contributions are recognised as employee benefits in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in the period  
to which they relate. 

TAX 
Income tax represents the sum of the tax currently payable and any deferred tax. The tax payable is calculated based on taxable profit  
for the period. Taxable profit for the period can differ from that reported in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income due  
to non-taxable income and certain items which are not tax deductible or which are deferred to subsequent periods. 

Deferred tax is recognised on all temporary differences between the assets and liabilities in the consolidated balance sheet and their tax 
base, except when the deferred tax liability arises from the initial recognition of goodwill. Deferred tax assets or liabilities are accounted 
for using the balance sheet liability method. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through 
future taxable profits is likely.  

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets against current  
tax liabilities and when the deferred income taxes relate to the same fiscal authority. 

Where the current estimated fair value of equity based compensation awards differs from the estimated fair value at the time of  
grant, adjusted where applicable for dividends, the related corporation tax and deferred tax charge or credit is recognised directly  
in other reserves. 

OWN SHARES 
Own shares include shares repurchased under share repurchase authorisations and held in treasury, plus shares repurchased and held in 
trust, for the purposes of employee equity based compensation schemes. Own shares are deducted from shareholders' equity. No gain or 
loss is recognised on the purchase, sale, cancellation or issue of own shares and any consideration paid or received is recognised directly 
in equity. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

111 
111

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES 
For the year ended 31 December 2015 

RISK DISCLOSURES: INTRODUCTION 
The Group is exposed to risks from several sources. These include insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, operational  
risk and strategic risk. The primary risk to the Group is insurance risk.  

The primary objective of the Group’s ERM is to ensure that the capital resources held are matched to the risk profile of the Group and 
that the balance between risk and reward is considered as part of all key business decisions. The Group has formulated, and keeps under 
review, a risk appetite which is set by the Board of Directors. The Group’s appetite for risk will vary marginally from time to time to reflect 
the potential risks and rewards that present themselves. However, protecting the Group’s capital and providing investors with a superior 
risk-adjusted return over the long term are constants. The risk appetite of the Group is central to how the business is run and permeates 
into the risk appetites that the individual operating entity boards of directors have adopted. These risk appetites are expressed through 
detailed risk tolerances at both a Group and an operating entity level. Risk tolerances represent the maximum amount of capital, 
generally on a modeled basis, that the Group and its entities are prepared to expose to certain risks.  

The Board of Directors is responsible for setting and monitoring the Group’s risk appetite and tolerances, whereas the individual  
entity boards of directors are responsible for setting and monitoring entity level risk tolerances. All risk tolerances are subject to at least 
an annual review and consideration by the respective boards of directors. The LHL Board and individual entity boards of directors review 
actual risk levels versus tolerances, emerging risks and any risk learning events at least quarterly. In addition, on at least a monthly basis, 
management reviews the output from BLAST in order to assess modeled potential losses against risk tolerances and ensure that risk  
levels are managed in accordance with them. 

RISK AND RETURN COMMITTEE 
The RRC seeks to optimise risk-adjusted return and facilitate the appropriate use of the Internal Model, including considering its 
effectiveness. It ensures that all key areas of risk are discussed according to a schedule that covers fortnightly, monthly, quarterly,  
semi-annual and annual reviews. The RRC meets fortnightly and is responsible for coordinating and overseeing ERM activities within  
the risk profile, appetites and tolerances set by the Group and individual entity boards of directors. The RRC includes the Group CEO 
and members from the finance, actuarial and underwriting functions and includes representation from Cathedral. The CRO attends the 
meetings and reports on the RRC’s activities to the Group and individual entity boards of directors and the Risk Committee of Cathedral.  

CHIEF RISK OFFICER 
The primary role of the CRO is to facilitate the effective operation of ERM throughout the Group at all levels. The role includes but  
is not limited to the following responsibilities: 

•  overall management of the risk management system; 

•  drive ERM culture, ownership and execution on three levels: Board, executive management, and operationally within the business; 

•  facilitate the identification, assessment, evaluation and management of existing and emerging risks by management and the Board; 

•  ensure that these risks are given due consideration and are embedded within management’s and the Board’s oversight and decision 

making process; 

•  be consulted, and opine, on policy in areas such as, but not limited to, underwriting, claims, investments, operations and capital 

management; and 

•  provide timely, accurate, reliable, factual, objective and accessible information and analysis to guide, coach and support  

decision making.  

Responsibility for the management of individual risks has been assigned to, and may form part of the performance objectives of, the  
risk owners within the business. Risk owners ensure that these risks and controls are consistent with their day-to-day processes and the 
entries made in the Group risk registers, which are a direct input into BLAST. The CRO provides regular reports to the business outlining 
the status of the Group’s ERM activities and strategy, as well as formal reports to the Boards of Directors of the Group and the individual 
operating entities in this regard including the Risk Committee of Cathedral. The CRO ultimately has the right to report directly to the 
Group and entity regulators if they feel that management is not appropriately addressing areas of concern. 

112 
112 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
INTERNAL AUDIT 
Internal audit plays a key role in the Group’s ERM by providing an independent opinion regarding the accuracy and completeness  
of risks, in addition to verification of the effectiveness of controls and the consistency of their operation. Internal audit’s roles and 
responsibilities are clearly defined through the Internal Audit Charter. The Head of Internal Audit reports directly to the Group  
Audit Committee. The CRO has input to the scope of each audit and receives a copy of each internal audit report. The CRO considers 
the findings and agreed actions in the context of the risk appetites and tolerances, plus the risk policies and risk management strategy of 
each area. The integration of internal audit and ERM into the business helps facilitate the Group’s protection of its assets and reputation. 

ECONOMIC CAPITAL MODEL 
The foundation of the Lancashire Companies’ and Kinesis’ risk-based capital approach to decision making is its economic capital model, 
BLAST, which is based on the widely accepted economic capital modeling tool, ReMetrica. Management uses BLAST primarily for 
monitoring its insurance risks. However, BLAST is also used to monitor other risks including market, credit and operational risks.  

BLAST produces data in the form of a stochastic distribution for all classes, including non-elemental classes. The distribution includes  
the mean outcome and the result at various return periods, including very remote events. BLAST calculates projected financial outcomes 
for each insurance class, as well as the overall portfolio including diversification credit. Diversification credit arises as individual risks are 
generally not strongly correlated and are unlikely to all produce profits or losses at the same time. BLAST also measures the Group’s 
aggregate insurance exposures. It therefore helps senior management and the Board of Directors to determine the level of capital 
required to meet the combined risk from a wide range of categories. Assisted by BLAST, the Group seeks to achieve an improved  
risk-adjusted return over time. 

BLAST is used in strategic underwriting decisions, as part of the Group’s annual business planning process and to assist in portfolio 
optimisation, taking account of inwards business and all major reinsurance purchases. Management also utilises BLAST in assessing  
the impact of strategic decisions on individual classes of business that the Group writes, or is considering writing, as well as the overall 
resulting financial impact to the Group. BLAST output, covering all of the risk groups to which the Group is exposed, is reviewed, 
including the anticipated loss curves, combined ratios and risk-adjusted profitability, to determine profitability and risk tolerance 
headroom by class.  

BLAST covers the risks for LICL, LUK and Kinesis but does not cover Cathedral’s risk. Due to the particular requirements of Lloyd’s 
regulations, Cathedral has its own Internal Model which is vetted by Lloyd’s as part of its own capital and solvency regulations. To 
formulate an overall Group view of risk, exposures from Cathedral are combined with LICL, LUK and Kinesis using Lancashire’s 
proprietary Internal Models.  

The six primary risk categories, insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, operational risk and strategic risk, are discussed  
in detail on pages 114 to 138. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

113 
113

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

A. INSURANCE RISK 
The Group underwrites worldwide, predominantly short-tail, insurance and reinsurance contracts that transfer insurance risk, including 
risks exposed to both natural and man-made catastrophes. The Group’s exposure in connection with insurance contracts is, in the event  
of insured losses, whether premiums will be sufficient to cover the loss payments and expenses. Insurance and reinsurance markets are 
cyclical and premium rates and terms and conditions vary by line of business depending on market conditions and the stage of the cycle. 
Market conditions are impacted by capacity and recent loss events, and broader economic cycle impacts amongst other factors. The 
Group’s underwriters assess likely losses using their experience and knowledge of past loss experience, industry trends and current 
circumstances. This allows them to estimate the premiums sufficient to meet likely losses and expenses and desired levels of profitability 
consistent with the Group’s risk-adjusted RoE targets.  

The Group considers insurance risk at an individual contract level, at a sector level, a geographic level and at an aggregate portfolio level. 
This ensures careful risk selection, limits on concentration and appropriate portfolio diversification are accomplished. The four principal 
classes of business for the Group, excluding the Lloyd’s segment, are Property, Energy, Marine and Aviation. These classes, plus the 
Group’s Lloyd’s segment, are deemed to be the Group’s five operating segments. The level of insurance risk tolerance per peril is set  
by the respective Boards of Directors at both the LHL and entity level. 

A number of controls are deployed to manage the amount of insurance exposure assumed: 

•  the Group has a rolling three-year strategic plan that helps establish the over-riding business goals that the Board of Directors aims  

to achieve; 

•  a detailed business plan is produced annually which includes expected premiums and combined ratios by class and considers risk-
adjusted profitability, capital usage and requirements. The plan is approved by the Board of Directors and is monitored, reviewed 
and updated on an ongoing basis; 

•  for Cathedral, the Syndicate business forecast and business plan are subject to review and approval by Lloyd’s; 

•  BLAST, SHARP and Cathedral’s internal models are used to measure occurrence risks, aggregate risks and correlations between classes 

and other non-insurance risks, and the outputs and assumptions from BLAST and SHARP are reviewed periodically by the RRC; 

•  each authorised class has a predetermined normal maximum line structure; 

•  each underwriter has a clearly defined limit of underwriting authority; 

•  the Group and individual operating entities have predetermined tolerances on probabilistic and deterministic losses of capital  

for certain single events; 

•  risk levels versus tolerances are monitored on a regular basis; 

•  a daily underwriting call is held for LICL and LUK to peer review insurance proposals, opportunities and emerging risks;  

•  a daily post-binding review process with exception reporting to management based on underwriting authority operates at Cathedral; 

•  sophisticated pricing and aggregation models are utilised in certain areas of the underwriting process, and are updated frequently; 

•  BLAST and other modeling tools are deployed to model catastrophes and resultant losses to the portfolio and the Group; and 

•  reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate both frequency and severity of losses on a treaty or facultative basis and to improve  

risk-adjusted RoE as modeled in BLAST. 

Some of the Group’s business provides coverage for natural catastrophes (e.g. hurricanes, earthquakes and floods) and is subject  
to potential seasonal variation. A proportion of the Group's business is exposed to large catastrophe losses in North America, Europe  
and Japan as a result of windstorms. The level of windstorm activity, and landfall thereof, during the North American, European and 
Japanese wind seasons may materially impact the Group's loss experience. The North American and Japanese wind seasons are typically 
June to November and the European wind season November to March. The Group also bears exposure to large losses arising from other 
non-seasonal natural catastrophes, such as earthquakes, tsunamis, droughts, floods and tornadoes, from risk losses throughout the year 
and from war, terrorism and political risk and other events. The Group’s associate bears exposure to catastrophe losses and any significant 
loss event could potentially result in impairment in the value of the Group’s investment in associate. 

114 
114 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
The Group’s exposures to certain peak zone elemental losses, as a percentage of tangible capital, including long-term debt, are  
shown below. Net loss estimates are before income tax and net of reinstatement premiums and outwards reinsurance. The exposure  
to catastrophe losses that would result in an impairment to the investment in associate is included in the figures below. 

As at 31 December 2015 

Zones 

Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 

Gulf of Mexico1 

California 

Pan-European 

Japan 

Japan 

Pacific North West 

(1) Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 

As at 31 December 2014 

Zones 

Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 

Gulf of Mexico1 

California 

Pan-European 

Japan 

Japan 

Pacific North West 

(1) Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 

100 year return period  
estimated net loss 

250 year return period  
estimated net loss 

$m 

% of  
tangible capital 

$m 

% of 
tangible capital

236.2

231.6

157.7

92.2

72.1

47.7

37.1

17.0 

16.7 

11.4 

6.6 

5.2 

3.4 

2.7 

457.4

347.2

250.8

145.6

121.2

69.3

98.5

32.9

25.0

18.1

10.5

8.7

5.0

7.1

100 year return period  
estimated net loss 

250 year return period  
estimated net loss 

$m 

% of  
tangible capital 

$m 

% of 
tangible capital

254.0

254.2

154.8

133.2

116.0

61.2

39.5

16.6 

16.6 

10.1 

8.7 

7.6 

4.0 

2.6 

455.8

377.2

247.5

205.0

184.8

94.6

123.3

29.8

24.7

16.2

13.4

12.1

6.2

8.1

Perils 

Hurricane 

Hurricane 

Earthquake 

Windstorm 

Earthquake 

Typhoon 

Earthquake 

Perils 

Hurricane 

Hurricane 

Earthquake 

Windstorm 

Earthquake 

Typhoon 

Earthquake 

There can be no guarantee that the modeled assumptions and techniques deployed in calculating these figures are accurate. There  
could also be an unmodeled loss which exceeds these figures. In addition, any modeled loss scenario could cause a larger loss to capital 
than the modeled expectation. 

Details of annual gross premiums written by geographic area of risks insured are provided below:  

U.S. and Canada 

Worldwide offshore 

Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1 

Europe 

Far East 

Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2 

Middle East 

Rest of world 

Total 

2015 

$m

176.1

153.2

135.6

48.9

31.2

18.2

8.0

69.9

641.1

% 

27.5 

23.9 

21.2 

7.6 

4.9 

2.8 

1.2 

10.9 

100.0 

2014 

$m

221.7

287.4

172.5

59.6

42.7

23.2

9.5

91.0

907.6

%

24.4

31.7

19.0

6.6

4.7

2.6

1.0

10.0

100.0

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.  

(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada.  

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

115 
115

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

Details of annual gross premiums written by business segment are provided below: 

Lloyd’s 

Property 

Energy 

Marine 

Aviation 

Total 

2015 

$m

247.7

197.2

112.0

47.6

36.6

641.1

% 

38.6 

30.8 

17.5 

7.4 

5.7 

100.0 

2014 

$m

284.3

263.0

239.4

67.7

53.2

907.6

%

31.3

28.9

26.4

7.5

5.9

100.0

Further details of the gross premiums written and the risks associated with each of these five principal business segments are described  
on the following pages. 

I. LLOYD’S 
Gross premiums written, for the year:  

Property reinsurance 

Property direct and facultative 

Marine cargo 

Aviation and satellite  

Energy 

Terrorism 

Contingency 

Total 

2015
$m

92.9

66.2

29.6

28.5

20.1

6.0

4.4

2014 
$m

104.3

80.7

37.5

27.6

25.9

3.5

4.8

247.7

284.3

Property reinsurance predominantly includes property catastrophe excess of loss, property per risk excess of loss and property 
retrocession lines of business. Property catastrophe excess of loss and property per risk excess of loss provide protection for elemental  
and non-elemental risks and are written on an excess of loss treaty basis within the U.S. and internationally. The U.S. property catastrophe 
excess of loss book is particularly focused on regional clients. Property retrocession is written on an excess of loss basis through treaty 
arrangements. It provides coverage for elemental risks when sold on a catastrophe basis and both elemental and non-elemental risks 
when sold on a per risk retrocession basis. Protection is generally given on a regional basis and may cover specific property risks or all 
catastrophe perils. It is also generally written on an UNL basis, meaning loss payments are linked to the ceding company’s own loss. 

Property direct and facultative is a worldwide book of largely commercial property business, written both in the open market and under 
delegated authorities. The account spans small individual locations to Fortune 500 accounts but with a bias towards small to medium  
sized risks. Policies are generally provided both for non-elemental and elemental perils, although not all risks include both elemental  
and non-elemental coverage. Coverage is generally written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis, although the very largest 
accounts are currently seldom written at the primary level.  

Marine cargo is an international account and is written either on a direct basis or by way of reinsurance. It covers the (re)insurance of 
commodities or goods in transit. Typically, transit cover is provided on an all-risks basis for marine perils for the full value of the goods 
concerned, although higher value or capacity business may be written on a layered basis. Static cover is also provided for losses to cargo, 
from both elemental and non-elemental causes, whilst static at points along its route. In addition, the cargo account can include specie 
and fine art, vault risks, artwork on exhibition and marine war business relating to cargo in transit.  

Aviation and satellite includes aviation reinsurance, aviation war, general aviation and aviation satellite lines of business. Aviation 
reinsurance provides excess of loss catastrophe cover to the insurers of the world’s major airlines and aircraft and aircraft manufacturers. 
This includes cover for the aircraft themselves as well as losses arising from passenger and third-party liability claims against airlines 
and/or manufacturers. Aviation war covers loss or damage to aviation assets from war, terrorism and similar causes. General aviation 
covers fixed wing and rotor wing aircraft typically with 50 passenger seats or less and covers both commercial and private clients.  
A significant part of the aviation satellite account is written through Satec, a specialist underwriting agency, to which underwriting 
authority is delegated. Satellite insurance is purchased by launch operators, satellite manufacturers and satellite operators to protect 
against launch or deployment failure or subsequent failure in orbit. Policies are typically written for launch plus one year in orbit. 
Thereafter orbit cover is normally provided on an annual basis.  

116 
116 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value 
basis. Worldwide offshore energy policies are typically package policies which may include physical damage, well control, business 
interruption and third-party liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets covered  
can be high-value and are therefore mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple risk carriers. 
Construction energy contracts generally cover all risks of platforms, FPSO and drilling units under construction at yard and offshore, 
during towing and installation. Onshore construction contracts are generally not written.  

Terrorism business can be written either ground-up or for primary or excess layers, with cover provided for U.S. and worldwide property 
risks, but typically excluding nuclear, chemical and biological coverage in most territories. Cover is generally provided to medium to large 
commercial and industrial enterprises. Policies are typically written for scheduled locations and exposure is controlled by setting limits  
on aggregate exposure within a ‘blast zone’ radius. The term of these contracts may be multi-year, reflecting the term of the underlying 
exposures. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis. 

Contingency focuses on the sports, leisure and entertainment industries, with a significant emphasis on the music industry. It provides 
coverage for non-appearance and event cancellation. Generally business is written on a full value basis. 

II. PROPERTY 
Gross premiums written, for the year: 

Property catastrophe excess of loss 

Terrorism 

Property political risk 

Property retrocession 

Other property 

Total 

2015
$m

90.6

43.8

33.3

13.6

15.9

2014 
$m

124.2

55.2

44.4

18.1

21.1

197.2

263.0

Property catastrophe excess of loss covers elemental risks and is written on an excess of loss treaty basis. The property catastrophe excess  
of loss portfolio is written within the U.S. and also internationally. Cover is offered for specific perils and regions or countries.  

Terrorism business can be written either ground-up or for primary or excess layers, with cover provided for U.S. and worldwide property 
risks, but typically excluding nuclear, chemical and biological coverage in most territories. Cover is generally provided to medium to large 
commercial and industrial enterprises. Policies are typically written for scheduled locations and exposure is controlled by setting limits  
on aggregate exposure within a ‘blast zone’ radius. The term of these contracts is often multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying 
exposures. Some national pools are also written, which may include nuclear, chemical and biological coverage and may have an element 
of life coverage. 

Property political risk cover is written either ground-up or on an excess of loss basis. Coverage that the Group provides in the political  
risk book is split between confiscation perils coverage and sovereign/quasi-sovereign obligor coverage. Confiscation perils coverage 
protects against CEND and may be extended to include other perils. Sovereign/quasi-sovereign obligors coverage protects against  
the non-payment or non-honouring of an obligation by a sovereign or quasi-sovereign entity. Cover is provided to medium to large 
commercial and industrial clients as well as bank and commodity trading clients. The term of these contracts is often multi-year  
reflecting the term of the underlying exposures. The Group does not provide cover against purely private obligor credit risk. 

Property retrocession is written on an excess of loss basis through treaty arrangements and covers elemental risks. Cover may be on  
a worldwide or regional basis and may cover specific risks or all catastrophe perils. Coverage may be given on a UNL basis, meaning  
that loss payments are linked directly to the ceding company’s own loss, or on an ILW basis, meaning that loss payments are linked 
to the overall industry insured loss as measured by independent third-party loss index providers. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

117 
117

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The Group is exposed to large natural catastrophe losses, such as windstorm and earthquake loss, primarily from assuming property 
catastrophe excess of loss and property retrocession portfolio risks. Exposure to such events is controlled and measured by setting limits 
on aggregate exposures in certain classes per geographic zone and through loss modeling. The accuracy of the latter exposure analysis  
is limited by the quality of data and the effectiveness of the modeling. It is possible that a catastrophic event significantly exceeds the 
expected modeled event loss. The Group’s appetite and exposure guidelines for large losses are set out on pages 114 and 115.  

Reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to large natural catastrophe losses in the U.S., Canada and worldwide with certain 
exclusions. Reinsurance may also be purchased to reduce the Group’s worldwide exposure to large risk losses. Reinsurance is typically 
purchased on an excess of loss basis, however ILWs or quota share arrangements may be entered into. 

III. ENERGY 
Gross premiums written, for the year:  

Worldwide offshore energy 

Gulf of Mexico offshore energy 

Energy liabilities 

Construction energy 

Other energy 

Total 

2015
$m

92.8

6.1

3.3

2.8

7.0

2014 
$m

149.9

69.9

8.5

6.5

4.6

112.0

239.4

Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value 
basis. Worldwide offshore energy policies are typically package policies which may include physical damage, business interruption and 
third-party liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets covered can be high-value  
and are therefore mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple risk carriers. 

Gulf of Mexico offshore energy programmes cover elemental and non-elemental risks. Most policies have sub-limits on coverage for 
elemental losses. These programmes are exposed to Gulf of Mexico windstorms. Exposure to such events is controlled and measured 
through loss modeling. The accuracy of this exposure analysis is limited by the quality of data and the effectiveness of the modeling.  
It is possible that a catastrophic event significantly exceeds the expected modeled event loss. The Group’s appetite and exposure 
guidelines to large losses are set out on pages 114 and 115. 

The Group writes energy liability business on a stand-alone basis. Unlike the liability contained within the energy packages that 
Lancashire writes, stand-alone energy liability is written on an excess of loss basis only. Coverage is worldwide and provides coverage  
for all kinds of damages and loss to third parties. Coverage is generally restricted to offshore assets. 

Construction energy contracts generally cover all risks of platform and drilling units under construction at yards and offshore,  
during towing and installation. Onshore construction contracts are generally not written. 

Reinsurance protection may be purchased to protect a portion of loss from elemental and non-elemental energy claims, and from  
the accumulation of smaller, attritional losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis but, from time to time,  
quota share arrangements may be entered into. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis. 

118 
118 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
IV. MARINE 
Gross premiums written, for the year: 

Marine hull and total loss 

Marine P&I clubs 

Marine builders’ risk 

Marine hull war 

Other marine 

Total 

2015
$m

19.9

13.0

6.5

6.0

2.2

47.6

2014 
$m

29.6

12.8

12.2

10.3

2.8

67.7

With the exception of the marine P&I clubs, where excess layers are written, most policies are written on a ground-up basis. Marine hull 
and total loss is generally written on a direct basis and covers marine risks on a worldwide basis, primarily for physical damage. Marine  
P&I clubs is mostly the reinsurance of the International Group of Protection and Indemnity Clubs and covers marine liabilities. Marine 
builders’ risk covers the building of ocean going vessels in specialised yards worldwide and their testing and commissioning. Marine hull 
war is mostly direct insurance of loss of vessels from war, piracy or terrorist attack, with a very limited amount of facultative reinsurance.  

The largest expected exposure in the marine class is from physical loss rather than from elemental loss events, although there is exposure 
to elemental perils and to the costs for removal of wreck. 

Reinsurance may be purchased to reduce the Group’s exposure to both large risk losses and an accumulation of smaller, attritional  
losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on a treaty excess of loss basis. 

V. AVIATION 
Gross premiums written, for the year:  

AV52 

Aviation satellite 

Other aviation 

Total 

2015
$m

23.5

12.2

0.9

36.6

2014 
$m

25.9

24.8

2.5

53.2

AV52 is written on a risk attaching excess of loss basis and provides coverage for third-party liability, excluding own passenger liability, 
resulting from acts of war or hijack of aircraft. Cover excludes countries whose governments provide a backstop coverage, but does,  
since 2014, include some U.S. commercial airlines. 

Aviation satellite cover is written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis and can provide cover for satellite launch, satellite in-orbit 
or both satellite launch and in-orbit. Coverage for in-orbit can be provided on an annual or multi-year basis and both launch and in-orbit 
can cover loss of earnings as well as physical damage. 

Reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to an AV52 event loss. Reinsurance is typically purchased on a treaty excess  
of loss basis. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

119 
119

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

REINSURANCE 
The Group, in the normal course of business and in accordance with its risk management practices, seeks to reduce certain types of  
loss that may arise from events that could cause unfavourable underwriting results, and to improve the modeled risk-adjusted RoE by 
entering into reinsurance arrangements. Reinsurance does not relieve the Group of its obligations to policyholders. Under the Group’s 
reinsurance security policy, reinsurers are assessed and approved as appropriate security based on their financial strength ratings, 
amongst other factors. The RSC considers reinsurers that are not rated or do not fall within the predefined rating categories on a  
case-by-case basis, and would usually require collateral to be posted to support such obligations. There are specific guidelines for  
these collateralised contracts. The RSC monitors its reinsurers on an ongoing basis and will formally review the Group’s reinsurance 
arrangements at least quarterly.  

Reinsurance protection is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis, however it may also include ILW covers or quota share 
arrangements. The mix of reinsurance cover is dependent on the specific loss mitigation requirements, market conditions and available 
capacity. Reinsurance may also be purchased to optimise the risk-adjusted return of the underwriting portfolio. The structure varies 
between types of peril and sub-class. The Group regularly reviews its catastrophe exposures and may purchase reinsurance in order  
to reduce the Group’s net exposure to a large natural catastrophe loss and/or to reduce net exposures to other large losses. The Group  
can purchase both facultative and treaty reinsurance. There is no guarantee that reinsurance coverage will be available to meet all 
potential loss circumstances, as it is possible that the cover purchased is not sufficient to transfer the totality of the Group’s exposure.  
Any loss amount which exceeds the programme would be retained by the Group. Some parts of the reinsurance programme have  
limited reinstatements, therefore the number of claims which may be recovered from second or subsequent losses in those particular 
circumstances is limited.  

INSURANCE LIABILITIES 
For most insurance and reinsurance companies, the most significant judgement made by management is the estimation of losses and  
loss adjustment expenses. The estimation of the ultimate liability arising from claims made under insurance and reinsurance contracts  
is a critical estimate for the Group, particularly given the nature of the business written. 

Under U.S. GAAP, loss reserves are not permitted until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a claim. As a result, only loss 
reserves applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date are established, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency 
reserve to account for expected future losses or for the emergence of new types of latent claims. Claims arising from future events can  
be expected to require the establishment of substantial reserves from time to time. All reserves are reported on an undiscounted basis. 

Losses and loss adjustment expenses are maintained to cover the Group’s estimated liability for both reported and unreported claims. 
Reserving methodologies that calculate a point estimate for the ultimate losses are utilised, and then a range is developed around these 
point estimates. The point estimate represents management’s best estimate of ultimate loss and loss adjustment expenses. The Group’s 
internal actuaries review the reserving assumptions and methodologies on a quarterly basis with loss estimates being subject to a semi-
annual corroborative review by independent actuaries, using U.S. generally accepted actuarial principles. This independent review is 
presented to the Group’s Audit Committee. The Group has also established Reserve Committees at the operating entity level, which  
have responsibility for the review of large claims and IBNR levels, their development and any changes in reserving methodology  
and assumptions. 

The extent of reliance on management’s judgement in the reserving process differs as to whether the business is insurance or 
reinsurance, whether it is short-tail or long-tail and whether the business is written on an excess of loss or on a pro-rata basis.  
Over a typical annual period, the Group expects to write the large majority of programmes on a direct excess of loss basis.  
The Group does not currently write a significant amount of long-tail business. 

INSURANCE VERSUS REINSURANCE 
Loss reserve calculations for direct insurance business are not precise in that they deal with the inherent uncertainty of assumptions 
regarding future reporting and development patterns, frequency and severity trends, claims settlement practices, potential changes in  
the legal environment and other factors, such as inflation. These estimates and judgements are based on numerous factors and may be 
revised as additional experience or other data becomes available or reviewed as new or improved methodologies are developed or as 
current laws or regulations change.  

Furthermore, as a broker market reinsurer, management must rely on loss information reported to brokers by other insurers and  
their loss adjusters, who must estimate their own losses at the policy level, often based on incomplete and changing information.  
The information management receives varies by cedant and may include paid losses, estimated case reserves and an estimated provision 
for IBNR reserves. Additionally, reserving practices and the quality of data reporting may vary among ceding companies, which adds 
further uncertainty to the estimation of the ultimate losses.  

120 
120 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
SHORT-TAIL VERSUS LONG-TAIL 
In general, claims relating to short-tail risks, such as the majority of risks underwritten by the Group, are reported more promptly  
than those relating to long-tail risks, including the majority of casualty risks. However, the timeliness of reporting can be affected by  
such factors as the nature of the event causing the loss, the location of the loss, and whether the losses are from policies in force with 
insureds, primary insurers, reinsurers or vendor binding authorities. 

EXCESS OF LOSS VERSUS PROPORTIONAL 
For excess of loss contracts, which make up the majority of the Group’s business, management are aided by the fact that each policy has  
a defined limit of liability arising from one event. Once that limit has been reached, there is no further exposure to additional losses from 
that policy for the same event. For proportional business, an initial estimated loss and loss expense ratio is generally used. This is based 
upon information provided by the insured or ceding company and/or their broker and management’s historical experience of that 
treaty, if any, and the estimate is adjusted as actual experience becomes known.  

TIME LAGS 
There is a time lag inherent in reporting from the original claimant to the primary insurer or binding authority holder to the broker  
and then to the reinsurer. Also, the combination of low claims frequency and high severity makes the available data more volatile and  
less useful for predicting ultimate losses. In the case of proportional contracts, reliance is placed on an analysis of a contract’s historical 
experience, industry information, and the professional judgement of underwriters in estimating reserves for these contracts. In addition,  
if available, reliance is placed partially on ultimate loss ratio forecasts as reported by insureds or cedants, which are normally subject to  
a quarterly or six-month lag. 

UNCERTAINTY 
As a result of the time lag described above, an estimation must be made of IBNR reserves, which consist of a provision for additional 
development in excess of the case reserves reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for claims which have  
occurred but which have not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. Due to the degree of reliance that is necessarily  
placed on insureds or ceding companies for claims reporting, the associated time lag, the low frequency/high severity nature of much  
of the business that the Group underwrites, and the varying reserving practices among ceding companies, reserve estimates are highly 
dependent on management judgement and are therefore uncertain. During the loss settlement period, which may be years in duration, 
additional facts regarding individual claims and trends often will become known, and current laws and case law may change as well as 
regulatory directives, with a consequent impact on reserving. The claims count on the types of insurance and reinsurance that the  
Group writes, which are low frequency and high severity in nature, is generally low.  

For certain catastrophic events there are greater uncertainties underlying the assumptions and associated estimated reserves for  
losses and loss adjustment expenses. Complexity resulting from problems such as policy coverage issues, multiple events affecting one 
geographic area and the resulting impact on claims adjusting (including the allocation of claims to the specific event and the effect  
of demand surge on the cost of building materials and labour) by, and communications from, insureds or ceding companies, can cause 
delays to the timing with which the Group is notified of changes to loss estimates. 

As at 31 December 2015, management’s estimates for IBNR represented 35.2 per cent of total net loss reserves (31 December  
2014 – 31.6 per cent). The majority of the estimate relates to potential claims on non-elemental risks where timing delays in insured  
or cedant reporting may mean losses could have occurred of which the Group was not made aware by the balance sheet date.  

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

121 
121

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

B. MARKET RISK 
The Group is at risk of loss due to movements in market factors. The main risks include: 

i. 

Insurance risk;  

ii.  Investment risk;  
iii.  Debt risk; and  

iv.  Currency risk.  

These risks, and the management thereof, are described below. 

I. INSURANCE RISK 
The Group is exposed to insurance market risk from several sources, including the following: 

•  the advent or continuation of a soft market, which may result in a stabilisation or decline in premium rates and/or terms  

and conditions for certain lines, or across all lines; 

•  the actions and reactions of key competitors, which may directly result in volatility in premium volumes and rates, fee levels and  

other input costs;  

•  market events which may cause a limit in the availability of cover, including unusual inflation in rates, causing political intervention  

or national remedies;  

•  failure to maintain broker, binding authority and client relationships, leading to a limited or substandard choice of risks inconsistent 

with the Group’s risk appetite; and 

•  changes in regulation including capital, governance or licensing requirements.  

The most important method to mitigate insurance market risk is to maintain strict underwriting standards. The Group manages 
insurance market risk in numerous ways, including the following: 

•  reviews and amends underwriting plans and outlook as necessary; 

•  reduces exposure to market sectors where conditions have reached unattractive levels; 

•  purchases appropriate, cost-effective reinsurance cover to mitigate exposures; 

•  closely monitors changes in rates and terms and conditions;  

•  ensures through continuous capital management that it does not allow surplus capital to drive underwriting appetite; 

•  holds a daily underwriting meeting for LICL and LUK to discuss, inter alia, market conditions and opportunities; 

•  reviews all new and renewal business post-underwriting for Cathedral; 

•  regularly reviews output from BLAST to assess up-to-date profitability of classes and sectors;  

•  holds a quarterly Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee meeting to review underwriting strategy;  

•  holds a fortnightly RRC meeting to monitor estimated exposures to peak zone elemental losses and RDS; and 

•  holds regular documented meetings with regulators.  

Insurance contract liabilities are not directly sensitive to the level of market interest rates, as they are undiscounted and contractually  
non-interest bearing.  

122 
122 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
II. INVESTMENT RISK 
Movements in investments resulting from changes in interest and inflation rates and currency exchange rates, amongst other factors,  
may lead to an adverse impact on the value of the Group’s investment portfolio. Investment guidelines are established by the Investment 
Committee of the Board of Directors to manage this risk. Investment guidelines set parameters within which the Group’s external 
investment managers must operate. Important parameters include guidelines on permissible assets, duration ranges, credit quality, 
currency, maturity, sectors, geographical, sovereign and issuer exposures. Compliance with guidelines is monitored on a monthly basis. 
Any adjustments to the investment guidelines are approved by the Investment Committee and the Board of Directors.  

The Group’s fixed income portfolios are managed by four external investment managers. The Group also has a diversified portfolio  
of multi-strategy low volatility hedge funds, and a small equity portfolio. The performance of the managers is monitored on an  
ongoing basis. 

Within the Group guidelines is a subset of guidelines for the portion of funds required to meet near-term obligations and cash flow  
needs following an extreme event. The subset of guidelines adds a further degree of requirements, including fewer allowable asset classes, 
higher credit quality, shorter duration and higher liquidity. The primary objectives for this portion of assets are capital preservation  
and providing liquidity to meet insurance and other near-term obligations. In addition to cash managed internally, funds held in the 
investment portfolio to cover this potential liability are designated as the ‘core’ portfolio and the portfolio duration is matched to the 
duration of the insurance liabilities, within an agreed range. The core portfolio is invested in fixed income securities, fixed income funds 
and cash and cash equivalents. The core portfolio may, at times, contain assets significantly in excess of those required to meet insurance 
liabilities or other defined funding needs.  

Assets in excess of those required to be held in the core portfolio are typically held in the ‘core plus’ or the ‘surplus’ portfolios. The  
core plus portfolio is invested in fixed income securities and cash and cash equivalents. The surplus portfolio is invested in fixed income 
securities, principal protected equity linked notes, derivative instruments, cash and cash equivalents, equity securities and hedge funds. 
The assets in the core plus and surplus portfolios are not matched to specific insurance liabilities. In general, the duration of the surplus 
portfolio is slightly longer than the core or core plus portfolio, while maintaining a focus on high quality assets.  

The Group reviews the composition, duration and asset allocation of its investment portfolio on a regular basis in order to respond  
to changes in interest rates and other market conditions. If certain asset classes are anticipated to produce a higher return within 
management’s risk tolerance, an adjustment in asset allocation may be made. Conversely, if the risk profile is expected to move outside  
of tolerance levels, adjustments may be made to reduce the risks in the portfolio. 

The investment portfolio is currently structured to perform better in a risk-on environment in order to mitigate the impact of a potential 
rise in interest rates. The Group endeavours to limit losses in risk-on, risk-off, and interest rate hike scenarios. The Group models various 
periods of significant stress in order to better understand the investment portfolio’s risks and exposures. The scenarios represent what 
could, and most likely will occur (albeit not in the exact form of the scenarios, which are based on historic periods of volatility).  
The Group also monitors the portfolio impact of more severe disaster scenarios consisting of extreme shocks. 

The IRRC meets quarterly to ensure that the Group’s strategic and tactical investment actions are consistent with investment  
risk preferences, appetite, risk and return objectives and tolerances. The IRRC also helps further develop the risk tolerances to  
be incorporated into the ERM framework. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

123 
123

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The investment mix of the fixed income portfolios is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2015 

–   Short-term investments  

–   Fixed income funds 

–   U.S. treasuries 

–   Other government bonds 

–   U.S. municipal bonds 

–   U.S. government agency debt 

–   Asset backed securities 

–   U.S. government agency mortgage 

backed securities 

–   Non-agency mortgage backed 

securities 

–   Non-agency commercial mortgage 

backed securities 

–   Bank loans 

–   Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Total fixed income securities  

As at 31 December 2014 

–   Short-term investments  

–   Fixed income funds 

–   U.S. treasuries 

–   Other government bonds 

–   U.S. municipal bonds 

–   U.S. government agency debt 

–   Asset backed securities 

–   U.S. government agency mortgage 

backed securities 

–   Non-agency mortgage backed 

securities 

–   Agency commercial mortgage 

backed securities 

–   Non-agency commercial mortgage 

backed securities 

–   Bank loans 

–   Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Total fixed income securities  

Core 

$m 

7.5 

11.4 

178.4 

24.4 

0.6 

2.9 

16.1 

20.2 

5.5 

4.1 

– 

182.4 

453.5 

– 

453.5 

%

0.5

0.7

11.1

1.5

–

0.2

1.0

1.3

0.3

0.3

–

11.4

28.3

–

28.3

Core plus 

Surplus 

Total 

$m

13.1

–

157.5

22.6

–

1.0

66.3

39.0

12.1

11.5

–

278.9

602.0

–

602.0

%

0.8

–

9.8

1.4

–

–

4.1

2.4

0.8

0.7

–

17.4

37.4

–

37.4

$m

–

–

57.4

18.4

4.6

–

31.5

84.6

% 

– 

– 

3.6 

1.2 

0.3 

– 

2.0 

$m

20.6

11.4

393.3

65.4

5.2

3.9

113.9

5.3 

143.8

4.2

0.3 

21.8

13.2

115.0

192.5

521.4

24.8

546.2

0.8 

7.2 

12.0 

32.7 

1.6 

34.3 

28.8

115.0

653.8

1,576.9

24.8

Core 

Core plus 

Surplus 

Total 

$m 

0.1 

15.4 

145.3 

49.5 

0.9 

1.4 

89.1 

40.6 

9.5 

– 

4.6 

– 

307.9 

664.3 

– 

664.3 

%

–

0.8

8.0

2.7

–

0.1

4.9

2.2

0.5

–

0.3

–

17.0

36.5

–

36.5

$m

30.3

–

129.0

1.7

0.3

–

28.8

41.9

4.0

0.3

14.3

–

153.5

404.1

–

404.1

%

1.7

–

7.1

0.1

–

–

1.6

2.3

0.2

–

0.8

–

8.5

22.3

–

22.3

$m

–

–

88.7

32.8

27.7

16.1

66.2

85.5

7.3

2.1

20.7

127.9

243.7

718.7

31.2

749.9

% 

– 

– 

4.9 

1.8 

1.5 

0.9 

3.6 

$m

30.4

15.4

363.0

84.0

28.9

17.5

184.1

4.7 

168.0

20.8

2.4

39.6

127.9

705.1

1,787.1

31.2

0.4 

0.1 

1.1 

7.0 

13.5 

39.5 

1.7 

41.2 

%

1.3

0.7

24.5

4.1

0.3

0.2

7.1

9.0

1.4

1.8

7.2

40.8

98.4

1.6

%

1.7

0.8

20.0

4.6

1.5

1.0

10.1

9.2

1.1

0.1

2.2

7.0

39.0

98.3

1.7

1,601.7

100.0

1,818.3

100.0

124 
124 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
Bank loans, corporate bonds, fixed income securities at FVTPL and other government bonds by country are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2015 

United States 

United Kingdom 

Canada 

Netherlands 

Australia 

France 

Germany 

Japan 

Norway 

Switzerland 

Sweden 

Luxembourg 

Hong Kong 

Mexico 

Russian Federation 

Other 

Total 

Financials 
$m

126.6

Other
 industries
 $m

372.9

48.8

19.4

19.2

26.8

14.2

5.2

15.4

8.0

11.2

12.2

–

–

–

–

2.0

309.0

27.7

15.3

10.5

5.7

8.4

13.2

5.1

0.7

2.1

0.1

11.8

4.8

1.0

–

5.3

Total1  
$m  

499.5 

76.5 

34.7 

29.7 

32.5 

22.6 

18.4 

20.5 

8.7 

13.3 

12.3 

11.8 

4.8 

1.0 

– 

7.3 

Other 
government
 bonds 
$m

–

1.0

13.8

7.5

4.2

7.8

10.8

–

5.3

–

0.2

–

–

3.5

3.4

7.9

484.6

793.6 

65.4

(1) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds and fixed income securities at FVTPL. 

(2) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds, fixed income securities at FVTPL and other government bonds. 

As at 31 December 2014 

United States 

United Kingdom 

Canada 

Australia 

France 

Netherlands 

Germany 

Norway 

Japan 

Switzerland 

Sweden 

Luxembourg 

Mexico 

Hong Kong 

United Arab Emirates 

Other 

Total 

(1) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds and fixed income securities at FVTPL. 

(2) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds, fixed income securities at FVTPL and other government bonds. 

Financials 
$m

141.5

Other
 industries
 $m

382.5

49.8

29.7

34.1

10.3

13.2

2.8

15.5

10.2

15.6

13.9

–

–

–

–

4.6

341.2

37.4

19.7

7.5

14.6

11.4

15.8

0.8

7.7

0.7

–

7.2

3.0

4.9

0.2

9.6

523.0

Total1  
$m  

524.0 

87.2 

49.4 

41.6 

24.9 

24.6 

18.6 

16.3 

17.9 

16.3 

13.9 

7.2 

3.0 

4.9 

0.2 

14.2 

864.2 

Other 
government
 bonds 
$m

–

0.4

24.6

9.8

8.4

6.4

9.8

5.0

–

–

0.2

–

3.6

–

3.5

12.3

84.0

Total2 
$m

499.5

77.5

48.5

37.2

36.7

30.4

29.2

20.5

14.0

13.3

12.5

11.8

4.8

4.5

3.4

15.2

859.0

Total2 
$m

524.0

87.6

74.0

51.4

33.3

31.0

28.4

21.3

17.9

16.3

14.1

7.2

6.6

4.9

3.7

26.5

948.2

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

125 
125

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The sector allocation of the corporate bonds, fixed income securities at FVTPL and bank loans is as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Industrial 

Financial 

Utility 

Supranationals 

Total 

2015 

 $m

457.9

308.5

26.7

0.5

793.6

 % 

57.7 

38.9 

3.4 

– 

100.0 

2014 

 $m

487.3

338.3

35.7

2.9

864.2

%

56.5

39.1

4.1

0.3

100.0

The Group’s net asset value is directly impacted by movements in the value of investments held. Values can be impacted by movements  
in interest rates, credit ratings, exchange rates and economic environment and outlook.  

The Group’s investment portfolio is mainly comprised of fixed income securities and cash and cash equivalents. The fixed income  
funds are overseas deposits held by Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 in trust for the benefit of the policyholders in those overseas 
jurisdictions. They consist of high quality, short duration fixed income securities. The Group also has small equity and hedge fund 
portfolios. The estimated fair value of the Group’s fixed income portfolio is generally inversely correlated to movements in market 
interest rates. If market interest rates fall, the fair value of the Group’s fixed income securities would tend to rise and vice versa.  

The sensitivity of the price of fixed income securities, and certain derivatives, to movements in interest rates is indicated by their duration. 
The greater a security’s duration, the greater its price volatility to movements in interest rates. The sensitivity of the Group’s fixed income 
and derivative investment portfolio to interest rate movements is detailed below, assuming linear movements in interest rates: 

As at 31 December 

Immediate shift in yield (basis points) 

100 

75 

50 

25 

(25) 

(50) 

(75) 

(100) 

2015 

$m

(25.5)

(19.1)

(12.7)

(6.4)

6.8

13.5

20.3

27.1

% 

(1.6)

(1.2)

(0.8)

(0.4)

0.4 

0.8 

1.3 

1.7 

2014 

$m

(30.6)

(22.9)

(15.3)

(7.6)

7.6

15.1

22.7

30.2

%

(1.7)

(1.3)

(0.8)

(0.4)

0.4

0.8

1.2

1.7

The Group mitigates interest rate risk on the investment portfolio by establishing and monitoring duration ranges in its investment 
guidelines. The Group may manage duration through the use of interest rate futures and swaptions from time to time. The duration  
of the core portfolio is matched to the modeled duration of the insurance reserves, within a permitted range. The permitted duration 
range for the core plus portfolio is between zero and four years and the surplus portfolio is between one and five years.  

The total durations of the externally managed portfolios which are comprised of fixed income, cash and cash equivalents and certain 
derivatives, are as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Core portfolio 

Core plus portfolio  

Surplus portfolio1 

Overall external portfolio1 

(1) Including duration overlay. 

2015 
years

1.7

1.7

1.3

1.6

2014 
years

1.7

1.9

1.4

1.6

The overall duration for fixed income, managed cash and cash equivalents and certain derivatives is 1.5 years (2014 – 1.5 years). 

In addition to duration management, the Group uses VaR on a monthly basis to measure potential losses in the estimated fair values of  
its cash and invested assets and to understand and monitor risk. The VaR calculation is performed using variance/covariance risk 
modeling to capture the cash flows and embedded optionality of the portfolio. Securities are valued individually using standard  
market pricing models. These security valuations serve as the input to many risk analytics, including full valuation risk analyses,  
as well as parametric methods that rely on option adjusted risk sensitivities to approximate the risk and return profiles of the portfolio.  

126 
126 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
The principal VaR measure that is produced is an annual VaR at the 99th percentile confidence level. The annual VaR, at the 99th 
percentile confidence level, measures the minimum amount the assets should be expected to lose over a one-year time horizon,  
under normal conditions, 1 per cent of the time.  

The Group’s annual VaR calculations are as follows: 

As at 31 December 

99th percentile confidence level1 

(1) Including the impact of internal foreign exchange hedges. 

2015 

2014 

% of shareholders’ 
equity 

$m

% of shareholders’ 
equity

$m

28.9

2.4 

34.0

2.5

DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the investment managers to utilise exchange-traded futures and options contracts, and  
OTC instruments including interest rate swaps, credit default swaps, interest rate swaptions and forward foreign currency contracts. 
Derivatives are used for yield enhancement, duration management, interest rate and foreign currency exposure management or to  
obtain an exposure to a particular financial market. These positions are monitored regularly. The Group may also use OTC or exchange 
traded managed derivatives to mitigate interest rate risk and foreign currency exposures. The Group principally has exposure to 
derivatives related to the following types of risks: foreign currency risk, interest rate risk and credit risk. 

The Group currently invests in the following derivative financial instruments: 

a.  Futures;  
b.  Options;  
c.  Forward foreign currency contracts;  
d.  Swaps; and 
e.  Swaptions. 

The net gains or losses on the Group’s derivative financial instruments recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive 
income are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2015 

Treasury futures 

Forward foreign currency contracts 

Interest rate swaps – held internally 

Total 

As at 31 December 2014 

Treasury futures 

Forward foreign currency contracts 

Interest rate swaps – investments portfolio 

Interest rate swaps – held internally 

Swaptions 

Total 

Net other 
investment 
income 
 $m

Net realised  
(losses)  
$m 

Net foreign 
exchange 
gains
$m 

–

–

–

–

(1.4)

– 

– 

(1.4)

–

3.6

–

3.6

Net other
investment 
(losses)
$m

Net realised 
(losses) 
$m 

Net foreign
exchange
(losses) 
$m 

–

–

(0.1)

–

(2.2)

(2.3)

(6.0)

– 

(0.1)

– 

(2.1)

(8.2)

–

(0.7)

–

–

–

(0.7)

Financing 
(losses) 
$m

–

–

(2.5)

(2.5)

Financing
(losses) 
$m

–

–

–

(7.4)

–

(7.4)

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

127 
127

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The estimated fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments are as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Forward foreign currency 
contracts 

Interest rate swaps – held 
internally 

Total 

2015 

2014 

Other  
investments  
$m  

Other 
receivables 
$m

Other
payables
$m

Interest 
rate swaps
 $m

Other 
investments 
$m 

Other  
receivables  
$m 

Other
payables
$m

Interest 
rate swaps
 $m

– 

– 

– 

1.6

–

1.6

(0.7)

–

(0.7)

–

(4.8)

(4.8)

0.7

–

0.7

3.8 

– 

3.8 

(1.8)

–

(1.8)

–

(4.9)

(4.9)

A. FUTURES 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of futures which provide the Group with participation in market movements, 
determined by the underlying instrument on which the futures contract is based, without holding the instrument itself or the individual 
securities. This approach allows the Group more efficient and less costly access to the exposure than would be available by the exclusive 
use of individual fixed income and money market securities. Exchange-traded futures contracts may also be used as substitutes for 
ownership of the physical securities. 

All futures contracts are held on a non-leveraged basis. An initial margin is provided, which is a deposit of cash and/or securities in  
an amount equal to a prescribed percentage of the contract value. The fair value of futures contracts is estimated daily and the margin  
is adjusted accordingly with unrealised gains and/or losses settled daily in cash and/or securities. A realised gain or loss is recognised 
when the contract is closed. 

Futures contracts expose the Group to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the estimated fair values of the underlying 
securities. Exchange-traded futures are, however, subject to a number of safeguards to ensure that obligations are met. These include  
the use of clearing houses (thus reducing counterparty credit risk), the posting of margins and the daily settlement of unrealised gains 
and losses. The amount of credit risk is therefore considered low. The investment guidelines restrict the maximum notional futures 
position as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value. 

As at 31 December, the Group had the following exposure to treasury futures: 

As at 31 December 

Treasury futures 

Total 

Notional 
long 
$m 

56.1

56.1

2015 

Notional 
short 
$m

152.5

152.5

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

(96.4)

(96.4)

Notional  
long  
$m 

89.1 

89.1 

2014 

Notional
 short
 $m

169.9

169.9

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

(80.8)

(80.8)

B. OPTIONS 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of exchange-traded options on U.S. treasury futures and Eurodollar futures, which  
are used to manage exposure to interest rate risk and also to hedge duration. Exchange-traded options are held on a similar basis  
to futures and are subject to similar safeguards. Options are contractual arrangements that give the purchaser the right, but not the 
obligation, to either buy or sell an instrument at a specific set price at a predetermined future date. The Group may enter into option 
contracts that are secured by holdings in the underlying securities or by other means which permit immediate satisfaction of the Group’s 
obligations. The notional amount of options is $nil as at 31 December 2015 and 2014. 

The investment guidelines also restrict the maximum notional options exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated 
fair value. 

128 
128 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
C. FORWARD FOREIGN CURRENCY CONTRACTS 
A forward foreign currency contract is a commitment to purchase or sell a foreign currency at a future date, at a defined rate. The Group 
may utilise forward foreign currency contracts to gain exposure to a certain currency or market rate or manage the impact of fluctuations 
in foreign currencies on the value of its foreign currency denominated investments, debt and/or insurance related currency exposures. 

Forward contracts expose the Group to credit, market and liquidity risks. Credit risk arises from the potential inability of counterparties to 
perform under the terms of the contract. The Group is exposed to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the exchange 
rate of the underlying foreign currency. Liquidity risk represents the possibility that the Group may not be able to rapidly adjust the size 
of its forward positions at a reasonable price in times of high volatility and financial stress. These risks are mitigated by requiring a 
minimum counterparty credit quality, restricting the maximum notional exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated 
fair value and restricting exposures to foreign currencies, individually and in aggregate, as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s 
estimated fair value.  

The notional amount of a derivative contract is the underlying quantity upon which payment obligations are calculated. A long position  
is equivalent to buying the underlying currency whereas a short position is equivalent to having sold the underlying currency. 

The Group has the following open forward foreign currency contracts: 

As at 31 December 

Canadian Dollar 

Australian Dollar 

Japanese Yen 

British Pound  

Malaysian Ringgit 

Euro 

Total 

2015 

Notional 
long 
$m 

Notional 
short 
$m

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

Notional  
long  
$m 

2014 

Notional
 short
 $m

Net notional 
long (short) 
$m

–

7.1

5.9

10.4

3.0

28.9

55.3

21.4

17.8

7.4

8.6

–

15.9

71.1

(21.4)

(10.7)

(1.5)

1.8

3.0

13.0

(15.8)

0.4 

10.0 

5.1 

– 

3.7 

43.2 

62.4 

20.7

26.3

5.1

8.1

–

26.4

86.6

(20.3)

(16.3)

–

(8.1)

3.7

16.8

(24.2)

D. SWAPS 
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of interest rate swaps and credit default swaps which are traded primarily OTC. Swaps 
are recorded at estimated fair value at the end of each period with unrealised gains and losses recorded in the consolidated statement  
of comprehensive income. 

Interest rate swaps are used to manage interest rate exposure, portfolio duration or capitalise on anticipated changes in interest rate 
volatility without investing directly in the underlying securities. Interest rate swap agreements entail the exchange of commitments to  
pay or receive interest, such as an exchange of floating rate payments for fixed rate payments, with respect to a notional amount  
of principal. These agreements involve elements of credit and market risk. Such risks include the possibility that there may not be  
a liquid market, that the counterparty may default on its obligation to perform, or that there may be unfavourable movements in  
interest rates. These risks are mitigated through defining a minimum counterparty credit quality and a maximum notional exposure  
to interest rate swaps as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value. The notional amount of interest rate swaps  
held in the investment portfolio is not material as at 31 December 2015 and 2014. The notional amount of interest rate swaps held 
internally for the purposes of hedging the interest rate exposure on the Group’s subordinated loan notes as at 31 December 2015  
is $246.4 million (31 December 2014 – $252.3 million). 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

129 
129

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

E. SWAPTIONS 
The Group has the ability to use swaptions, options on interest rate swaps, to manage interest rate risk exposure and portfolio and yield 
curve duration. The Group, as the purchaser of a swaption, is subject to the credit risk of the counterparty but is only subject to market 
risk to the extent of the premium paid. As a swaption writer, the Group is not subject to credit risk but is subject to market risk, due to its 
obligation to make payments under the terms of the contract. These risks are mitigated through maximum allowable notional exposures 
as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value. The estimated fair value of these instruments is $nil as at 31 December 
2015 and 2014. 

III. DEBT RISK 

The Group has issued long-term debt as described in note 22. The LHL issued subordinated loan notes due in 2035 bear interest at 
a floating rate that is reset on a quarterly basis, plus a fixed margin of 3.70 per cent. The Group is subject to interest rate risk on the 
coupon payments of these subordinated loan notes. The Group has mitigated the interest rate risk on the LHL debt by entering into 
interest rate swap contracts as follows: 

Subordinated loan notes $97.0 million 

Subordinated loan notes €24.0 million 

Maturity date

Interest hedged

15 December 2035

15 June 2035

100%

100%

The interest rate swaps expire on 15 December 2020, therefore until 2020 the Group has no cash flow interest rate risk on the LHL issued 
subordinated loan notes due in 2035. 

The senior unsecured notes maturing 1 October 2022 bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.70 per cent and therefore the Group is not 
exposed to interest rate risk on this long-term debt. 

On the acquisition of Cathedral, the Group assumed subordinated loan notes as described in note 22. The Group is subject to  
interest rate risk on the coupon payment of this long-term debt. An increase of 100 basis points on the EURIBOR and LIBOR three-
month deposit rates would result in an increase in the interest expense on long term debt for the Group of approximately $0.7 million  
on an annual basis. 

IV. CURRENCY RISK 
The Group underwrites from two locations, Bermuda and London, although risks are assumed on a worldwide basis. Risks assumed  
are predominantly denominated in U.S. dollars.  

The Group is exposed to currency risk to the extent its assets are denominated in different currencies to its liabilities. The Group is also 
exposed to non-retranslation risk on non-monetary assets such as unearned premiums and deferred acquisition costs. Exchange gains  
and losses can impact income. 

The Group hedges monetary non-U.S. dollar liabilities primarily with non-U.S. dollar assets, but may also use derivatives to mitigate 
foreign currency exposures. The Group’s main foreign currency exposure relates to its insurance obligations, cash holdings, investments, 
premiums receivable, dividends payable and the euro denominated subordinated loan notes long-term debt liabilities discussed in  
note 22. See page 129 for a listing of the Group’s open forward foreign currency contracts. 

130 
130 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
The Group’s assets and liabilities, categorised by currency at their translated carrying amount, are as follows: 

Assets 

Cash and cash equivalents  

Accrued interest receivable  

Investments 

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds 
and cedants 

Reinsurance assets 

Other receivables  

Investment in associate 

Property, plant and equipment  

Deferred acquisition costs 

Intangible assets 

Total assets as at 31 December 2015 

Liabilities  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses  

Unearned premiums  

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Deferred acquisition costs ceded 

Other payables 

Corporation tax payable 

Deferred tax liability 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total liabilities as at 31 December 2015 

U.S. $ 
$m

190.8

6.5

1,706.3

204.4

106.1

35.5

47.5

0.5

68.4

153.8

2,519.8

U.S. $ 
$m

529.3

318.5

27.0

24.0

0.3

31.7

0.8

16.7

2.3

284.4

1,235.0

Sterling 
$m

40.3

–

17.0

15.4

7.2

1.8

–

6.7

5.6

–

94.0

Sterling 
$m

43.5

19.2

3.8

1.8

–

35.2

1.0

8.9

–

–

113.4

 Euro 
$m

17.8

–

32.0

23.5

2.7

–

–

–

7.1

–

83.1

 Euro 
$m

47.4

34.6

3.0

0.6

–

0.1

–

–

2.5

37.9

126.1

Japanese Yen  
$m 

18.5 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

0.4 

– 

18.9 

Japanese Yen  
$m 

20.9 

3.7 

0.3 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

Other 
$m

24.4

–

18.0

10.4

0.8

0.5

–

–

5.7

–

59.8

Other 
$m

29.9

23.2

2.1

0.2

–

–

–

–

–

–

24.9 

55.4

 Total 
$m

291.8

6.5

1,773.3

253.7

116.8

37.8

47.5

7.2

87.2

153.8

2,775.6

 Total 
$m

671.0

399.2

36.2

26.6

0.3

67.0

1.8

25.6

4.8

322.3

1,554.8

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

131 
131

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

Assets 

Cash and cash equivalents  

Accrued interest receivable  

Investments 

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds 
and cedants 

Reinsurance assets 

Other receivables  

Corporation tax receivable 

Investment in associate 

Property, plant and equipment  

Deferred acquisition costs 

Intangible assets 

Total assets as at 31 December 2014 

Liabilities  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses  

Unearned premiums  

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Deferred acquisition costs ceded 

Other payables 

Deferred tax liability 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total liabilities as at 31 December 2014 

U.S. $ 
$m

173.4

7.7

1,885.7

263.5

119.8

10.8

–

52.7

0.3

81.8

153.8

2,749.5

U.S. $ 
$m

550.1

379.6

34.8

30.0

0.1

46.5

17.4

1.6

284.4

1,344.5

Sterling 
$m

42.8

–

18.8

15.9

15.3

25.1

4.3

–

8.8

4.8

–

135.8

Sterling 
$m

51.9

20.2

1.4

2.4

–

36.8

21.3

–

–

134.0

 Euro
 $m

27.2

–

41.2

27.6

3.9

–

–

–

–

10.9

–

110.8

 Euro 
$m

65.6

48.4

2.2

1.0

–

0.1

–

3.3

42.2

162.8

Japanese Yen  
$m 

28.6 

– 

– 

0.2 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

0.6 

– 

29.4 

Japanese Yen  
$m 

43.3 

4.8 

0.3 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

Other 
$m

31.5

–

41.2

9.0

3.4

0.7

–

–

–

6.5

–

92.3

Other 
$m

41.7

26.1

2.1

0.8

–

0.1

–

–

–

48.4 

70.8

 Total 
$m

303.5

7.7

1,986.9

316.2

142.4

36.6

4.3

52.7

9.1

104.6

153.8

3,117.8

 Total 
$m

752.6

479.1

40.8

34.2

0.1

83.5

38.7

4.9

326.6

1,760.5

The impact on net income of a proportional foreign exchange movement of 10.0 per cent up and 10.0 per cent down against the  
U.S. dollar at the year end spot rates would be an increase or decrease of $2.6 million (2014 – $3.8 million). 

The 31 December 2014 losses and loss adjustment expenses included the equivalent of $21.0 million of Japanese Yen denominated 
insurance liabilities that were contained within the Group’s outwards reinsurance programme which limited the Group’s net liability  
to $30.0 million. The Group did not therefore hedge the foreign currency exposure in relation to these losses. 

The Group uses forward foreign currency contracts for the purposes of managing currency exposures. See page 129 for details  
of the Group’s open forward foreign currency contracts.  

132 
132 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
C. LIQUIDITY RISK 
Liquidity risk is the risk that cash may not be available to pay obligations when they are due without incurring an unreasonable cost.  
The Group’s main exposures to liquidity risk are with respect to its insurance and investment activities. The Group is exposed if proceeds 
from financial assets are not sufficient to fund obligations arising from its insurance contracts. The Group can be exposed to daily calls  
on its available investment assets, principally to settle insurance claims. 

Exposures in relation to insurance activities are as follows: 

•  large catastrophic events, or multiple medium-sized events in quick succession, resulting in a requirement to pay a large value of  

claims within a relatively short time frame; 

•  failure of insureds or cedants to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of premiums in a timely manner; and 

•  failure of reinsurers to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of claims in a timely manner.  

Exposures in relation to investment activities are as follows: 

•  adverse market movements and/or a duration mismatch to obligations, resulting in investments being disposed of at a significant 

realised loss; and 

•  an inability to liquidate investments due to market conditions. 

The maturity dates of the Group’s fixed income portfolio are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2015 

Less than one year 

Between one and two years 

Between two and three years 

Between three and four years 

Between four and five years 

Over five years 

Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed income securities 

As at 31 December 2014 

Less than one year 

Between one and two years 

Between two and three years 

Between three and four years 

Between four and five years 

Over five years 

Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed income securities 

Core 
$m

58.0

185.3

96.6

25.1

21.3

21.3

45.9

453.5

Core
 $m

103.7

168.1

200.0

20.9

21.9

5.9

143.8

664.3

Core plus  
$m 

93.0 

190.7 

102.8 

28.3 

46.5 

11.8 

128.9 

602.0 

Core plus  
$m 

58.9 

117.1 

80.6 

19.6 

29.1 

9.5 

89.3 

404.1 

Surplus 
$m

24.5

70.3

35.9

53.3

96.2

132.5

133.5

546.2

Surplus
 $m

43.6

42.4

75.5

65.3

97.5

243.8

181.8

749.9

Total 
$m

175.5

446.3

235.3

106.7

164.0

165.6

308.3

1,601.7

Total 
$m

206.2

327.6

356.1

105.8

148.5

259.2

414.9

1,818.3

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

133 
133

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The maturity profile of the financial liabilities of the Group is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2015 

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values 

Balance sheet 
$m

Less than one 
$m

One to three 
$m

Three to five  
$m 

Losses and loss adjustment expenses 

671.0

269.5

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Other payables 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total  

36.2

26.6

67.0

4.8

322.3

1,127.9

33.1

26.6

67.0

2.0

14.0

412.2

246.4

3.1

–

–

2.3

33.8

285.6

88.6 

– 

– 

– 

0.5 

36.5 

125.6 

As at 31 December 2014 

Losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Other payables 

Interest rate swap 

Long-term debt 

Total  

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values 

Balance sheet 
$m

Less than one 
$m

One to three 
$m

Three to five  
$m 

752.6

40.8

34.2

83.5

4.9

326.6

1,242.6

299.0

30.5

34.2

83.5

2.5

13.2

462.9

270.0

9.6

–

–

2.2

35.3

317.1

102.2 

0.7 

– 

– 

0.4 

38.0 

141.3 

Over five 
$m

66.5

–

–

–

–

Total 
$m

671.0

36.2

26.6

67.0

4.8

521.3

587.8

605.6

1,411.2

Over five 
$m

81.4

–

–

–

(0.2)

546.6

627.8

Total 
$m

752.6

40.8

34.2

83.5

4.9

633.1

1,549.1

Actual maturities of the above may differ from contractual maturities because certain borrowers have the right to call or prepay certain 
obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. The prepayment options for the Group’s long-term debt are discussed in  
note 22. While the estimation of the ultimate liability for losses and loss adjustment expenses is complex and incorporates a significant 
amount of judgement, the timing of payment of losses and loss adjustment expenses is also uncertain and cannot be predicted as simply 
as for other financial liabilities. Actuarial and statistical techniques, past experience and management's judgement have been used to 
determine a likely settlement pattern. 

The Group manages its liquidity risks via its investment strategy to hold high quality, highly liquid securities, sufficient to meet its 
insurance liabilities and other near-term liquidity requirements. The creation of the core portfolio with its subset of guidelines aims  
to ensure funds are readily available to meet potential insurance liabilities in an extreme event plus other near-term liquidity 
requirements. In addition, the Group has established asset allocation and maturity parameters within the investment guidelines  
such that the majority of the investments are in high quality assets which could be converted into cash promptly and at minimal  
expense. The Group monitors market changes and outlooks and reallocates assets as deemed necessary. 

134 
134 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
D. CREDIT RISK 
Credit risk is the risk that a counterparty may fail to pay, or repay, a debt or obligation. The Group is exposed to credit risk on its  
fixed income investment portfolio and derivative instruments, its inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants, and on  
any amounts recoverable from reinsurers.  

Credit risk on the fixed income portfolio is mitigated through the Group’s policy to invest in instruments of high credit quality issuers  
and to limit the amounts of credit exposure with respect to particular ratings categories and any one issuer. Securities rated below an  
S&P or equivalent rating of BBB-/Baa3 may comprise no more than 10.0 per cent of shareholders’ equity. In addition, no one issuer,  
with the exception of U.S. government and agency securities, other G10 government guaranteed securities (excluding Italy) and 
Australian sovereign debt should exceed 5.0 per cent of shareholders’ equity. The Group is therefore not exposed to any significant  
credit concentration risk on its investment portfolio, except for fixed income securities issued by the U.S. government and government 
agencies and other highly rated governments.  

Credit risk on exchange-traded derivative instruments is mitigated by the use of clearing houses to reduce counterparty credit risk,  
requiring the posting of margins and settling of unrealised gains and losses daily. Credit risk on OTC derivatives is mitigated by 
monitoring the creditworthiness of the counterparties and by requiring collateral to be posted for positions which have accrued gains  
by amounts exceeding predetermined thresholds. 

Credit risk on inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants is managed by conducting business with reputable broking 
organisations, with whom the Group has established relationships, and by rigorous cash collection procedures. The Group also has a 
broker approval process in place. Binding authorities are subject to standard market controls including credit control. Credit risk from 
reinsurance recoverables is primarily managed by the review and approval of reinsurer security, as discussed on page 120.  

The table below presents an analysis of the Group’s major exposures to counterparty credit risk, based on their rating. The table  
includes amounts due from policyholders and unsettled investment trades. The quality of these receivables is not graded but, based  
on management’s historical experience, there is limited default risk associated with these amounts.  

As at 31 December 2015 

AAA 

AA+, AA, AA- 

A+, A, A- 

BBB+, BBB, BBB- 

Other1 

Total 

(1) Reinsurance recoveries classified as “other” include $1.5 million of reserves that are fully collateralised. 

As at 31 December 2014 

AAA 

AA+, AA, AA- 

A+, A, A- 

BBB+, BBB, BBB- 

Other1 

Total 

Cash and fixed 
income securities
 $m

Other  
investments  
$m 

Inwards
 premiums 
receivable and 
other receivables 
$m

Reinsurance 
recoveries
$m

302.8

744.0

502.2

232.0

112.5

1,893.5

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

–

–

81.3

–

212.9

294.2

–

–

77.5

–

6.4

83.9

Cash and fixed 
income securities
 $m

Other  
investments  
$m 

Inwards 
premiums
 receivable and 
other receivables 
$m

Reinsurance
 recoveries
 $m

385.9

765.8

642.4

193.1

134.6

2,121.8

– 

– 

0.7 

– 

– 

0.7 

–

–

85.0

–

273.1

358.1

–

–

103.0

0.1

9.3

112.4

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

(1) Reinsurance recoveries classified as “other” include $4.2 million of reserves that are fully collateralised. 

The two counterparties to the Group’s long-term debt interest rate swaps are currently rated A and BBB+ by S&P. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

135 
135

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

The following table shows inwards premiums receivable that are past due but not impaired: 

Less than 90 days past due 

Between 91 and 180 days past due 

Over 180 days past due 

Total 

2015 
$m

16.1

5.6

6.4

28.1

2014 
$m

23.6

6.7

3.2

33.5

Provisions of $2.2 million (2014 – $1.2 million) have been made for impaired or irrecoverable balances and $1.0 million  
(2014 – $1.0 million) was charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in respect of bad debts. No provisions  
have been made against balances recoverable from reinsurers. 

E. OPERATIONAL RISK 
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes or systems. The Group and its subsidiaries have 
identified and evaluated their key operational risks and these are incorporated in the risk registers and modeled directly within BLAST. 
The Group has also established, and monitors compliance with, internal operational risk tolerances. The RRC reviews operational risk  
on at least an annual basis and operational risk is covered in the CRO’s quarterly report to the LHL Board and entity boards and the 
Cathedral Risk Committee reporting. 

In order to manage operational risks, the Group has implemented a robust governance framework. Policies and procedures are 
documented and identify the key risks and controls within processes. The Group’s Internal Audit function provides independent  
feedback with regard to the accuracy and completeness of key risks and controls, and independently verifies the effective operation  
of these through substantive testing. All higher risk areas are subject to an annual audit while compliance with tax operating guidelines  
is audited quarterly. Frequency of audits for all other areas varies from quarterly at the most frequent to a minimum of once every three 
years, on a rotational basis.  

F. STRATEGIC RISK 
The Group has identified several strategic risks. These include: 

•  the risks that either the poor execution of the business plan or an inappropriate business plan in itself results in a strategy that  

fails to adequately reflect the trading environment, resulting in an inability to optimise performance, including reputational risk;  

•  the risks of the failure to maintain adequate capital, accessing capital at an inflated cost or the inability to access capital. This includes 
unanticipated changes in vendor, regulatory and/or rating agency models that could result in an increase in capital requirements or  
a change in the type of capital required; and 

•  the risks of succession planning, staff retention and key man risks.  

The Group has maintained elevated risk scores in the risk register relating to the integration of Cathedral into the Group’s financial  
and actuarial reporting, but these will be reviewed in 2016. 

I. BUSINESS PLAN RISK 
The Group addresses the risks associated with the planning and execution of the business plan through a combination of the following: 

•  an iterative annual forward-looking business planning process with cross departmental involvement; 

•  evaluation of and approval of the annual business plan by the Board of Directors; 

•  regular monitoring of actual versus planned results;  

•  periodic review and re-forecasting as market conditions change; and 

•  feedback to senior management via the daily UMCC and fortnightly RRC meetings. 

136 
136 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
II. CAPITAL MANAGEMENT RISK  
The total capital of the Group is as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Shareholders’ equity  

Long-term debt 

Total capital 

Intangible assets 

Total tangible capital 

2015 
$m

1,220.3

322.3

1,542.6

(153.8)

1,388.8

2014 
$m

1,356.8

326.6

1,683.4

(153.8)

1,529.6

Risks associated with the effectiveness of the Group’s capital management, are mitigated as follows: 

•  regular monitoring of current and prospective regulatory and rating agency capital requirements; 

•  regular discussion with the Cathedral management team regarding Lloyd’s capital requirements;  

•  oversight of capital requirements by the Board of Directors;  

•  ability to purchase sufficient, cost effective reinsurance; 

•  maintaining contact with vendors, regulators and rating agencies in order to stay abreast of upcoming developments; and  

•  participation in industry groups such as the International Underwriters Association, the Association of Bermuda Insurers and  

Reinsurers and the Lloyd’s Market Association. 

The Group reviews the level and composition of capital on an ongoing basis with a view to: 

•  maintaining sufficient capital for underwriting opportunities and to meet obligations to policyholders; 

•  maximising the risk-adjusted return to shareholders within predetermined risk tolerances;  

•  maintaining adequate financial strength ratings; and  

•  meeting internal and regulatory capital requirements. 

Capital is increased or returned as appropriate. The retention of earnings generated leads to an increase in capital. Capital raising  
can include debt or equity and returns of capital may be made through dividends, share repurchases, a redemption of debt or any 
combination thereof. Other capital management tools and products available to the Group may also be utilised. All capital actions  
require approval by the Board of Directors. 

Internal methods have been developed to review the profitability of classes of business and their estimated capital requirements plus  
the capital requirements of the combination of a wide range of other risk categories. These approaches are used by management in 
decision making. The operating entities also conduct capital requirement assessments under internal measures and local regulatory 
requirements. Refer to note 29 for a discussion of the regulatory capital requirements of the Group’s operating entities. 

The Group’s aim is to provide its shareholders with an RoE of 13.0 per cent in excess of a risk-free rate over the insurance cycle. The 
return is generated within a broad framework of risk parameters. The return is measured by management in terms of the IRR of the 
increase in FCBVS in the period adjusted for dividends accrued. This aim is a long-term goal, acknowledging that management expects 
both higher and lower results in the shorter term. The cyclicality and volatility of the insurance market is expected to be the largest  
driver of this pattern. Management monitors these peaks and troughs – adjusting the Group’s portfolio to make the most effective use  
of available capital and seeking to maximise the risk-adjusted return. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

137 
137

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
RISK DISCLOSURES CONTINUED 

IRR achieved is as follows: 

31 December 20051 

31 December 2006 

31 December 2007 

31 December 2008 

31 December 2009 

31 December 2010 

31 December 2011 

31 December 2012 

31 December 2013 

31 December 20142 

31 December 20152 

(1) The returns shown are for the period from date of incorporation, 12 October 2005 to 31 December 2005. 

(2) The annual return was 13.5 per cent (2014 – 14.7 per cent), after adjusting for the impacts of warrants. 

IRR achieved in excess of the three-month treasury yield is as follows: 

31 December 20051 

31 December 2006 

31 December 2007 

31 December 2008 

31 December 2009 

31 December 2010 

31 December 2011 

31 December 2012 

31 December 2013 

31 December 20142 

31 December 20152 

Annual  
return  
% 

Compound 
annual return 
%

Inception to 
date return
 %

(3.2)

17.8 

31.4 

7.8 

26.5 

23.3 

13.4 

16.7 

18.9 

13.9 

10.9 

n/a

14.0

22.4

17.9

19.8

20.3

19.5

19.2

19.2

18.9

18.6

(3.2)

14.0

50.3

63.7

105.8

152.4

191.2

242.7

308.0

375.3

449.1

Annual 
return  
% 

Compound 
annual return 
%

Inception to 
date return 
%

(3.4)

13.0 

26.9 

6.4 

26.4 

23.2 

13.3 

16.6 

18.9 

13.9 

10.9 

n/a

9.2

17.8

14.3

17.1

18.2

17.7

17.7

17.9

17.7

17.5

(3.4)

9.2

40.8

52.7

 94.6

141.1

179.9

231.3

296.6

363.8

437.5

(1) The returns shown are for the period from date of incorporation, 12 October 2005 to 31 December 2005. 

(2) The annual return was 13.5 per cent (2014 – 14.7 per cent), after adjusting for the impacts of warrants. 

III. RETENTION RISK 
Risks associated with succession planning, staff retention and key man risks are mitigated through a combination of resource  
planning processes and controls, including: 

•  the identification of key personnel with appropriate succession plans; 

•  the identification of key team profit generators and function holders with targeted retention packages;  

•  documented recruitment procedures, position descriptions and employment contracts; and 

•  resource monitoring and the provision of appropriate compensation, including equity based compensation which vests over  

a defined time horizon, and training schemes. 

138 
138 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS 

1. GENERAL INFORMATION 
The Group is a provider of global specialty insurance and reinsurance products with operations in London and Bermuda. LHL was 
incorporated under the laws of Bermuda on 12 October 2005. On 16 March 2009, LHL was added to the official list and its common 
shares were admitted to trading on the main market of the LSE; previously LHL’s shares were listed on AIM, a subsidiary market of the 
LSE. Since 21 May 2007, LHL’s shares have had a secondary listing on the BSX. LHL’s registered office is Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville 
Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. LHL’s head office is at Level 29, 20 Fenchurch Street, London, EC3M 3BY, United Kingdom.  

The consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2015 include the Company’s subsidiary companies, the Company’s 
interest in associates, and the Group’s share of Syndicate assets and liabilities and income and expenses. A full listing of the Group’s 
related parties can be found in note 27. 

2. SEGMENTAL REPORTING 
Management and the Board of Directors review the Group's business primarily by its five principal segments: Property, Energy, Marine, 
Aviation and Lloyd’s. These segments are therefore deemed to be the Group’s operating segments for the purposes of segment reporting. 
Further sub-classes of business are underwritten within each operating segment. The nature of these individual sub-classes is discussed 
further in the risk disclosures section on pages 116 to 119. Operating segment performance is measured by the net underwriting profit  
or loss and the combined ratio.  

All amounts reported are transactions with external parties and associates. There are no inter-segmental transactions and there are  
no significant insurance or reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in Bermuda, the Group’s country of domicile.  

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

139 
139

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

2. SEGMENTAL REPORTING CONTINUED 
REVENUE AND EXPENSE BY OPERATING SEGMENT 

For the year ended 31 December 2015 

Gross premiums written by geographical region 

U.S. and Canada 

Worldwide offshore 

Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1 

Europe 

Far East 

Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2 

Middle East 

Rest of world 

Total 

Outwards reinsurance premiums  

Change in unearned premiums 

Change in unearned premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
recoverable 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Net underwriting profit 

Net unallocated income and expenses 

Profit before tax 

Net loss ratio 

Net acquisition cost ratio 

Expense ratio 

Combined ratio 

Property 
$m

Energy 
$m

Marine 
$m

Aviation  
$m 

Lloyd’s 
$m

Total 
$m

74.3

0.2

23.0

24.2

23.2

10.4

7.3

34.6

197.2

(51.4)

19.6

5.9

171.3

(33.0)

14.8

(32.4)

0.8

121.5

1.2

106.2

3.9

(0.1)

(0.1)

–

–

0.9

112.0

(30.6)

48.6

(3.5)

126.5

(47.5)

0.7

(48.0)

0.7

32.4

–

46.8

–

–

–

–

–

0.8

47.6

(11.9)

1.9

0.1

37.7

(5.2)

–

(13.2)

0.3

19.6

– 

– 

36.6 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

36.6 

(14.2)

6.4 

4.6 

33.4 

(26.8)

7.5 

(8.9)

0.1 

5.3 

100.6

–

72.1

24.8

8.1

7.8

0.7

33.6

247.7

(51.3)

3.4

(1.6)

198.2

(65.0)

(1.2)

(45.7)

0.1

86.4

10.6%

18.4%

–

37.0%

37.4%

–

13.8%

34.2%

–

57.8% 

26.3% 

– 

33.4%

23.0%

–

29.0%

74.4%

48.0%

84.1% 

56.4%

176.1

153.2

135.6

48.9

31.2

18.2

8.0

69.9

641.1

(159.4)

79.9

5.5

567.1

(177.5)

21.8

(148.2)

2.0

265.2

(93.5)

171.7

27.5%

25.8%

18.8%

72.1%

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.  

(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada.  

140 
140 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
REVENUE AND EXPENSE BY OPERATING SEGMENT 

For the year ended 31 December 2014 

Gross premiums written by geographical region 

U.S. and Canada 

Worldwide offshore 

Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1 

Europe 

Far East 

Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2 

Middle East 

Rest of world 

Total 

Outwards reinsurance premiums  

Change in unearned premiums 

Change in unearned premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
recoverable 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Net underwriting profit 

Net unallocated income and expenses 

Profit before tax 

Net loss ratio 

Net acquisition cost ratio 

Expense ratio 

Combined ratio 

Property 
$m

Energy 
$m

Marine
 $m

Aviation  
$m 

Lloyd’s 
$m

Total 
$m

92.3

0.1

33.4

34.6

33.8

14.4

8.0

46.4

263.0

(34.3)

(9.9)

2.7

221.5

(12.0)

(9.6)

(33.4)

7.2

173.7

12.5

220.2

3.7

0.9

(0.1)

0.4

0.5

1.3

239.4

(47.8)

(22.5)

0.6

169.7

(55.2)

13.3

(53.1)

0.7

75.4

–

67.0

–

–

–

–

–

0.7

67.7

(9.7)

(0.3)

–

57.7

(27.6)

–

(17.9)

0.2

12.4

– 

0.1 

53.1 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

53.2 

(8.1)

4.7 

2.8 

52.6 

(32.9)

– 

(9.7)

0.1 

10.1 

116.9

–

82.3

24.1

9.0

8.4

1.0

42.6

284.3

(64.9)

(9.0)

3.7

214.1

221.7

287.4

172.5

59.6

42.7

23.2

9.5

91.0

907.6

(164.8)

(37.0)

9.8

715.6

(110.2)

(237.9)

7.7

11.4

(47.7)

(161.8)

0.2

64.1

8.4

335.7

(109.2)

226.5

31.7%

21.4%

15.6%

68.7%

9.8%

11.8%

–

24.7%

30.9%

–

47.8%

30.7%

–

62.5% 

18.3% 

– 

47.9%

22.2%

–

21.6%

55.6%

78.5%

80.8% 

70.1%

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.  

(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

141 
141

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

3. INVESTMENT RETURN 
The total investment return for the Group is as follows: 

For the year ended 31 December 2015 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Cash and cash equivalents 

Total investment return 

Net investment 
income
 and net other 
investment (losses) 
income1
 $m

Net realised 
 (losses) gains 
and impairments
 $m

Net change 
in unrealised 
gains/losses on AFS 
$m

Total investment 
 return excluding 
 foreign exchange  
$m 

Net foreign 
exchange
 (losses) gains
$m

Total investment
return including 
foreign exchange 
$m

28.8

(1.3)

0.4

–

–

0.6

28.5

(1.8)

2.7

(0.7)

(1.6)

(1.4)

–

(2.8)

(11.4)

–

(0.2)

–

–

–

(11.6)

15.6 

1.4 

(0.5)

(1.6)

(1.4)

0.6 

14.1 

(9.2)

–

–

–

2.1

(0.3)

(7.4)

6.4

1.4

(0.5)

(1.6)

0.7

0.3

6.7

(1)  Net unrealised gains/losses on our FVTPL investments are included within net investment income and net other investment income. 

For the year ended 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Cash and cash equivalents 

Total investment return 

Net investment 
income
 and net other
investment (losses) 
income1
$m

Net realised 
 (losses) gains
 and impairments 
$m

Net change 
in unrealised 
gains/losses on AFS
$m

Total investment 
return excluding  
foreign exchange  
$m 

Net foreign 
exchange
 (losses) gains 
$m

Total investment
return including 
foreign exchange 
$m

27.7

1.6

0.5

2.1

(2.3)

0.4

30.0

2.7

–

(0.4)

–

(8.2)

–

(5.9)

(1.8)

–

(0.4)

–

–

–

(2.2)

28.6 

1.6 

(0.3)

2.1 

(10.5)

0.4 

21.9 

(9.5)

–

–

–

1.9

(0.6)

(8.2)

(1)  Net unrealised gains/losses on our FVTPL investments are included within net investment income and net other investment income. 

Net realised (losses) gains and impairments includes impairment losses of $2.4 million (2014 – $0.1 million) recognised on fixed  
income securities and $0.5 million (2014 – $0.2 million) recognised on equity securities held by the Group. 

Refer to page 128 in the risk disclosures section for the estimated fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments. Realised gains  
and losses on futures and options contracts are included in net realised (losses) gains and impairments.  

Included in investment income is $3.2 million (2014 – $5.7 million) of investment management, accounting and custodian fees. 

4. NET INSURANCE ACQUISITION EXPENSES 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Amortisation of value of in-force business acquired 

Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses  

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Total net insurance acquisition expenses 

2015 
$m

130.8

–

17.4

(2.2)

0.2

146.2

2014 included a portion of the amortisation expense relating to the value of in-force business acquired that was allocated to insurance 
acquisition expenses, in line with the run-off profile of that business. 

142 
142 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

19.1

1.6

(0.3)

2.1

(8.6)

(0.2)

13.7

2014 
$m

177.6

15.0

(30.8)

(8.3)

(0.1)

153.4

 
 
 
 
5. RESULTS OF OPERATING ACTIVITIES 
Results of operating activities are stated after charging the following amounts: 

Depreciation on owned assets  

Operating lease charges  

Amortisation of value of in-force business 

Auditors’ remuneration 

– Group audit fees 

– Other services  

Total  

2015 
$m

1.9

3.4

–

1.8

0.1

7.2

2014 
$m

2.1

3.8

8.4

1.7

0.3

16.3

During 2015, EY provided non-audit services in relation to taxation services. During 2014, EY provided non-audit services in relation  
to taxation services, capital management projects, Cathedral group restructuring and services pursuant to the KCML subscription and 
shareholders’ agreement. All fees paid to the Group’s auditors for non-audit services are approved by the Group’s Audit Committee. 

6. EMPLOYEE BENEFITS 

Wages and salaries 

Pension costs 

Bonus and other benefits 

Total cash compensation 

RSS – ordinary 

RSS – bonus deferral 

RSS – Cathedral acquisition grant 

Total equity based compensation 

Total employee benefits 

2015 
$m

30.4

3.1

30.8

64.3

7.3

2.1

6.4

15.8

80.1

2014 
$m

27.4

3.0

23.7

54.1

12.6

3.2

7.5

23.3

77.4

EQUITY BASED COMPENSATION 
The Group’s primary equity based compensation scheme is its RSS. Previously the Group also issued options to employees pursuant  
to an LTIP, which has been closed to further issues, and also authorised and issued warrants at its formation in 2005 and 2006. Further 
details of the warrants can be found in note 24.  

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

143 
143

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

6. EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CONTINUED 
RSS 
On 22 December 2010, LHL’s shareholders, in a Special General Meeting, voted in favour of the LHL Board’s proposal to modify  
the existing RSS awards programme to a nil-cost options programme. The modification introduced an exercise period of ten years from 
the grant date for all outstanding and future RSS grants. Previously, all awards were automatically converted to shares on the vesting date.  

The fair value of any TSR component of the nil-cost options is estimated using a stochastic model. For all other components the  
Black-Scholes model is used to estimate the fair value. 

The following table lists the assumptions used in the stochastic model for the RSS awards granted during the years ended  
31 December 2015 and 2014: 

Assumptions 

Dividend yield 

Expected volatility1 

Risk-free interest rate2 

Expected average life of options  

Share price 

2015

2014

0.0%

19.5%

0.7%

3 years

$9.87

0.0%

22.0%

1.0%

3 years

$12.16

(1)  The expected volatility of LHL and comparator companies’ share prices are calculated based on the movement in the share prices over a period prior to the grant date, equal in length to the expected life  

of the award.  

(2) The risk-free interest rate is consistent with three- year UK government bond yields on the date of grant. 

The calculation of the equity based compensation expense assumes forfeitures due to employee turnover of 10.0 per cent per annum 
prior to vesting, with subsequent adjustments to reflect actual experience. 

RSS – ORDINARY 
The ordinary RSS options vest after a three-year period and are dependent on certain performance criteria. A maximum of 75.0 per cent 
of the ordinary RSS options will vest only on the achievement of an LHL RoE in excess of a required amount. A maximum of 25.0 per cent 
of the ordinary RSS options will vest only on the achievement of an LHL TSR in excess of the 75th percentile of the TSR of a predefined 
comparator group. For all RSS options issued in 2012 and earlier the performance criteria was split as 50.0 per cent relating to RoE and 
50.0 per cent relating to TSR. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is 
paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of RSS options that vest.  

Number of 
employee  
restricted stock  

Number of 
non-employee 
restricted stock 

Total number of 
restricted stock 

4,320,761 

1,157,761 

408,827

4,729,588

–

1,157,761

(1,894,668)

(186,994)

(2,081,662)

(166,857)

(262,781)

3,154,216 

1,529,507 

(662,345)

(223,893)

(525,348)

3,272,137 

956,911 

–

–

(166,857)

(262,781)

221,833

3,376,049

–

1,529,507

(128,839)

–

(92,994)

–

–

(791,184)

(223,893)

(618,342)

3,272,137

956,911

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 

Granted  

Exercised 

Forfeited  

Lapsed 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2014 

Granted  

Exercised 

Forfeited  

Lapsed 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2015 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2015 

144 
144 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
2015 

2014 

Employee 
restricted stock

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Employee  
restricted stock 

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

7.9 years

Weighted average fair value at date of grant 
during the year 

$9.78

–

–

7.9 years

7.9 years 

6.8 years

7.9 years

$9.78

$12.25 

–

$12.25

Weighted average share price at date of 
exercise during the year 

$9.98

$9.86

$9.97

$11.35 

$10.66

$11.29

RSS – BONUS DEFERRAL 
The bonus deferral RSS options vesting periods range from one to three years from the date of grant and do not have associated 
performance criteria for vesting. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues  
and is paid at the time of exercise. 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 

Granted  

Exercised 

Forfeited 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2014 

Granted  

Exercised 

Forfeited 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2015 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2015 

Number of 
employee  
restricted stock  

Number of 
non-employee 
restricted stock 

Total number of 
restricted stock 

355,221 

278,608 

24,921

–

380,142

278,608

(266,228)

(11,183)

(277,411)

(3,991)

363,610 

268,738 

–

13,738

–

(3,991)

377,348

268,738

(170,844)

(11,183)

(182,027)

(26,229)

435,275 

60,882 

–

2,555

–

(26,229)

437,830

60,882

2015 

2014 

Employee 
restricted stock

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Employee  
restricted stock 

Non-employee 
restricted stock

Total 
restricted stock

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

8.0 years

7.2 years

8.0 years

8.4 years 

7.6 years

8.4 years

Weighted average fair value at date of grant 
during the year 

Weighted average share price at date of 
exercise during the year 

$9.69

–

$9.69

$12.14 

–

$12.14

$10.08

$9.96

$10.08

$11.40 

$11.08

$11.39

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

145 
145

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

6. EMPLOYEE BENEFITS CONTINUED  
RSS – CATHEDRAL ACQUISITION 
The Cathedral acquisition RSS options vesting periods range from three to five years and are dependent on certain performance criteria. 
A maximum of 75.0 per cent of the Cathedral acquisition RSS options will vest only on the achievement of a Cathedral combined ratio 
below a required amount. A maximum of 25.0 per cent of the Cathedral acquisition RSS options will vest only on the achievement of  
an LHL RoE in excess of a required amount. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise  
date accrues and is paid at the time of exercise. The awards are not exercisable as at 31 December 2015. 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2015 and 2014 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average fair value at date of grant  

Total number of 
restricted stock 

2,307,157

Total restricted 
stock 

7.9 years

$13.01

MANAGEMENT TEAM ORDINARY WARRANTS  
Ordinary warrants were all fully vested by 31 December 2008 and expired ten years from the date of issue on 16 December 2015. The fair 
value of all ordinary warrants granted was $2.62 per warrant. Ordinary warrants granted and exercised were: 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 

Exercised 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2014 

Exercised  

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2015 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Number

Weighted average 
exercise price 

6,184,399

(5,625,217)

559,182

(559,182)

–

$4.64

$4.63

$4.72

$4.72

–

2015

–

$9.96

2014

1.0 year

$10.55

MANAGEMENT TEAM PERFORMANCE WARRANTS  
Performance warrants were all fully vested by 31 December 2009 and expired ten years from the date of issue on 16 December 2015. 
Vesting was dependent on achieving certain performance criteria. The fair value of all warrants granted was $2.62 per warrant.  
The exercise price of warrants was automatically adjusted for dividends declared prior to their vesting dates. 

Performance warrants granted and outstanding are: 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2013 

Exercised  

Outstanding as at 31 December 2014 

Exercised 

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2015 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Refer to note 24 for further disclosure on non-management warrants outstanding. 

146 
146 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Number

Weighted average 
exercise price 

859,445

(741,965)

117,480

(117,480)

–

$3.62

$3.62

$3.62

$3.62

–

2015

–

$9.96

2014

1.0 year

$11.07

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7. FINANCING COSTS 

Interest expense on long-term debt 

Net losses on interest rate swaps 

Other financing costs 

Total  

2015 
$m

15.1

2.5

0.8

18.4

2014 
$m

15.5

7.4

0.9

23.8

Refer to note 22 for details of long-term debt and financing arrangements. 

8. TAX CHARGE 
BERMUDA 
LHL, LICL and LUK have received an undertaking from the Bermuda government exempting them from all Bermuda local income, 
withholding and capital gains taxes until 31 March 2035. At the present time no such taxes are levied in Bermuda. 

UNITED KINGDOM  
LHL and its UK subsidiaries are subject to normal UK corporation tax on all their taxable profits.  

Tax credit 

Corporation tax charge for the period 

Adjustments in respect of prior period corporation tax 

Deferred tax credit for the period 

Tax rate change adjustment 

Adjustments in respect of prior period deferred tax 

Total tax credit 

Tax reconciliation 

Profit before tax 

UK corporation tax at 20.3% (2014 – 21.5%) 

Non-taxable income 

Adjustments in respect of prior period 

Differences related to equity based compensation 

Other expense permanent differences 

Tax rate change adjustment 

Unused tax losses not recognised for deferred tax 

Utilisation of tax losses previously unrecognised for deferred tax 

Total tax credit 

2015 
$m

2.3

(0.4)

(7.9)

(0.8)

(3.2)

(10.0)

2015 
$m

171.7

34.8

(41.1)

(3.6)

0.4

1.7

(0.8)

–

(1.4)

(10.0)

2014 
$m

0.4

0.2

(2.9)

(0.8)

–

(3.1)

2014 
$m

226.5

48.7

(59.8)

0.2

(8.5)

2.2

(0.8)

14.9

–

(3.1)

Due to the different taxpaying jurisdictions throughout the Group, the current tax credit as a percentage of the Group’s profit before  
tax is 5.8 per cent (2014 – 1.4 per cent).  

For the years ended 31 December, the following tax movements were recognised in other reserves relating to tax deductions for equity 
based compensation award exercises and temporary differences in respect of unexercised awards where the estimated market value varies 
from the cumulative expense at the reporting date. 

Tax (credit) charge in other reserves 

Deferred tax (credit) charge 

Total tax (credit) charge in other reserves 

2015 
$m

(0.1)

(0.1)

2014 
$m

4.4

4.4

Refer to note 10 for details of the tax expense related to the net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments that is included  
in accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income within shareholders’ equity.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

147 
147

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

9. CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS 

Cash at bank and in hand  

Cash equivalents  

Total cash and cash equivalents 

2015 
$m

131.7

160.1

291.8

2014 
$m

210.6

92.9

303.5

Cash equivalents have an original maturity of three months or less. The carrying amount of these assets approximates their fair value. 
Refer to note 22 for the cash and cash equivalent balances on deposit as collateral.  

10. INVESTMENTS 

As at 31 December 2015 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries 

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans  

– Corporate bonds 

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Total investments 

Cost or 
amortised cost 
$m

Unrealised  
gains  
$m 

Unrealised 
losses 
$m

Estimated 
fair value 
$m

20.6

13.9

394.9

70.0

5.0

3.9

115.2

144.0

22.1

28.8

119.9

659.4

1,597.7

24.9

15.8

153.6

– 

– 

0.2 

0.3 

0.2 

– 

0.1 

1.7 

0.3 

0.1 

0.2 

1.4 

4.5 

– 

1.6 

5.3 

–

(2.5)

(1.8)

(4.9)

–

–

(1.4)

(1.9)

(0.6)

(0.1)

(5.1)

(7.0)

20.6

11.4

393.3

65.4

5.2

3.9

113.9

143.8

21.8

28.8

115.0

653.8

(25.3)

1,576.9

(0.1)

(1.8)

(2.9)

24.8

15.6

156.0

1,792.0

11.4 

(30.1)

1,773.3

148 
148 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
As at 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries 

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans  

– Corporate bonds 

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Total investments 

Cost or 
amortised cost 
$m

Unrealised  
gains  
$m 

Unrealised 
losses 
$m

Estimated
 fair value 
$m

30.4

17.1

363.0

88.5

28.6

17.3

185.1

165.9

20.9

2.4

39.0

131.2

707.0

1,796.4

30.0

15.8

150.0

–

– 

0.5 

1.0 

0.8 

0.4 

0.3 

0.3 

2.8 

0.3 

– 

0.6 

0.1 

3.4 

10.5 

1.2 

2.0 

4.3 

0.7 

–

(2.2)

(1.0)

(5.3)

(0.1)

(0.1)

(1.3)

(0.7)

(0.4)

–

–

(3.4)

(5.3)

(19.8)

–

(2.0)

(2.2)

–

30.4

15.4

363.0

84.0

28.9

17.5

184.1

168.0

20.8

2.4

39.6

127.9

705.1

1,787.1

31.2

15.8

152.1

0.7

1,992.2

18.7 

(24.0)

1,986.9

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income is in relation to the Group’s AFS fixed income and equity securities and is as follows: 

Unrealised gains  

Unrealised losses  

Net foreign exchange losses on fixed income – AFS 

Tax provision 

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income 

2015 
$m

6.1

(27.1)

10.4

0.1

(10.5)

2014 
$m

12.5

(21.8)

10.3

(0.2)

0.8

Fixed income maturities are presented in the risk disclosures section on page 133. Refer to note 22 for the investment balances in trusts  
in favour of ceding companies and on deposit as collateral.  

The Group determines the estimated fair value of each individual security utilising the highest level inputs available. Prices for the Group’s 
investment portfolio are provided by a third-party investment accounting firm whose pricing processes and the controls thereon are 
subject to an annual audit on both the operation and the effectiveness of those controls. The audit reports are available to clients of  
the firm and the report is reviewed annually by management. In accordance with their pricing policy, various recognised reputable  
pricing sources are used including broker-dealers and pricing vendors. The pricing sources use bid prices where available, otherwise 
indicative prices are quoted based on observable market trade data. The prices provided are compared to the investment managers’ 
pricing. The Group has not made any adjustments to any pricing provided by independent pricing services or its third-party investment 
managers for either year ending 31 December. 

The fair value of securities in the Group’s investment portfolio is estimated using the following techniques: 

LEVEL (I) 
Level (i) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets. A financial instrument is regarded as quoted in an active market  
if quoted prices are readily and regularly available from an exchange, dealer, broker, industry group, pricing service or regulatory agency 
and those prices represent actual and regularly occurring market transactions on an arm’s length basis. The Group determines securities 
classified as Level (i) to include highly liquid U.S. treasuries, certain highly liquid short-term investments and quoted equity securities.  

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

149 
149

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

10. INVESTMENTS CONTINUED 
LEVEL (II) 
Level (ii) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets for similar assets or liabilities or securities valued using other 
valuation techniques for which all significant inputs are based on observable market data. Instruments included in Level (ii) are valued  
via independent external sources using modeled or other valuation methods. Such methods are typically industry accepted standard  
and include: 

•  broker-dealer quotes; 

•  pricing models or matrix pricing; 

•  present values; 

•  future cash flows; 

•  yield curves; 

•  interest rates; 

•  prepayment speeds; and 

•  default rates.  

Other similar quoted instruments or market transactions may be used.  

The Group determines securities classified as Level (ii) to include short-term and fixed maturity investments and certain derivatives  
such as: 

•  Fixed income funds; 

•  Non-U.S. government bonds; 

•  U.S. municipal bonds; 

•  U.S. government agency debt; 

•  Asset backed securities;  

•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities; 

•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities; 

•  Bank loans; 

•  Corporate bonds; and 

•  OTC derivatives, options, forward foreign exchange contracts, interest rate swaps, credit default swaps and swaptions. 

150 
150 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
LEVEL (III) 
Level (iii) investments are securities for which valuation techniques are not based on observable market data. The Group classifies  
hedge funds as Level (iii) assets as the valuation technique incorporates both observable and unobservable inputs.  

The estimated fair values of the Group’s hedge funds are determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each 
fund’s independent administrator and the estimated performance provided by each hedge fund manager. Independent administrators 
provide monthly reported NAVs with up to a one-month delay in valuation. The most recent NAV available for each hedge fund is 
adjusted for the estimated performance, as provided by the fund manager, between the NAV date and the reporting date. Historically 
estimated fair values incorporating these performance estimates have not been significantly different from subsequent NAVs. Given the 
Group’s knowledge of the underlying investments and the size of the Group’s investment therein, we would not anticipate any material 
variance between estimated valuations and the final NAVs reported by the administrators. 

The Group determines whether transfers have occurred between levels of the fair value hierarchy by re-assessing the categorisation  
at the end of each reporting period based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement as a whole.  

The fair value hierarchy of the Group’s investment holdings is as follows:  

As at 31 December 2015 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries  

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans 

– Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Total investments 

Level (i) 
$m 

 Level (ii)  
$m  

 Level (iii)
 $m

Total 
$m 

10.9

–

393.3

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

404.2

–

15.6

–

9.7 

11.4 

– 

65.4 

5.2 

3.9 

113.9 

143.8 

21.8 

28.8 

115.0 

653.8 

1,172.7 

24.8 

– 

– 

419.8

1,197.5 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

156.0

156.0

20.6

11.4

393.3

65.4

5.2

3.9

113.9

143.8

21.8

28.8

115.0

653.8

1,576.9

24.8

15.6

156.0

1,773.3

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

151 
151

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

10. INVESTMENTS CONTINUED 

As at 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities – AFS 

– Short-term investments 

– Fixed income funds 

– U.S. treasuries  

– Other government bonds 

– U.S. municipal bonds 

– U.S. government agency debt 

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Bank loans 

– Corporate bonds  

Total fixed income securities – AFS 

Fixed income securities – at FVTPL 

Equity securities – AFS 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Other investments  

Total investments 

Level (i) 
$m 

 Level (ii)  
$m  

 Level (iii)
 $m

Total 
$m 

30.3

–

363.0

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

393.3

–

15.8

–

–

0.1 

15.4 

– 

84.0 

28.9 

17.5 

184.1 

168.0 

20.8 

2.4 

39.6 

127.9 

705.1 

1,393.8 

31.2 

– 

– 

0.7 

409.1

1,425.7 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

152.1

–

152.1

30.4

15.4

363.0

84.0

28.9

17.5

184.1

168.0

20.8

2.4

39.6

127.9

705.1

1,787.1

31.2

15.8

152.1

0.7

1,986.9

Hedge funds 
$m

–

150.0

2.1

152.1

18.1

(12.9)

(1.3)

156.0

There have been no transfers between Levels (i) and (ii), therefore no reconciliations have been presented. 

The table below analyses the movements in hedge funds classified as Level (iii) investments: 

As at 31 December 2013 

Purchases  

Total net gains recognised in profit or loss 

As at 31 December 2014 

Purchases  

Sales 

Total net losses recognised in profit or loss 

As at 31 December 2015 

11. INTERESTS IN STRUCTURED ENTITIES 
A. CONSOLIDATED STRUCTURED ENTITIES 
The Group’s only consolidated structured entity is the EBT. The Group provides capital contributions to the EBT to enable it to meet  
its obligations to employees under the equity based compensation plans. The Group has a contractual agreement which may require  
it to provide financial support to the EBT. 

B. UNCONSOLIDATED STRUCTURED ENTITIES IN WHICH THE GROUP HAS AN INTEREST 
As part of its investment activities, the Group invests in unconsolidated structured entities. As at 31 December 2015, the Group’s total 
interest in unconsolidated structured entities was $511.8 million (31 December 2014 – $619.7 million). The Group does not sponsor any 
of the unconsolidated structured entities. 

152 
152 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
A summary of the Group’s interest in unconsolidated structured entities is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2015 

Fixed income securities  

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed income securities  

Investment funds 

– Hedge funds  

Total investment funds 

Specialised investment vehicles 

– KHL (see note 17) 

Total 

As at 31 December 2014 

Fixed income securities  

– Asset backed securities 

– U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

– Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

– Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed income securities  

Investment funds 

– Hedge funds  

Total investment funds 

Specialised investment vehicles 

– KHL (see note 17) 

Total 

Investments  
$m 

Interest in associate
$m

Total 
$m

113.9 

143.8 

21.8 

28.8 

308.3 

156.0 

156.0 

– 

464.3 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

47.5

47.5

113.9

143.8

21.8

28.8

308.3

156.0

156.0

47.5

511.8

Investments  
$m 

Interest in associate
$m

Total 
$m

184.1 

168.0 

20.8 

2.4 

39.6 

414.9 

152.1 

152.1 

– 

567.0 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

52.7

52.7

184.1

168.0

20.8

2.4

39.6

414.9

152.1

152.1

52.7

619.7

The fixed income securities structured entities are created to meet specific investment needs of borrowers and investors which cannot  
be met from standardised financial instruments available in the capital markets. As such, they provide liquidity to the borrowers in these 
markets and provide investors with an opportunity to diversify risk away from standard fixed income securities. Whilst individual securities 
may differ in structure, the principles of the instruments are broadly the same and it is appropriate to aggregate the investments into the 
categories detailed above. 

The risk that the Group faces in respect of the investments in structured entities is similar to the risk it faces in respect of other financial 
investments held on the consolidated balance sheet in that fair value is determined by market supply and demand. This is in turn driven 
by investor evaluation of the credit risk of the structure and changes in term structure of interest rates which change investors’ expectation 
of the cash flows associated with the instrument and, therefore, its value in the market. Risk management disclosure for these financial 
instruments and other investments is provided on pages 123 to 135. The total assets of these structured entities are not considered 
meaningful for the purpose of understanding the related risks and therefore have not been presented. 

The maximum exposure to loss in respect of these structured entities would be the carrying value of the instruments that the Group  
holds as at 31 December 2015 and 31 December 2014. Generally, default rates would have to increase substantially from their current  
level before the Group would suffer a loss and this assessment is made prior to investing and continually through the holding period  
for the security. The Group has not provided any other financial or other support in addition to that described above as at the reporting 
date, and there are no intentions to provide support in relation to any other unconsolidated structured entities in the foreseeable future. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

153 
153

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

11. INTERESTS IN STRUCTURED ENTITIES CONTINUED 
As at 31 December 2015 the Group has a commitment of $50.0 million (31 December 2014 – $nil) in respect of a credit facility fund.  
The Group, via the fund, provides collateral for revolving credit facilities purchased at a discount from financial institutions and is at  
risk for its portion of any defaults on those revolving credit facilities. The Group’s proportionate share of these revolving credit facilities 
purchased by the fund as at 31 December 2015 is $14.3 million (31 December 2014 – $nil), which currently remains unfunded. The 
maximum exposure to the credit facility fund is $50.0 million and as at 31 December 2015 there have been no defaults under this facility. 

12. REINSURANCE ASSETS AND LIABILITIES 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net deferral for prior years 

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2014 

Net deferral for prior years  

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2015 

Unearned 
premiums ceded 
$m

Amounts payable  
to reinsurers 
 $m 

Other 
receivables 
$m

14.9

(14.9)

24.7

–

24.7

(24.7)

30.2

–

30.2

(30.9)

10.8

– 

– 

(3.3)

(34.2)

– 

– 

7.6

(26.6)

–

–

(5.5)

5.3

–

–

(2.6)

2.7

Total 
$m

(5.2)

(14.9)

24.7

(8.8)

(4.2)

(24.7)

30.2

5.0

6.3

154 
154 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
13. LOSSES AND LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net incurred losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Exchange adjustments 

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Net paid losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses 

As at 31 December 2014 

Net incurred losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Exchange adjustments 

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Net paid losses for: 

Prior years 

Current year 

Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses 

As at 31 December 2015 

 Losses and  
loss adjustment 
expenses  
$m 

Reinsurance 
recoveries 
$m

Net losses and 
loss adjustment 
expenses 
$m

853.4 

(183.0)

670.4

(40.8)

278.7 

(11.8)

226.1 

265.8 

61.1 

326.9 

752.6 

(101.4)

278.9 

4.9 

182.4 

210.0 

54.0 

264.0 

671.0 

6.4

(17.8)

0.8

(10.6)

(76.4)

(4.8)

(81.2)

(112.4)

(6.3)

(15.5)

0.8

(21.0)

(40.7)

(8.8)

(49.5)

(83.9)

(34.4)

260.9

(11.0)

215.5

189.4

56.3

245.7

640.2

(107.7)

263.4

5.7

161.4

169.3

45.2

214.5

587.1

Further information on the calculation of loss reserves and the risks associated with them is provided in the risk disclosures section from 
page 120. The risks associated with general insurance contracts are complex and do not readily lend themselves to meaningful sensitivity 
analysis. The impact of an unreported event could lead to a significant increase in the Group’s loss reserves. The Group believes that the 
loss reserves established are adequate, however a 20.0 per cent increase in estimated losses would lead to a $134.2 million (2014 – $150.5 
million) increase in gross loss reserves. There was no change to the Group’s reserving methodology during the year. The split of losses  
and loss adjustment expenses between notified outstanding losses, ACRs assessed by management and IBNR is shown below:  

As at 31 December 

Outstanding losses 

Additional case reserves 

Losses incurred but not reported 

Total  

2015 

 $m

286.0

162.1

222.9

671.0

% 

42.6 

24.2 

33.2 

100.0 

2014 

$m

369.3

159.7

223.6

752.6

%

49.1

21.2

29.7

100.0

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

The Group’s reserve for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses as at 31 December 2015 and 2014 had an estimated duration  
of approximately two years.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

155 
155

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

13. LOSSES AND LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES CONTINUED 
CLAIMS DEVELOPMENT 
The development of insurance liabilities is indicative of the Group’s ability to estimate the ultimate value of its insurance liabilities.  
The Group began writing insurance and reinsurance business in December 2005. With the acquisition of Cathedral in 2013, the Group 
assumed additional loss reserves relating to 2001 and subsequent years.  

Accident year 

Gross Group losses 

Estimate of ultimate liability1 

2006  
and prior  
$m 

2007  
$m 

2008 
$m

2009 
$m

2010 
$m

2011
 $m

2012 
$m

2013 
 $m 

2014 
$m 

2015
$m

Total 
$m

At end of accident year 

39.1 

154.8 

444.6

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

Nine years later 

417.4

377.5

345.1

340.8

355.6

350.9

353.6

131.2 

103.5 

94.8 

83.5 

81.0 

87.6 

87.8 

86.6 

34.7 

32.0 

27.6 

27.2 

24.4 

24.0 

60.6 

58.6 

56.5 

280.0 

274.8 

276.0

259.8 

226.7 

224.0 

250.3

350.4

338.8

326.9

397.0

371.9

447.0

450.4

460.0

297.4

209.4

204.2

235.8

229.4

231.4

163.3

107.8

73.1

66.0

89.1

81.7

72.9

Current estimate of cumulative 
liability  

56.5 

86.6 

353.6

72.9

231.4

460.0

326.9

224.0 

226.7 

276.0 2,314.6

Paid 

(30.2)

(81.2)

(339.5)

(60.4)

(201.0)

(331.2)

(249.6)

(173.7)

(122.8)

(54.0)(1,643.6)

Total Group gross liability 

26.3 

5.4 

14.1

12.5

30.4

128.8

77.3

50.3 

103.9 

222.0

671.0

(1)  Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2015. 

Accident year 

Reinsurance 

Estimate of ultimate recovery1 

At end of accident year 

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

Nine years later 

Current estimate of cumulative 
recovery  

Paid 

Total Group gross recovery 

2006  
and prior  
$m 

2007  
$m 

2008 
$m

2009 
$m

2010 
$m

2011 
$m

2012 
$m

2013  
$m 

2014 
$m 

2015
$m

Total 
$m

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

25.1 

25.1 

24.7 

24.7 

(3.1)

21.6 

15.3

17.8 

14.1 

9.9 

8.9 

8.8 

48.9

121.8

122.0

121.2

56.2

52.6

92.4

88.9

103.3

33.8

23.6

24.1

33.5

34.4

34.6

1.6

1.3

0.7

0.7

10.0

7.0

2.5

40.7

47.1

43.1

40.9

38.1

40.7

39.8

40.4

3.6 

6.2 

4.0 

3.5 

3.3 

3.1 

4.0 

4.1 

4.1 

4.1 

40.4

2.5

34.6

103.3

121.2

(3.6)

(39.0)

(0.8)

(30.7)

(70.0)

(116.2)

0.5 

1.4

1.7

3.9

33.3

5.0

8.8 

(5.9)

2.9 

14.1 

(7.0)

7.1 

15.3

369.0

(8.8)

(285.1)

6.5

83.9

(1)  Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2015. 

156 
156 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accident year 

Net Group losses 

Estimate of ultimate liability1 

At end of accident year 

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

Nine years later 

2006  
and prior  
$m 

2007 
$m

2008 
$m

2009 
$m

2010
 $m

2011 
$m

2012
 $m

2013  
$m 

2014 
$m

2015
$m

Total 
$m

260.7

257.0

212.6

270.1 

250.9 

215.2 

201.4

228.6

216.8

205.7

340.8

319.3

354.6

361.5

356.7

263.6

185.8

180.1

202.3

195.0

196.8

161.7

106.5

72.4

65.3

79.1

74.7

70.4

403.9

370.3

334.4

304.2

302.7

314.9

311.1

313.2

151.2

125.0

99.5

91.3

80.2

77.9

83.6

83.7

82.5

39.1 

34.7 

32.0 

27.6 

27.2 

24.4 

24.0 

35.5 

33.5 

31.8 

Current estimate of cumulative 
liability  

31.8 

82.5

313.2

70.4

196.8

356.7

205.7

215.2 

212.6

260.7 1,945.6

Paid 

(27.1)

(77.6)

(300.5)

(59.6)

(170.3)

(261.2)

(133.4)

(167.8)

(115.8)

(45.2)(1,358.5)

Total Group net liability 

4.7 

4.9

12.7

10.8

26.5

95.5

72.3

47.4 

96.8

215.5

587.1

(1) Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2015. 

The inherent uncertainty in reserving gives rise to favourable or adverse development on the established reserves. The total favourable 
development on net losses and loss adjustment expenses, excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, was as follows: 

2006 accident year and prior 

2007 accident year 

2008 accident year 

2009 accident year 

2010 accident year 

2011 accident year 

2012 accident year 

2013 accident year 

2014 accident year 

Total favourable development 

2015 
$m

1.6

1.1

(2.1)

4.1

(3.5)

17.1

10.8

35.4

43.2

107.7

2014 
$m

1.8

(0.3)

3.6

4.3

5.7

(6.1)

11.1

14.3

–

34.4

The favourable prior year development in 2015 arose primarily from general IBNR releases across most lines of business plus additional 
recoveries on our 2011 Thai flood losses. The favourable prior year development in 2014 arose primarily from IBNR releases due to lower 
than expected reported losses and releases on settlement of outstanding losses, offset by adverse development on prior accident year mid-
sized marine and energy claims.  

14. INSURANCE, REINSURANCE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES 
All receivables are considered current other than $53.8 million (2014 – $71.3 million) of inwards premiums receivable related  
to multi-year contracts. The carrying value approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the receivables. There are  
no significant concentrations of credit risk within the Group’s receivables. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

157 
157

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

15. DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS AND DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS CEDED 
The reconciliation between opening and closing deferred acquisition costs incurred and ceded is shown below: 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net deferral during the year 

As at 31 December 2014 

Net deferral during the year 

As at 31 December 2015 

16. PROVISION FOR DEFERRED TAX 

Equity based compensation 

Claims equalisation reserves  

Syndicate underwriting profits 

Syndicate participation rights 

Other temporary differences 

Tax losses carried forward 

Net deferred tax liability  

Incurred  
$m 

73.8 

30.8 

104.6 

(17.4)

87.2 

Ceded 
$m

(0.2)

0.1

(0.1)

(0.2)

(0.3)

2015 
$m

(4.6)

14.6

3.3

13.6

0.6

(1.9)

25.6

Net 
$m

73.6

30.9

104.5

(17.6)

86.9

2014 
$m 

(3.2)

15.1

13.3

16.0

0.2

(2.7)

38.7

Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through future taxable profits is likely. It is 
anticipated that sufficient taxable profits will be available within the Group in 2016 and subsequent years to utilise the deferred tax  
assets recognised when the underlying temporary differences reverse.  

A deferred tax asset of $14.1 million (2014 – $18.7 million) has not been recognised in relation to unused tax losses carried forward  
in LHL, because at present the related tax benefit is not expected to be realised through future taxable profits. 

The UK government has announced its intention to legislate to reduce the rate of corporation tax to 19.0 per cent with effect from  
1 April 2017 and to 18.0 per cent with effect from 1 April 2020. These rates have been reflected in the closing deferred tax position  
on the consolidated balance sheet. 

All deferred tax assets and liabilities are classified as non-current. 

158 
158 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
17. INVESTMENT IN ASSOCIATE 
The Group holds a 10.0 per cent interest in the preference shares of each segregated account of KHL, a company incorporated  
in Bermuda. KHL’s operating subsidiary, KRL, is authorised by the BMA as a Special Purpose Insurer. KRL commenced writing  
insurance business on 1 January 2014. As at 31 December 2015, the carrying value of the Group’s investment in KHL was $47.5 million  
(31 December 2014 – $52.7 million). The Group’s share of comprehensive income for KHL for the period was $4.1 million  
(31 December 2014 – $4.7 million). Key financial information for KHL is as follows: 

Assets 

Liabilities 

Shareholders’ equity 

Gross premium earned 

Comprehensive income 

2015 
$m

495.0

19.4

475.4

73.4

41.2

The Group has the power to participate in operational and financial policy decisions of KHL and KRL through the provision  
of essential technical information by KCML and has therefore classified its investment in KHL as an investment in associate. 

During the year ended 31 December 2014, AHL and SHL were placed into member’s voluntary liquidation. The Group’s share of 
comprehensive income for AHL for the period was $nil (31 December 2014 – $1.1 million). The Group’s share of comprehensive  
income for SHL for the period was $nil (31 December 2014 – $0.1 million).  

Refer to note 27 for details of transactions between the Group and its associates. 

18. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT  

Cost 

Accumulated depreciation 

Net book value 

19. INTANGIBLE ASSETS 

Net book value as at 31 December 2013 

Amortisation charge for the year through insurance acquisition expenses 

Amortisation charge for the year through other operating expenses 

Net book value as at 31 December 2014 

Net book value as at 31 December 20151  

(1) During the year ended 31 December 2015 the amortisation charge was $nil. 

Value of 
in-force business 
$m

 Syndicate 
participation  
rights  
$m 

23.4

(15.0)

(8.4)

–

–

82.6 

– 

– 

82.6 

82.6 

2015 
$m

20.5

(13.3)

7.2

Goodwill 
$m

71.2

–

–

71.2

71.2

2014 
$m 

551.2

24.6

526.6

79.8

47.0

2014 
$m 

19.3

(10.2)

9.1

Total 
$m

177.2

(15.0)

(8.4)

153.8

153.8

Syndicate participation rights and goodwill are deemed to have indefinite life as they are expected to have value in use that does not 
diminish over the course of time. Consequently, the carrying value is not amortised but tested annually for impairment. The value of  
in-force business was amortised over the remaining life of the acquired insurance contracts, which was approximately one year. 

For the purpose of impairment testing, intangible assets are allocated to the Group’s CGUs, in accordance with the manner in which management 
operates and monitors the business. The syndicate participation rights and goodwill have therefore been allocated to the Lloyd’s CGU. 

When testing for impairment, the recoverable amount of the Lloyd’s CGU is determined based on value in use. Value in use is calculated using 
projected cash flows based on the financial projections of the CGU. These are approved by management and cover a three- year period. The  
most significant assumptions used to derive the projected cash flows include an assessment of business prospects, projected loss ratios, outwards 
reinsurance expenditure and investment returns. A discount rate of 6.8 per cent (31 December 2014 – 8.0 per cent) has been used to discount  
the projected pre tax cash flows, which reflects a combination of factors including the Group’s expected cost of equity and cost of borrowing. 
The growth rate used to extrapolate the cash flows of the unit beyond the three- year period is 2.0 per cent based on historical growth rates and 
management’s best estimate of future growth rates. 

The results of this exercise indicate that the recoverable amount exceeds the intangible assets’ carrying value for both the syndicate participation 
rights and goodwill and would not be sensitive to any reasonably possible changes in assumptions. Therefore no impairment has been recognised 
during the year ended 31 December 2015 (31 December 2014 – $nil). 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

159 
159

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

20. INSURANCE LIABILITIES 

As at 31 December 2013 

Net deferral for prior years 

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2014 

Net deferral for prior years 

Net deferral for current year 

Other 

As at 31 December 2015 

21. INSURANCE, REINSURANCE AND OTHER PAYABLES 

Other payables 

Accrued interest payable 

Total other payables 

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers  

Total payables  

 Unearned  
premiums  
$m 

Other payables 
$m

442.1 

(330.5)

367.5 

– 

479.1 

(345.1)

265.2 

– 

399.2 

28.9

–

–

11.9

40.8

–

–

(4.6)

36.2

2015 
$m

64.8

2.2

67.0

36.2

26.6

Total 
$m

471.0

(330.5)

367.5

11.9

519.9

(345.1)

265.2

(4.6)

435.4

2014 
$m 

81.2

2.3

83.5

40.8

34.2

129.8

158.5

Other payables include unsettled investment trades, accrued interest and other accruals. Insurance payables relate to amounts due  
to policyholders for profit commission, return premiums and claims payable. All payables are considered current. The carrying value 
approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the payables. 

22. LONG-TERM DEBT AND FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS 
LONG-TERM DEBT 
On 5 October 2012, the Group issued $130.0 million 5.70 per cent senior unsecured notes due 2022 pursuant to a private offering  
to U.S. Qualified Institutional Buyers. Interest on the principal is payable semi-annually. The notes were listed and admitted to trading  
on the LSE on 16 October 2012.  

On 15 December 2005, the Group issued $97.0 million and €24.0 million in aggregate principal amount of floating rate subordinated  
loan notes. The U.S. dollar subordinated loan notes are repayable on 15 December 2035. Interest on the principal is based on a set 
margin, 3.70 per cent, above the three-month LIBOR rate and is payable quarterly. The loan notes were issued via a trust company.  
The Euro subordinated loan notes are repayable on 15 June 2035. Interest on the principal is based on a set margin, 3.70 per cent,  
above the EURIBOR rate and is payable quarterly. On 21 October 2011, the CSX admitted to the official list the LHL U.S. dollar and  
Euro subordinated loan notes due 2035. 

In 2013, the Group assumed loan notes, issued by CCHL and listed on the ISE, as part of the Cathedral acquisition. The loan notes 
acquired are set out as follows: 

•  €12.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 18 November 2004 and repayable in September 2034, paying interest 

quarterly based on a set margin, 3.75 per cent, above three-month EURIBOR; 

•  $10.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 26 November 2004 and repayable in September 2034, paying interest 

quarterly based on a set margin, 3.75 per cent, above three-month LIBOR;  

•  $25.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 13 May 2005 and repayable in June 2035, paying interest quarterly based  

on a set margin, 3.25 per cent, above three-month LIBOR; and 

•  $25.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 18 November 2005 and repayable in December 2035, paying interest 

quarterly based on a set margin, 3.25 per cent, above three-month LIBOR. 

160 
160 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
The Group has the option to redeem its senior unsecured notes and all of its subordinated loan notes, in whole or in part, prior to  
the respective maturity dates. 

The carrying values of the notes are shown below: 

As at 31 December 

Long-term debt $130.0 million 

Long-term debt $97.0 million  

Long-term debt €24.0 million  

Long-term debt €12.0 million 

Long-term debt $10.0 million 

Long-term debt $25.0 million 

Long-term debt $25.0 million 

Carrying value 

2015 
$m

130.0

97.0

26.2

11.7

10.0

23.7

23.7

2014 
$m 

130.0

97.0

29.2

13.0

10.0

23.7

23.7

322.3

326.6

The Group is exposed to cash flow interest rate risk and currency risk on its long-term debt. Further information is provided in the  
risk disclosures section on page 130. 

The fair value of the long-term debt is estimated as $328.8 million (2014 – $347.2 million). The fair value measurement is classified within 
Level (ii) of the fair value hierarchy. The fair value is estimated by reference to similar financial instruments quoted in active markets. 

The interest accrued on the long-term debt was $2.2 million (2014 – $2.3 million) at the balance sheet date and is included  
in other payables.  

Refer to note 7 for details of the interest expense for the year included in financing costs. 

INTEREST RATE SWAPS 
The Group hedges a portion of its floating rate borrowings using interest rate swaps to transfer floating to fixed rate. These instruments 
are held at estimated fair value. Refer to the risk disclosures section from page 129 for further details. The Group has the right to net  
settle these instruments.  

The net fair value position owed by the Group on the swap agreements is a $4.8 million liability (2014 – $4.9 million). Further information 
is provided on pages 127 and 129. Cash settlements are completed on a quarterly basis and the total of the next cash settlement in the first 
quarter of 2016 on these instruments is $0.6 million. The net impact from cash settlement and changes in estimated fair value are 
included in financing costs. 

The interest rate swaps are held at estimated fair value, priced using observable market inputs, and are therefore classified as Level (ii) 
securities in the fair value hierarchy. 

Refer to note 7 for the net impact from cash settlement and changes in estimated fair value included in financing costs. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

161 
161

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

22. LONG-TERM DEBT AND FINANCING ARRANGEMENTS CONTINUED 
LETTERS OF CREDIT 
As both LICL and LUK are non-admitted insurers or reinsurers throughout the U.S., the terms of certain contracts require them  
to provide LOCs to policyholders as collateral. LHL and LICL have the following facilities in place as at 31 December 2015 and 2014:  

•  a $350.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility with a $75.0 million loan sub-limit that has been in place since 5 April 2012  

and will expire on 5 April 2017. There was no outstanding debt under this facility as at 31 December 2015 and 2014; and 

•  a $50.0 million bi-lateral uncommitted LOC facility with Citibank Europe PLC as at 31 December 2014, which has now expired. 

The existing facility is available for the issue of LOCs to ceding companies. The facility is also available for LICL to issue LOCs to LUK  
to collateralise certain insurance balances. 

The terms of the $350.0 million LOC facility include standard default and cross-default provisions which require certain covenants  
to be adhered to. These include the following: 

•  an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++; and 

•  a maximum debt to capital ratio of 30.0 per cent, where the LHL subordinated loan notes are excluded from this calculation.  

As at all reporting dates the Group was in compliance with all covenants under these facilities.  

The following LOCs have been issued: 

As at 31 December  

Issued to third parties  

LOCs are required to be fully collateralised.  

2015 
$m

44.5

2014 
$m 

31.8

SYNDICATE BANK FACILITIES 
As at 31 December 2015 and 2014, Syndicate 2010 had in place an $80.0 million catastrophe facility with Barclays Bank plc. The facility  
is available to assist in paying claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 2010. Up to $40.0 million can be utilised by way  
of an LOC and up to $40.0 million by way of an RCF to assist Syndicate 2010’s gross funding requirements. 

As at 31 December 2015 and 2014, Syndicate 3010 had in place a $40.0 million catastrophe facility with Barclays Bank plc. The facility is 
available to assist in paying claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 3010. Up to $20.0 million can be utilised by way  
of an LOC and up to $20.0 million by way of an RCF to assist Syndicate 3010’s gross funding requirements. 

The total combined maximum borrowings available to Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 under these facilities are $100.0 million and  
the total combined maximum that can be utilised by way of an LOC is $50.0 million and by way of an RCF is $50.0 million to assist in 
both Syndicates’ gross funding requirements. 

There are no balances outstanding under either of the syndicate bank facilities as at 31 December 2015 or 2014. The syndicate bank 
facilities are not available to the Group other than through its participation on the syndicates it supports. 

TRUSTS AND RESTRICTED BALANCES 
The Group has several trust arrangements in place in favour of policyholders and ceding companies in order to comply with the security 
requirements of certain reinsurance contracts and/or the regulatory requirements of certain jurisdictions.  

In 2012, LICL entered into an MBRT to collateralise its reinsurance liabilities associated with U.S. domiciled clients. As at and for the years 
ended 31 December 2015 and 2014, LICL had been granted authorised or trusteed reinsurer status in all states. The MBRT is subject to 
the rules and regulations of the aforementioned states and the respective deed of trust. These rules and regulations include minimum 
capital funding requirements, investment guidelines, capital distribution restrictions and regulatory reporting requirements. 

As at and for the years ended 31 December 2015 and 2014, the Group was in compliance with all covenants under its trust facilities. 

162 
162 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
The Group is required to hold a portion of its assets as FAL to support the underwriting capacities of Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010. 
FAL are restricted in their use and are only drawn down to pay cash calls to syndicates supported by the Group. FAL requirements are 
formally assessed twice a year and any funds surplus to requirements may be released at that time. See note 29 for more information 
regarding FAL requirements. 

In addition to the FAL, certain cash and investments held by Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 are only available for paying the syndicate 
claims and expenses. See note 29 for more information regarding capital requirements for Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010. 

The following cash and cash equivalents and investment balances were held in trust, other collateral accounts in favour of third parties, 
or are otherwise restricted: 

Cash and cash 
equivalents 
$m

2015 

Fixed income 
securities 
$m

Equity
securities
$m

Cash and cash 
equivalents  
$m 

2014 

Fixed income 
securities 
$m

Equity
securities
 $m

As at 31 December 

MBRT accounts 

In trust accounts for policyholders 

In favour of LOCs 

In favour of derivative contracts 

FAL 

Syndicate accounts 

Total 

23. SHARE CAPITAL 
Authorised ordinary shares of $0.50 each 

As at 31 December 2015 and 2014 

Allocated, called up and fully paid  

As at 31 December 2013 

Shares issued 

As at 31 December 2014 

Shares issued 

As at 31 December 2015 

Own shares 

As at 31 December 2013 

Shares distributed 

Shares repurchased 

Shares donated to trust  

As at 31 December 2014 

Shares distributed 

Shares purchased by trust  

As at 31 December 2015 

0.6

0.9

7.4

6.0

11.3

9.4

35.6

31.3

21.7

43.4

0.3

201.4

85.8

383.9

–

–

–

–

15.6

–

15.6

0.3 

0.7 

8.0 

1.5 

6.9 

6.9 

24.3 

31.3

22.9

25.3

1.7

167.5

89.6

338.3

Number

3,000,000,000

Number

185,445,809

6,666,789

192,112,598

9,229,320

201,341,918

–

–

–

–

15.8

–

15.8

$m

1,500

$m

92.7

3.4

96.1

4.6

100.7

$m

36.8

25.0

8.1

43.3

(22.2)

9.3

30.4

The new common shares issued during 2015 and 2014 were to satisfy the exercises of warrants and to fund future RSS exercises. 

Number held
 in treasury

3,513,325

(666,434)

2,498,433

(2,394,377)

2,950,947

(1,109,421)

$m

24.6

Number held
 in trust

906,339

$m 

Total number 
of own shares

12.2 

4,419,664

(5.0)

(1,643,647)

(21.6)

(2,310,081)

(26.6)

25.0

–

(16.8)

2,394,377

27.8

1,657,069

– 

2,498,433

24.9 

15.5 

–

4,608,016

(9.7)

(1,354,535)

(12.5)

(2,463,956)

–

–

1,000,000

1,841,526

18.1

1,302,534

9.3 

12.3 

1,000,000

3,144,060

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

The number of common shares in issue with voting rights (allocated share capital less shares held in treasury) as at 31 December 2015  
was 199,500,392 (31 December 2014 – 189,161,651). 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

163 
163

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

23. SHARE CAPITAL CONTINUED 

SHARE REPURCHASES 
At the AGM held on 29 April 2015, the Group’s shareholders approved a renewal of the Repurchase Programme authorising the 
repurchase of a maximum of 20,034,191 shares, with such authority to expire on the conclusion of the 2016 AGM or, if earlier,  
15 months from the date the resolution approving the Repurchase Programme was passed.  

During the year ended 31 December 2015 no shares were repurchased by the Group under the Share Repurchase Programme. During  
the year ended 31 December 2014 $25.0 million (2,498,433 shares) were repurchased by the Group at a weighted average share price  
of $10.02. 

In 2015, the trustees of the EBT acquired 1,000,000 shares (2014 – nil) in accordance with the terms of the trust and distributed  
1,354,535 (2014 – 1,643,647). There were no unsettled balances in relation to EBT purchases at either balance sheet date.  

DIVIDENDS 
The Board of Directors have authorised the following dividends: 

Type 

Final  

Special 

Interim 

Special 

Final  

Special 

Interim 

Special 

Per share amount

Record date 

Payment date

$0.10

21 Mar 2014 

16 Apr 2014

$0.20

21 Mar 2014 

16 Apr 2014

$0.05

29 Aug 2014 

24 Sep 2014

$1.20

28 Nov 2014 

19 Dec 2014

$0.10

20 Mar 2015 

15 Apr 2015

$0.50

20 Mar 2015 

15 Apr 2015

$0.05

28 Aug 2015 

25 Sep 2015

$0.95

27 Nov 2015 

18 Dec 2015

$m

21.1

42.1

10.4

247.4

19.8

99.2

9.9

188.6

164 
164 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
24. OTHER RESERVES 
Other reserves consist of the following: 

As at 31 December 2013 

Share premium reclassification 

Purchase of shares from non-controlling interest 

Distributed by trust 

Shares donated to trust 

Warrant exercises 

RSS compensation 

Equity based compensation – tax 

Equity based compensation – exercises 

Equity based compensation – expense 

As at 31 December 2014 

Purchase of shares by trust 

Distributed by trust 

Warrant exercises 

Equity based compensation – tax 

Equity based compensation – exercises 

Equity based compensation – expense 

As at 31 December 2015 

Contributed surplus 
$m 

633.1 

192.2 

(0.6)

(28.3)

8.1 

22.4 

(9.8)

– 

21.3 

– 

838.4 

8.8 

(17.2)

(4.2)

– 

13.8 

– 

839.6 

Equity based 
compensation 
$m

67.8

–

–

–

–

(16.7)

–

(4.4)

(21.3)

23.3

48.7

–

–

(9.6)

0.1

(13.8)

15.8

41.2

Total other 
reserves 
$m

700.9

192.2

(0.6)

(28.3)

8.1

5.7

(9.8)

(4.4)

–

23.3

887.1

8.8

(17.2)

(13.8)

0.1

–

15.8

880.8

Equity based compensation reserves represent the fair value, at the grant date, of all outstanding RSS options and management team 
ordinary and performance warrants held by employees, adjusted for any applicable performance conditions. Refer to note 6 for changes  
in the number of warrants held by employees. 

Given the equity nature of the Founder warrants, they are recorded net within other reserves. Founder warrants exercised during the  
year ended 31 December 2015 were $39.4 million (31 December 2014 – $10.6 million). The changes in the number of warrants held  
by non-employees are as follows: 

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2013 

Exercised 

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2014 

Exercised 

Outstanding and exercisable as at 31 December 2015 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Number of  
Founder warrants 

Number of 
Lancashire 
Foundation 
warrants

Number of 
ordinary 
warrants

19,074,787 

648,143

2,350,000

(4,042,108)

–

–

15,032,679 

648,143

2,350,000

(15,032,679)

(648,143)

(2,350,000)

– 

–

–

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

2015

–

$9.98

2014

1.0 year

$11.25

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

165 
165

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

25. COMMITMENTS 
A. LEASE COMMITMENTS 
The Group has payment obligations in respect of operating leases for certain items of office equipment and office space. Operating  
lease expenses for the year were $3.4 million (2014 – $3.8 million). 

Future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases are as follows: 

Due in less than one year  

Due between one and five years 

Due in more than five years 

Total 

2015 
$m

1.1

12.7

36.6

50.4

2014 
$m

1.1

11.4

41.2

53.7

During 2014, the Group entered into a new lease agreement for larger office premises in the UK and assigned the leases in relation to the 
existing office premises in the UK to a third party who assumed responsibility for payments. Under the terms of the lease assignment the 
Group retains liability for lease payments in the event that the assignee and the assignee’s guarantor fail to meet their obligations under 
the assignment agreements. The new lease agreement contains a break date of April 2029 and is guaranteed by the Group. 

B. CREDIT FACILITY FUND 
At as 31 December 2015 the Group has a commitment of $50.0 million (31 December 2014 – $nil) relating to a credit facility fund  
(refer to note 11). 

26. EARNINGS PER SHARE 
The following reflects the profit and share data used in the basic and diluted earnings per share computations: 

Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of LHL 

Basic weighted average number of shares 

Dilutive effect of RSS 

Dilutive effect of warrants 

Diluted weighted average number of shares 

Earnings per share 

Basic 

Diluted 

2015 
$m

181.1

2015 
Number
 of shares

2014 
$m

229.3

2014 
Number 
of shares

195,649,042

185,558,086

2,982,711

2,442,255

–

10,112,990

198,631,753

198,113,331

2015

$0.93

$0.91

2014

$1.24

$1.16

Equity based compensation awards are only treated as dilutive when their conversion to common shares would decrease earnings per 
share or increase loss per share from continuing operations. Unvested restricted shares without performance criteria are therefore 
included in the number of potentially dilutive shares. Incremental shares from ordinary restricted share options where relevant 
performance criteria have not been met are not included in the calculation of dilutive shares.  

166 
166 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
 
 
 
 
27. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES  
The consolidated financial statements include LHL and the entities listed below: 

Name 

Subsidiaries1 

LICL 

KCML2 

KCMMSL 

LIHL 

LIMSL 

LISL 

LUK 

LMSCL 

CCIL3 

CCHL 

CCL 

CCL 1998 

CCL 1999 

CCL 20004 

CCML5 

CCSL 

CUL 

Associate 

KHL 

Other controlled entities 

LHFT 

EBT 

Principal Business 

Domicile 

General insurance business 

Insurance management services 

Support services 

Holding company 

Insurance mediation activities 

Support services 

General insurance business 

Support services 

Holding company 

Investment company 

Holding company 

Lloyd’s corporate member 

Non trading 

Holding company 

Non trading 

Support services 

Lloyd’s managing agent 

Bermuda 

Bermuda 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

Canada 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

Holding company 

Bermuda 

Trust 

Trust 

United States 

Jersey 

(1)  Unless otherwise stated, the Group owns 100 per cent of the ordinary share capital and voting rights in its subsidiaries listed below. 

(2) 92.68 per cent owned by the Group. 

(3) CCIL was dissolved on 4 February 2016. 

(4) CCL 2000 was dissolved on 4 February 2016. 

(5) CCML was dissolved on 4 February 2016. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

167 
167

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

27. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES CONTINUED  
The Group has issued subordinated loan notes via a trust vehicle – LHFT, refer to note 22. The Group effectively has 100.0 per cent  
of the voting rights in LHFT. These rights are subject to the property trustee’s obligations to seek the approval of the holders of LHFT’s 
preferred securities in case of default and other limited circumstances where the property trustee would enforce its rights. While the 
ability of the Group to influence the actions of LHFT is limited by the trust agreement, LHFT was set up by the Group with the sole 
purpose of issuing the subordinated loan notes, is in essence controlled by the Group, and is therefore consolidated. 

The EBT was established to assist in the administration of the Group’s employee equity based compensation schemes. While the Group 
does not have legal ownership of the EBT and the ability of the Group to influence the actions of the EBT is limited by the trust deed,  
the EBT was set up by the Group with the sole purpose of assisting in the administration of these schemes, is in essence controlled by  
the Group, and is therefore consolidated. 

The Group has a Loan Facility Agreement (the ‘Facility’) with RBC Cees Trustee Limited, the trustee of the EBT. The Facility is an interest 
free revolving credit facility under which the trustee can request advances on demand, within the terms of the Facility, up to a maximum 
aggregate of $60.0 million. The Facility may only be used by the trustee for the purpose of achieving the objectives of the EBT. During  
the year ended 31 December 2015, the Group had made advances of $9.0 million (2014 – $5.0 million) to the EBT under the terms of  
the Facility. 

During the year ended 31 December 2015, the Group issued 1,000,000 shares to the EBT at a total par value of $0.5 million. During  
the year ended 31 December 2014, the Group donated 2,394,377 treasury shares to the EBT at the prevailing market rate. The total  
value of the treasury share donation was $24.9 million.  

LICL holds $308.1 million (2014 – $346.1 million) of cash and cash equivalents and fixed income securities in trust for the benefit of  
LUK relating to intra-group reinsurance agreements.  

During 2014, LHL and members of the Group’s senior management team purchased shares in KCML from Richard Brindle, the Group’s 
former CEO. The senior management team shareholding now represents a minority interest of 7.32 per cent. This investment represents 
the non-controlling interest listed in the Group’s consolidated balance sheet. 

KEY MANAGEMENT COMPENSATION 
Remuneration for key management, the Group’s Executive and Non-Executive Directors, was as follows:  

For the year ended 31 December 

Short-term compensation1 

Equity based compensation 

Directors' fees and expenses 

Total 

2015 
$m

4.1

3.3

1.9

9.3

2014 
$m

3.3

7.5

2.2

13.0

(1)  The year ended 31 December 2014 includes a credit of $2.3 million relating to the decrease in the UK National Insurance contribution provision in respect of Richard Brindle’s warrants. This is a result of the 

reduction in the Group’s share price prior to the exercise of his warrants during 2014. 

The table above for the year ended 31 December 2014 includes short-term compensation of $1.8 million and an equity based 
compensation charge of $3.5 million relating to the retirement of Richard Brindle. His retirement package also included a cash settlement 
of RSS awards amounting to $8.2 million. Dividend equivalents that have been accrued on the RSS awards amounted to $1.6 million. The 
settlement of the RSS awards and the dividend equivalent payment are reflected in contributed surplus within shareholders’ equity.  

The Directors’ fees and expenses includes $nil (2014 – $0.4 million) paid to significant founding shareholders. Non-Executive Directors 
do not receive any benefits in addition to their agreed fees and expenses and do not participate in any of the Group’s incentive, 
performance or pension plans. 

168 
168 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
 
TRANSACTIONS WITH ASSOCIATES 
In relation to transactions with ARL, the following amounts were included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income: 

For the year ended 

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 

Insurance loss and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

2015 
$m

–

–

–

2014 
$m

0.6

(6.9)

6.8

In 2013, KCML entered into an underwriting services agreement with KRL and KHL to provide various services relating to underwriting, 
actuarial, premium payments and relevant deductions, acquisition expenses and receipt of claims. For the year ended 31 December 2015, 
the Group recognised $12.9 million (31 December 2014 – $6.2 million) of service fees and profit commissions in other income in relation 
to this agreement.  

During 2015, the Group committed an additional $23.5 million (31 December 2014 – $27.8 million) of capital to KHL. During 2015,  
KHL returned $32.8 million (31 December 2014 – $nil) of capital to the Group. 

During 2014, AHL returned $33.5 million of capital to the Group and ARL paid a final profit commission to the Group in the amount  
of $6.7 million following a commutation of the Group’s quota share agreement with ARL. 

During 2014, SHL returned $12.2 million of capital to the Group and SRL paid a final profit commission to the Group in the amount  
of $3.0 million and was placed in to run-off and subsequently liquidated. 

Refer to note 17 for further details on the Group’s investment in associate. 

28. NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS  
During 2015, the Group issued new common shares to satisfy the exercises of warrants and future exercises of RSS in the amount of  
$4.6 million (31 December 2014 – $3.4 million); refer to note 23. On 25 June 2014, following shareholder approval on 30 April 2014,  
LHL transferred $192.2 million from share premium to contributed surplus. Refer to note 24 for further details. 

I

F
I
N
A
N
C
A
L
S
T
A
T
E
M
E
N
T
S

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

169 
169

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
 
 
NOTES TO THE ACCOUNTS CONTINUED 

29. STATUTORY REQUIREMENTS AND DIVIDEND RESTRICTIONS 
The primary source of capital used by the Group is equity shareholders’ funds and borrowings. As a holding company, LHL relies on 
dividends from its operating entities to provide the cash flow required for debt service and dividends to shareholders. The operating 
entities’ ability to pay dividends and make capital distributions is subject to the legal and regulatory restrictions of the jurisdictions in 
which they operate.  

For LICL and LUK, these regulatory restrictions are based principally on the amount of premiums written and reserves for losses and  
loss adjustment expenses, subject to overall minimum solvency requirements. LICL and LUK’s statutory capital and surplus are different 
from shareholders equity due to certain items that are capitalised under IFRS but expensed or have a different valuation basis for 
regulatory reporting, or are not admitted under insurance regulations. 

Annual statutory capital and surplus reported to regulatory authorities by LICL and LUK is as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Statutory capital and surplus 

Minimum required statutory capital and surplus 

2015 

LICL 
$m

938.1

128.9

LUK  
$m 

165.6 

35.5 

2014 

LICL 
$m

1,009.5

233.7

LUK 
$m

182.2

37.2

LICL is required to maintain a minimum liquidity ratio, whereby relevant assets, as defined in the regulations, must exceed 75.0 per cent 
of relevant liabilities. As at 31 December 2015 and 2014 the liquidity ratio was met. LICL is also required to perform various capital 
calculations under the BMA’s regulatory framework. An assessment is made of LICL’s capital needs and a target capital amount is 
determined. The BMA may require a further capital loading on the target capital amount in certain circumstances. The BMA considers 
that a decrease in capital below the target level represents a regulatory intervention point.  

For LUK, various capital calculations are performed and an ICA is presented to the PRA. The PRA then considers the capital calculations 
and issues an ICG, reflecting the PRA’s own view as to the level of capital required. The PRA considers that a decrease in an insurance 
company’s capital below the level of its ICG represents a regulatory intervention point.  

Solvency II, a new regulatory regime for (re)insurance in the European Economic Area, introduces a new basis for assessing capital.  
This assessment includes a market-consistent economic balance sheet and an SCR, using either an internal model or the standard  
formula. It will impact the Group, LUK and CCL (as part of Lloyd’s) and is effective from 1 January 2016. The Group has implemented 
the new requirements and, as part of the preparatory phase, provided interim information on this basis to regulators in 2015. This 
information demonstrated that the Group and LUK were more than adequately capitalised for supervisory and regulatory purposes  
under Solvency II regulations. 

The Group’s underwriting capacity as a member of Lloyd’s must be supported by providing a deposit in the form of cash, securities or 
LOCs, which are referred to as FAL. The capital framework at Lloyd’s requires each managing agent to calculate the capital requirement 
for each syndicate they manage. Solvency II internal models have been used to determine capital requirements for Syndicate 2010 and 
Syndicate 3010 based on the uSCR. Lloyd’s has the discretion to take into account other factors at member level to uplift the calculated 
uSCR, including the need to maintain the market’s overall security rating. Any uplift by Lloyd’s is added to the uSCR to produce the 
ECA and this is regarded as the minimum capital requirement for the business. 

Lloyd’s then uses each syndicate’s ECA as a basis for determining member level capital requirements, which are backed by FAL.  
For the 2016 calendar year the Group’s initial FAL requirement was set at 56.8 per cent (2015 – 53.9 per cent) of underwriting capacity 
supported. Further adjustments can be made by Lloyd’s to allow for open year profits and losses of the syndicates on which the corporate 
member participates. The Group has sufficient capital to meet its FAL requirement of £157.3 million as at 31 December 2015  
(31 December 2014 – £149.3 million). 

As at 31 December 2015 and 2014 the capital requirements of all the regulatory jurisdictions were met.  

30. COMPARATIVE INFORMATION 
Certain comparative figures have been re-presented to conform to the presentation adopted for 2015. 

31. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS 
DIVIDEND 
On 17 February 2016 the Board of Directors declared the payment of an ordinary dividend of $0.10 per common share to shareholders of 
record on 26 February 2016, with a settlement date of 23 March 2016. The ordinary dividend payable will be approximately $19.8 million. 
An amount equivalent to the dividend accrues on all RSS options and is paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of 
RSS options that vest. 

170 
170 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

 
SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION 

ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 
The Company’s AGM is scheduled for 4 May 2016. Notice of this 
year’s AGM and the form of proxy accompany this Annual Report.  
If you have any queries regarding the notice or return of the proxy  
please contact Chris Head, Company Secretary, at Lancashire  
Holdings Limited, 29th Floor, 20 Fenchurch Street, London  
EC3M 3BY, United Kingdom, Tel: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000 and  
email: chris.head@lancashiregroup.com.  

FURTHER INFORMATION 
Lancashire Holdings Limited is registered in Bermuda under  
company number EC 37415 and has its registered office at  
Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. 

Further information about the Group including this Annual 
Report, press releases and the Company’s share price is available 
on our website at www.lancashiregroup.com. Please address any 
enquiries to info@lancashiregroup.com. 

NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS 
Some of the statements in this document include forward-looking 
statements which reflect the Directors’ current views with respect 
to financial performance, business strategy, plans and objectives  
of management for future operations (including development 
plans relating to the Group’s products and services). These 
statements include forward-looking statements both with respect  
to the Group and the sectors and industries in which the Group 
operates. Statements containing the words “believes”, “anticipates”, 
“plans”, “projects”, “forecasts”, “guidance”, “intends”, “expects”, 
“estimates”, “predicts”, “may”, “can”, “likely”, “will”, “seeks”, 
“should” or, in each case, their negative or comparable 
terminology and similar statements are of a future or forward-
looking nature. All forward-looking statements address matters  
that involve risks and uncertainties. Accordingly, there are or  
will be important factors that could cause the actual results, 
performance or achievements of the Group to be materially 
different from future results, performance or achievements 
expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements.  

These factors include, but are not limited to: the Group’s ability  
to integrate its business and personnel, the successful retention 
and motivation of the Group’s key management, the increased 
regulatory burden facing the Group, the number and type of 
insurance and reinsurance contracts that the Group writes or  
the Group may write; the Group’s ability to successfully implement 
its business strategy during “soft” as well as “hard” markets; the 
premium rates which may be available at the time of such renewals 
within its targeted business lines; the possible low frequency of 
large events; potentially unusual loss frequency; the impact that the 
Group’s future operating results, capital position and rating agency 
and other considerations may have on the execution of any capital 
management initiatives or dividends; the possibility of greater 
frequency or severity of claims and loss activity than the Group’s 

underwriting, reserving or investment practices have anticipated; 
the reliability of, and changes in assumptions to, catastrophe 
pricing, accumulation and estimated loss models; increased 
competition from existing alternative capital providers  
and insurance linked funds and collateralised special purpose 
insurers and the related demand and supply dynamics as contracts 
come up for renewal; the effectiveness of its loss limitation 
methods; the potential loss of key personnel; a decline in the 
Group’s operating subsidiaries’ rating with A.M.Best, Standard  
& Poor’s, Moody’s or other rating agencies; increased competition 
on the basis of pricing, capacity, coverage terms or other factors; 
cyclical downturns of the industry; the impact of a deteriorating 
credit environment for issuers of fixed income investments; the 
impact of swings in market interest rates and securities prices; 
changes by central banks regarding the level of interest rates;  
the impact of inflation or deflation in relevant economies in  
which the Group operates; the effect, timing and other 
uncertainties surrounding future business combinations within  
the insurance and reinsurance industries; the impact of terrorist 
activity in the countries in which the Group writes risks; a rating 
downgrade of, or a market decline in, securities in its investment 
portfolio; changes in governmental regulations or tax laws in 
jurisdictions where the Group conducts business; Lancashire or its 
Bermudian subsidiaries becoming subject to income taxes in the 
United States or the Bermudian subsidiaries becoming subject to 
income taxes in the United Kingdom; the inapplicability to the 
Group of suitable exclusions from the UK CFC regime; any change 
in the UK government policy which impacts the CFC regime or 
other tax changes. Any estimates relating to loss events involve the 
exercise of considerable judgement and reflect a combination of 
ground-up evaluations, information available to date from brokers 
and insureds, market intelligence, initial and/or tentative loss 
reports and other sources. Judgements in relation to loss arising 
from natural catastrophe and man-made events are influenced by 
complex factors. The Group cautions as to the preliminary nature 
of the information used to prepare such estimates as subsequently 
available information may contribute to an increase in these types 
of losses. 

These forward-looking statements speak only as at the date of  
this document. The Company expressly disclaims any obligation  
or undertaking (save as required to comply with any legal  
or regulatory obligations including the rules of the LSE)  
to disseminate any updates or revisions to any forward-looking 
statements to reflect any changes in the Group’s expectations  
or circumstances on which any such statement is based. All 
subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements 
attributable to the Group or individuals acting on behalf  
of the Group are expressly qualified in their entirety by this 
paragraph. Prospective investors should specifically consider  
the factors identified in this document which could cause actual 
results to differ before making an investment decision. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

www.lancashiregroup.com 

171 
171

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
GLOSSARY 

ABS 
Asset backed securities 

ACTIVE UNDERWRITER 
The individual at a Lloyd’s syndicate with principal authority to 
accept insurance and reinsurance risk on behalf of the syndicate 

ADDITIONAL CASE RESERVES (ACR) 
Additional reserves deemed necessary by management 

AFS 
Available for sale 

AGGREGATE 
Accumulations of insurance loss exposures which result from 
underwriting multiple risks that are exposed to common causes  
of loss 

CCL 
Cathedral Capital Limited 

CCL 1998 
Cathedral Capital (1998) Limited 

CCL 1999 
Cathedral Capital (1999) Limited 

CCL 2000 
Cathedral Capital (2000) Limited 

CCML 
Cathedral Capital Management Limited 

CCSL 
Cathedral Capital Services Limited 

AGM 
Annual General Meeting 

AHL 
Accordion Holdings Limited 

AIM 
A sub-market of the LSE 

AIR 
AIR Worldwide 

A.M. BEST COMPANY (A.M. BEST)  
A.M. Best is a full-service credit rating organisation dedicated  
to serving the financial services industries, focusing on the 
insurance sector  

ANP 
All natural perils 

ARL (ACCORDION) 
Accordion Reinsurance Limited 

BAM 
Bathwater aggregate model 

BEST LANCASHIRE ASSESSMENT OF SOLVENCY OVER TIME (BLAST) 
The Group’s economic internal capital model  

BMA 
Bermuda Monetary Authority 

BOARD OF DIRECTORS 
Unless otherwise stated refers to the LHL Board of Directors 

BOOK VALUE PER SHARE (BVS) 
Calculated by dividing the value of the total shareholders’ equity  
by the sum of all common voting shares outstanding 

BSX 
Bermuda Stock Exchange 

CATHEDRAL; CATHEDRAL GROUP 
Refers to CCL and all direct and indirect subsidiaries of CCL 

CCHL 
Cathedral Capital Holdings Limited 

CCIL 
Cathedral Capital (Investments) Limited 

172 
172 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

CEDED 
To transfer insurance risk from a direct insurer to a reinsurer 
and/or from a reinsurer to a retrocessionaire 

CEND 
Confiscation, Expropriation, Nationalisation and Deprivation 

CEO 
Chief Executive Officer 

CFC 
Controlled Foreign Company 

CFO 
Chief Financial Officer 

CGU 
Cash generating unit 

CMBS 
Commercial mortgage backed securities 

THE CODE 
UK Corporate Governance Code published by the UK FRC 

COMBINED RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of the sum of net insurance losses, net 
acquisition expenses and other operating expenses to net 
premiums earned 

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
Includes the independent auditors’ report, consolidated primary 
statements, accounting policies, risk disclosures and related notes 

CONSOLIDATED PRIMARY STATEMENTS 
Includes the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, 
consolidated balance sheet, consolidated statement of changes in 
shareholders’ equity and the statement of consolidated cash flows 

COVERHOLDER AT LLOYD’S 
A coverholder is a company or partnership authorised by a 
managing agent to enter into a contract or contracts of insurance  
to be underwritten by the members of a syndicate managed by  
it in accordance with the terms of a binding authority 

CRO 
Chief Risk Officer 

CSX 
Cayman Islands Stock Exchange 

CUL 
Cathedral Underwriting Limited 

CUO 
Chief Underwriting Officer 

FAL 
Funds at Lloyd’s 

FCA 
Financial Conduct Authority 

DEFERRED ACQUISITION COSTS  
Costs incurred for the acquisition or the renewal of insurance 
policies (e.g. brokerage and premium taxes) which are deferred  
and amortised over the term of the insurance contracts to which 
they relate 

DILUTED EARNINGS PER SHARE 
Calculated by dividing the net profit for the year attributable to 
shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares 
outstanding during the year plus the weighted average number  
of common shares that would be issued on the conversion of  
all potentially dilutive equity based compensation awards into 
common shares under the treasury stock method 

DIVIDEND YIELD 
Calculated by dividing the annual dividends per share by the  
share price on the last day of the given year 

DURATION 
Duration is the weighted average maturity of a security’s cash flows, 
where the present values of the cash flows serve as the weights  

The effect of the convexity, or sensitivity, of the portfolio’s response 
to changes in interest rates is also factored in to the calculation 

EARNINGS PER SHARE (EPS)  
Calculated by dividing net profit for the year attributable to 
shareholders by the weighted average number of common  
shares outstanding during the year, excluding treasury shares  
and shares held by the EBT 

EBT 
Lancashire Holdings Employee Benefit Trust 

FDIC CORPORATE BONDS 
Corporate bonds protected by the Federal Deposit Insurance 
Corporation, an agency of the U.S. government 

FPSO 
Floating production storage and offloading 

FRC 
Financial Reporting Council 

FSMA 
The Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended  
from time to time) 

FULLY CONVERTED BOOK VALUE PER SHARE (FCBVS) 
Calculated by dividing the value of the total shareholders’ equity 
plus the proceeds that would be received from the exercise of all 
dilutive equity compensation awards, by the sum of all shares, 
including equity compensation awards assuming all are exercised 

FVTPL 
Fair value through profit or loss 

G10 
Belgium, Canada, Germany, France, Italy, Japan, the Netherlands, 
Sweden, the United Kingdom, and the United States 

GOM 
Gulf of Mexico 

GROSS PREMIUMS WRITTEN 
Amounts payable by the insured, excluding any taxes or duties 
levied on the premium, including any brokerage and commission 
deducted by intermediaries  

ECA 
Economic Capital Assessment 

ERM 
Enterprise Risk Management 

EURIBOR 
The Euro Interbank Offered Rate 

EXCESS OF LOSS  
Reinsurance or insurance that indemnifies the reinsured  
or insured against all or a specified portion of losses on an 
underlying insurance policy in excess of a specified amount 

EXPENSE RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of other operating expenses to net  
premiums earned 

EY 
Ernst & Young LLP 

FACULTATIVE REINSURANCE 
A reinsurance risk that is placed by means of a separately 
negotiated contract as opposed to one that is ceded under  
a reinsurance treaty 

THE GROUP  
LHL and its subsidiaries 

HMRC 
Her Majesty's Revenue & Customs 

ICA 
Individual capital assessment 

ICG 
Individual capital guidance 

ICM 
International Care Ministries 

IFRIC 
International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee 

IFRS 
International Financial Reporting Standard(s) 

IGPIA 
International Group of Protection and Indemnity Associations 

ILS 
Insurance linked securities 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

173 
173

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
GLOSSARY CONTINUED 

INCURRED BUT NOT REPORTED (IBNR)  
These are anticipated or likely losses that may result from insured 
events which have taken place, but for which no losses have yet 
been reported. IBNR also includes a reserve for possible adverse 
development of previously reported losses 

LHL (THE COMPANY) 
Lancashire Holdings Limited 

LIBOR 
London Interbank Offered Rate 

INDUSTRY LOSS WARRANTY (ILW) 
A type of reinsurance or derivative contract through which one 
party will purchase protection based on the total loss arising  
from an event to the entire insurance industry rather than their 
own losses 

INTERNAL AUDIT CHARTER 
Is a formal written document that sets out the mission, scope, 
responsibilities, authority, professional standards and the 
relationship with the external auditors / regulatory bodies of  
the internal audit function (“internal audit”) with the Company  
and its subsidiaries 

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARD(S) (IAS) 
Standards, created by the IASB, for the preparation and 
presentation of financial statements 

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARDS BOARD (IASB)  
An international panel of accounting experts responsible for 
developing IAS and IFRS 

IRR 
Internal rate of return 

IRRC 
Investment Risk and Return Committee 

ISA 
International Standards on Auditing (UK and Ireland) 

ISE 
Irish Stock Exchange 

KCML 
Kinesis Capital Management Limited 

KCMMSL 
KCM Marketing Services Limited  

KHL  
Kinesis Holdings I Limited 

KINESIS 
The Group’s third-party capital management division 
encompassing KCML, KCMMSL and the management of KHL  
and KRL 

KRL (KINESIS RE) 
Kinesis Reinsurance I Limited 

LANCASHIRE COMPANIES 
Refers to the Group excluding Cathedral and Kinesis 

LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION OR FOUNDATION 
The Lancashire Foundation is a charity registered in England  
and Wales 

LHFT 
Lancashire Holdings Financing Trust I 

174 
174 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

LICL 
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 

LIHL 
Lancashire Insurance Holdings (UK) Limited 

LIMSL 
Lancashire Insurance Marketing Services Limited 

LISL 
Lancashire Insurance Services Limited 

LISTING RULES  
The listing rules made by the FCA under part VI of FSMA  
(as amended from time to time) 

LLOYD’S 
The Society of Lloyd’s 

LMSCL 
Lancashire Management Services (Canada) Limited 

LOC 
Letter of credit 

LOSSES 
Demand by an insured for indemnity under an insurance contract 

LSE 
London Stock Exchange 

LTIP 
Long-term incentive plan 

LUK 
Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited 

M&A 
Mergers and acquisitions 

MBRT 
Multi-beneficiary reinsurance trust 

MBS 
Mortgage backed securities 

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICES (MOODY’S) 
Moody's Corporation is the parent company of Moody's Investors 
Service, which provides credit ratings and research covering debt 
instruments and securities, and Moody's Analytics, which offers 
software, advisory services and research for credit and economic 
analysis and financial risk management 

NAMES 
An individual member underwriting with unlimited liability.  
Since 6 March 2003 no person has been admitted as a new  
member to underwrite on an unlimited basis 

NAV 
Net asset value 

 
 
GLOSSARY CONTINUED 

events which have taken place, but for which no losses have yet 

been reported. IBNR also includes a reserve for possible adverse 

development of previously reported losses 

INDUSTRY LOSS WARRANTY (ILW) 

A type of reinsurance or derivative contract through which one 

party will purchase protection based on the total loss arising  

from an event to the entire insurance industry rather than their 

own losses 

INTERNAL AUDIT CHARTER 

Is a formal written document that sets out the mission, scope, 

responsibilities, authority, professional standards and the 

relationship with the external auditors / regulatory bodies of  

the internal audit function (“internal audit”) with the Company  

and its subsidiaries 

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARD(S) (IAS) 

Standards, created by the IASB, for the preparation and 

presentation of financial statements 

INTERNATIONAL ACCOUNTING STANDARDS BOARD (IASB)  

An international panel of accounting experts responsible for 

developing IAS and IFRS 

Internal rate of return 

Investment Risk and Return Committee 

International Standards on Auditing (UK and Ireland) 

IRR 

IRRC 

ISA 

ISE 

KCML 

KCMMSL 

KHL  

KINESIS 

and KRL 

Irish Stock Exchange 

Kinesis Capital Management Limited 

KCM Marketing Services Limited  

Kinesis Holdings I Limited 

KRL (KINESIS RE) 

Kinesis Reinsurance I Limited 

LANCASHIRE COMPANIES 

LIBOR 

LICL 

LIHL 

LIMSL 

LISL 

LSE 

LTIP 

LUK 

M&A 

MBRT 

MBS 

London Interbank Offered Rate 

Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 

Lancashire Insurance Holdings (UK) Limited 

Lancashire Insurance Marketing Services Limited 

Lancashire Insurance Services Limited 

LISTING RULES  

The listing rules made by the FCA under part VI of FSMA  

(as amended from time to time) 

Lancashire Management Services (Canada) Limited 

LLOYD’S 

The Society of Lloyd’s 

LMSCL 

LOC 

Letter of credit 

LOSSES 

London Stock Exchange 

Long-term incentive plan 

Demand by an insured for indemnity under an insurance contract 

Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited 

Mergers and acquisitions 

Multi-beneficiary reinsurance trust 

Mortgage backed securities 

Service, which provides credit ratings and research covering debt 

instruments and securities, and Moody's Analytics, which offers 

software, advisory services and research for credit and economic 

analysis and financial risk management 

The Group’s third-party capital management division 

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICES (MOODY’S) 

encompassing KCML, KCMMSL and the management of KHL  

Moody's Corporation is the parent company of Moody's Investors 

Refers to the Group excluding Cathedral and Kinesis 

NAMES 

LANCASHIRE FOUNDATION OR FOUNDATION 

The Lancashire Foundation is a charity registered in England  

An individual member underwriting with unlimited liability.  

Since 6 March 2003 no person has been admitted as a new  

member to underwrite on an unlimited basis 

and Wales 

LHFT 

Lancashire Holdings Financing Trust I 

NAV 

Net asset value 

174 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2014 

INCURRED BUT NOT REPORTED (IBNR)  

LHL (THE COMPANY) 

These are anticipated or likely losses that may result from insured 

Lancashire Holdings Limited 

NBS 
New Bridge Street (a trading name of Aon Hewitt Limited) 

RSS 
Restricted share scheme 

NET ACQUISITION COST RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of net acquisition expenses to net  
premiums earned 

NET LOSS RATIO 
Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance losses to net premiums earned 

NET OPERATING PROFIT 
Profit before tax excluding realised gains and losses and foreign 
exchange gains and losses  

NET PREMIUMS WRITTEN 
Net premiums written is equal to gross premiums written  
less outwards reinsurance premiums written  

ORSA 
Own Risk and Solvency Assessment 

OTC 
Over the counter 

PML 
Probable maximum loss 

PRA 
Prudential Regulation Authority 

PRO-RATA/PROPORTIONAL  
Reinsurance or insurance where the reinsurer or insurer shares  
a proportional part of the original premiums and losses of  
the reinsured or insured 

RCF 
Revolving credit facility 

RDS 
Realistic Disaster Scenarios 

RETROCESSION 
The reinsurance of a reinsurance account  

RETURN ON EQUITY (RoE) 
The IRR of the change in FCBVS in the period plus  
accrued dividends 

RMBS 
Residential mortgage backed securities 

RMS 
Risk Management Solutions 

RPI 
Renewal Price Index 

RRC 
Risk and Return Committee 

RROC 
Regulatory Reporting Oversight Committee 

RSC 
Reinsurance Security Committee 

SATEC 
SATEC Underwriting, a privately owned insurance underwriting 
agency operating at national and international level in specialty 
classes of business. SATEC Underwriting is a coverholder at Lloyd’s 

SCR 
Solvency Capital Requirement 

SHARP 
Lancashire’s in house aggregation system 

SHL 
Saltire Holdings I Limited 

SRL (SALTIRE) 
Saltire Re I Limited 

STANDARD & POOR’S (S&P) 
Standard & Poor’s is a worldwide insurance rating and information 
agency whose ratings are recognised as an ideal benchmark for 
assessing the financial strength of insurance related organisations 

SYNDICATE 2010 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 2010, managed by CUL. The Group provides 
capital to support 57.8 per cent of the stamp 

SYNDICATE 3010 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 3010, managed by CUL. The Group provides 
capital to support 100.0 per cent of the stamp 

THE SYNDICATES 
Syndicate 2010 and 3010 

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN (TSR) 
The IRR of the increase/ (decrease) in share price in the period, 
measured in U.S. dollars, adjusted for dividends 

TREATY REINSURANCE 
A reinsurance contract under which the reinsurer agrees to offer  
and to accept all risks of a certain size within a defined class 

UK 
United Kingdom 

UMCC 
Underwriting and Marketing Conference Call 

UNEARNED PREMIUMS  
The portion of premium income that is attributable to periods  
after the balance sheet date that is deferred and amortised to 
future accounting periods 

UNL 
Ultimate net loss 

USCR 
Ultimate solvency capital requirement 

U.S. GAAP 
Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States 

VALUE AT RISK (VAR) 
A measure of the risk of loss of a specific portfolio of  
financial assets 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com 

175 
175

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
 
 
KINESIS 
Kinesis Capital Management Limited  
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

LEGAL COUNSEL TO THE COMPANY 
AS TO ENGLISH AND U.S. LAW: 
Willkie Farr & Gallagher (UK) LLP 
City Point 
1 Ropemaker Street 
London EC2Y 9AW 
United Kingdom 

AS TO BERMUDA LAW: 
Conyers Dill & Pearman Limited 
Clarendon House 
2 Church Street 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

AUDITORS 
Ernst & Young LLP 
25 Churchill Place 
Canary Wharf 
London E14 5EY 
United Kingdom 

REGISTRAR 
Capita Registrars (Jersey) Limited 
PO Box 532 
St Helier  
Jersey JE4 5UW 
Channel Islands 

DEPOSITARY 
Capita IRG Trustees Limited 
The Registry 
34 Beckenham Road 
Beckenham 
Kent BR3 4TU 
United Kingdom 

CONTACT INFORMATION 

HEAD OFFICE 
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
29th Floor  
20 Fenchurch Street  
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4077 

REGISTERED OFFICE  
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

BERMUDA OFFICE 
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

UK OFFICE 
Lancashire Insurance Company  
(UK) Limited 
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street  
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4077 

CATHEDRAL 
Cathedral Capital Limited  
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street 
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9001 

176 
176 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2015

Visit our corporate website for more information: 
http://www.lancashiregroup.com

This report is printed on Heaven 42 and Essential 
Offset which have been independently certified by 
the Forest Stewardship Council® and manufactured 
using materials from sustainable sources.

The inks used are all vegetable oil based.

Designed and produced by Black Sun Plc.

Printed at Principal Colour Ltd. ISO 14001 certified, 
Alcohol Free and FSC® Chain of Custody certified.

www.lancashiregroup.com